Fix CVE-2016-1531
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3112
3113 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3115 backward compatibility.)
3116 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3117 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118
3119 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3120 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3121 name will not be output.
3122
3123 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3124 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3125 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3126 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3127 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3128 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3129 written directly into the spool directory.
3130
3131 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132 .code
3133 exim -bP +local_domains
3134 .endd
3135 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3136 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137
3138 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3141 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3142 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3143 that driver are output. For example:
3144 .code
3145 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146 .endd
3147 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3148 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3149 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3150 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3151 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3152 &%authenticators%&.
3153
3154 .cindex "environment"
3155 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3156 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag supresses the value of the
3157 variables.
3158
3159 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3160 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3161 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3162 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3163 The output format is one item per line.
3164
3165 .vitem &%-bp%&
3166 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3167 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3168 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3169 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3170 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3171 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3172 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3173 to allow any user to see the queue.
3174
3175 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3176 .code
3177 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3178 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3179 <other addresses>
3180 .endd
3181 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3182 .cindex "size" "of message"
3183 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3184 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3185 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3186 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3187 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3188 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3189 before the sender address.
3190
3191 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3192 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3193 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3194
3195 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3196 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3197 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3198 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3199 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3200 complete.
3201
3202
3203 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3204 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3205 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3206 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3207 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3208 of just &"D"&.
3209
3210
3211 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3212 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3213 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3214 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3215 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3216 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3217
3218
3219 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3220 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3221 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3222 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3223 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3224 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3225
3226 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3227 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3228 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3229
3230 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3231 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3232 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3233
3234
3235 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3236 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3237 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3238 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3239 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3240 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3241
3242
3243 .vitem &%-brt%&
3244 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3245 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3246 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3247 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3248 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3249 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3250 .code
3251 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3252 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3253 .endd
3254 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3255 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3256 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3257 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3258 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3259 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3260 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3261 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3262 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3263 .code
3264 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3265 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3266 .endd
3267
3268 .vitem &%-brw%&
3269 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3270 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3271 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3272 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3273 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3274 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3275 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3276 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3277
3278 .vitem &%-bS%&
3279 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3280 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3281 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3282 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3283 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3284 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3285 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3286 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3287 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3288 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3289
3290 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3291 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3292 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3293
3294 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3295 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3296 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3297 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3298
3299 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3300 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3301 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3302
3303 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3304 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3305 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3306 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3307 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3308
3309 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3310 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3311
3312 .vitem &%-bs%&
3313 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3314 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3315 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3316 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3317 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3318 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3319 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3320 messages to the MTA.
3321
3322 In
3323 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3324 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3325 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3326 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3327 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3328 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3329 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3330
3331 .cindex "inetd"
3332 The
3333 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3334 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3335 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3336 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3337 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3338 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3339 the listening daemon.
3340
3341 .vitem &%-bt%&
3342 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3343 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3344 .cindex "address" "testing"
3345 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3346 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3347 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3348 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3349 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3350
3351 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3352 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3353
3354 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3355 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3356 security issues.
3357
3358 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3359 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3360 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3361 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3362 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3363 program.
3364
3365 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3366 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3367 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3368 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3369
3370 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3371 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3372 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3373 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3374 always shown.
3375
3376 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3377 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3378 message,
3379 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3380 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3381 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3382 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3383 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3384 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3385 doing such tests.
3386
3387 .vitem &%-bV%&
3388 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3389 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3390 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3391 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3392 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3393 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3394 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3395
3396 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3397 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3398 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3399 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3400 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3401 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3402 dynamic testing facilities.
3403
3404 .vitem &%-bv%&
3405 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3406 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3407 .cindex "address" "verification"
3408 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3409 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3410 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3411 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3412 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3413 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3414
3415 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3416 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3417 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3418
3419 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3420 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3421
3422 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3423 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3424 security issues.
3425
3426 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3427 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3428 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3429 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3430 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3431
3432 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3433 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3434 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3435 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3436 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3437 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3438 to succeed.
3439
3440 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3441 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3442 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3443
3444 The
3445 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3446 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3447 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3448 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3449
3450 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3451 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3452 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3453 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3454
3455 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3456 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3457 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3458 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3459 might happen.
3460
3461 .vitem &%-bw%&
3462 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3463 .cindex "daemon"
3464 .cindex "inetd"
3465 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3466 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3467 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3468 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3469
3470 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3471 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3472 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3473 each port only when the first connection is received.
3474
3475 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3476 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3477
3478 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3479 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3480 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3481 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3482 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3483 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3484 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3485 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3486 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3487 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3488 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3489
3490 The file names need to be absolute names.
3491
3492 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3493 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3494 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3495 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3496 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3497 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3498 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3499 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3500 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3501
3502 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3503 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3504 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3505 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3506 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3507 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3508 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3509
3510 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3511 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3512 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3513 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3514 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3515 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3516 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3517
3518 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3519 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3520 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3521 configuration file.
3522
3523 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3524 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3525 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3526 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3527 specified by this option.
3528
3529
3530 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3531 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3532 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3533 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3534 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3535 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3536 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3537 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3538
3539 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3540 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3541 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3542 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3543 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3544 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3545 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3546
3547 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3548 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3549 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3550 synonymous:
3551 .code
3552 exim -DABC ...
3553 exim -DABC= ...
3554 .endd
3555 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3556 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3557 example:
3558 .code
3559 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3560 .endd
3561 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3562 .new
3563 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3564 .wen
3565
3566
3567 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3568 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3569 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3570 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3571 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3572 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3573 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3574 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3575 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3576 return code.
3577
3578 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3579 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3580 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3581 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3582 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3583 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3584 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3585 are:
3586 .display
3587 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3588 &`auth `& authenticators
3589 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3590 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3591 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3592 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3593 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3594 &`filter `& filter handling
3595 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3596 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3597 &`ident `& ident lookup
3598 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3599 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3600 &`load `& system load checks
3601 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3602 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3603 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3604 &`memory `& memory handling
3605 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3606 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3607 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3608 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3609 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3610 &`retry `& retry handling
3611 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3612 &`route `& address routing
3613 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3614 &`tls `& TLS logic
3615 &`transport `& transports
3616 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3617 &`verify `& address verification logic
3618 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3619 .endd
3620 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3621 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3622 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3623 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3624 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3625 turn everything off.
3626
3627 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3628 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3629 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3630 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3631 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3632 rather than stderr.
3633
3634 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3635 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3636 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3637 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3638 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3639 run in parallel.
3640
3641 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3642 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3643 in processing.
3644
3645 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3646 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3647
3648 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3649 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3650 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3651 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3652 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3653 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3654
3655 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3656 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3657 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3658 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3659 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-E%&
3662 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3663 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3664 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3665 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3666 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3667 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3668 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3669 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3670 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3671
3672 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3673 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3674 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3675 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3676 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3677 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3678
3679 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3680 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3681 .cindex "sender" "name"
3682 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3683 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3684 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3685 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3686 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3687 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3688
3689 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3690 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3691 .cindex "sender" "address"
3692 .cindex "address" "sender"
3693 .cindex "trusted users"
3694 .cindex "envelope sender"
3695 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3696 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3697 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3698 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3699 users to use it.
3700
3701 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3702 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3703 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3704 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3705 domain.
3706
3707 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3708 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3709 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3710 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3711 examples of shell commands:
3712 .code
3713 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3714 exim -f "" user@domain
3715 .endd
3716 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3717 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3718 &%-bv%& options.
3719
3720 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3721 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3722 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3723 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3724
3725 White
3726 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3727 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3728 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3729 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3730 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3731 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3732
3733 .vitem &%-G%&
3734 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3735 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3736 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3737 .code
3738 control = suppress_local_fixups
3739 .endd
3740 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3741 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3742 in future.
3743
3744 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3745 this option.
3746
3747 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3748 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3749 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3750 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3751 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3752 headers.)
3753
3754 .vitem &%-i%&
3755 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3756 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3757 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3758 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3759 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3760 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3761 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3764 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3765 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3766 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3767 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3768 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3769 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3770 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3771
3772 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3773
3774 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3775 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3776 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3777 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3778 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3779 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3780 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3781 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3782 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3783
3784 Retry
3785 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3786 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3787 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3788 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3789 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3790 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3791
3792 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3793 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3794 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3795 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3796
3797 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3798 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3799 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3800 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3801 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3802 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3803 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3804 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3805 can be used only by an admin user.
3806
3807 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3808 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3809 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3810 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3811 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3812 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3813 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3814 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3815 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3816 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3817 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3818
3819 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3820 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3821 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3822 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3823 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3824
3825 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3826 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3827 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3828 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3829 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3830
3831 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3832 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3833 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3834 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3835 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3836
3837 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3838 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3839 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3840 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3841 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3842 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3843 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3844 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3845
3846 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3847 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3848 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3850 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3851 connection.
3852
3853 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3854 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3855 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3857 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3858
3859 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3860 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3861 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3862 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3863 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3864 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3865 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3866 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3867 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3868 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3869 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3870 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3871 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3872 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3873 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3874
3875 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3876 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3877 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3878 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3879 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3880 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3881 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3882 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3883 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3884 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3885
3886 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3887 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3888 .cindex "freezing messages"
3889 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3890 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3891 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3892 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3893 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3894 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3895 user.
3896
3897 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3898 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3899 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3900 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3901 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3902 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3903 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3904 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3905 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3906 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3907 user.
3908
3909 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3910 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3911 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3912 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3913 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3914 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3915 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3916
3917 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3918 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3919 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3920 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3921 .cindex "removing recipients"
3922 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3923 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3924 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3925 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3926 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3927 can be used only by an admin user.
3928
3929 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3930 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3931 .cindex "removing messages"
3932 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3933 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3934 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3935 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3936 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3937 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3938 placed on the queue.
3939
3940 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3941 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3942 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3943 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3944 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3945 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3946 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3947 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3948 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3949 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3950 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3951
3952 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3953 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3954 .cindex "thawing messages"
3955 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3956 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3957 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3958 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3959 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3960 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3961 by an admin user.
3962
3963 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3964 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3965 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3966 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3967 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3968 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3969
3970 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3971 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3973 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3974 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3975 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3976 only by an admin user.
3977
3978 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3979 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3980 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3981 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3983 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3984 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3987 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3988 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3989 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3990 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3991 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3992
3993 .vitem &%-m%&
3994 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3995 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3996 treats it that way too.
3997
3998 .vitem &%-N%&
3999 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4000 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4001 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4002 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4003 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4004 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4005 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4006 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4007 than &"=>"&.
4008
4009 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4010 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4011 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4012 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4013 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4014 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4015 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4016 for that message.
4017
4018 .vitem &%-n%&
4019 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4020 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4021 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4022 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4023
4024 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4025 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4026 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4027 Exim.
4028
4029 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4030 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4031 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4032 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4033 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4034 description above.
4035
4036 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4037 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4038 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4039 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4040 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4041 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4042 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4043 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4044
4045 .vitem &%-odb%&
4046 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4047 .cindex "background delivery"
4048 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4049 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4050 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4051 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4052 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4053 processes to finish.
4054
4055 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4056 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4057 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4058 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4059
4060 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4061 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4062 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4063 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4064
4065 .vitem &%-odf%&
4066 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4067 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4068 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4069 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4070 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4071 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4072 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4073
4074 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4075 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4076 during deliveries.
4077
4078 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4079 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4080
4081 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4082 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4083 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4084 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4085
4086
4087 .vitem &%-odi%&
4088 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4089 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4090 Sendmail.
4091
4092 .vitem &%-odq%&
4093 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4094 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4095 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4096 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4097 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4098 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4099 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4100 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4101 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4102 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4103 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4104 forces queueing.
4105
4106 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4107 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4108 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4109 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4110 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4111 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4112 configuration file is in effect.
4113
4114 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4115 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4116 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4117 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4118 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4119 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4120 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4121 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4122 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4123 &%-qq%& option.
4124
4125 .vitem &%-oee%&
4126 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4127 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4128 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4129 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4130 message.
4131
4132 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4133 Provided
4134 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4135 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4136 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4137 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4138
4139 .vitem &%-oem%&
4140 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4141 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4142 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4143 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4144 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4145 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4146
4147 .vitem &%-oep%&
4148 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4149 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4150 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4151 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4152 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4153 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4154
4155 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4156 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4157 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4158 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4159 effect as &%-oep%&.
4160
4161 .vitem &%-oew%&
4162 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4163 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4164 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4165 effect as &%-oem%&.
4166
4167 .vitem &%-oi%&
4168 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4169 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4170 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4171 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4172 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4173 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4174 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4175
4176 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4177 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4178 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4179
4180 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4181 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4182 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4183 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4184 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4185 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4186 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4187 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4188
4189 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4190 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4191 .code
4192 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4193 .endd
4194 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4195 followed by a colon and the port number:
4196 .code
4197 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4198 .endd
4199 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4200 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4201 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4202 whichever one is last.
4203
4204 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4205 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4206 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4207 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4208 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4209 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4210 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4211 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4212
4213 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4214 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4215 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4216 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4217 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4218 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4219 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4220 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4221
4222 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4223 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4224 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4225 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4226 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4227 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4228 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4229 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4230 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4231 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4232
4233 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4234 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4235 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4236 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4237 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4238 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4239 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4240
4241 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4242 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4243 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4244 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4245 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4246 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4247 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4248 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4249 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4250
4251 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4252 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4253 is sending the bounce.
4254
4255 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4256 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4257 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4258 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4259 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4260 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4261 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4262 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4263 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4264 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4265 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4266 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4267
4268 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4269 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4270 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4271 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4272 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4273 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4274 uses the name it is given.
4275
4276 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4277 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4278 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4279 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4280 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4281 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4282 used, when there is no default.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-om%&
4285 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4286 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4287 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4288 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4289 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4290
4291 .vitem &%-oo%&
4292 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4293 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4294 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4295 whatever that means.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4298 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4299 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4300 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4301 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4302 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4303 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4304 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4305 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4306
4307 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4308 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4309 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4310 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4311 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4312 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4313 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4314
4315 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4316 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4317 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4318 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4319 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4320 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4321 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4322 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4323
4324 .vitem &%-ov%&
4325 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4326 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4327
4328 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4329 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4330 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4331 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4332 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4333 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4334 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4335 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4336 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4337 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4338
4339 .vitem &%-pd%&
4340 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4341 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4342 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4343 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4344 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4345 needed.
4346
4347 .vitem &%-ps%&
4348 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4349 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4350 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4351 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4352 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4353 started.
4354
4355 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4356 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4357 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4358 .display
4359 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4360 .endd
4361 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4362 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4363 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4364 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4365 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4366
4367 .vitem &%-q%&
4368 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4369 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4370 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4371 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4372 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4373 and &%-S%& options).
4374
4375 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4376 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4377 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4378 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4379 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4380 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4381
4382 If
4383 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4384 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4385 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4386 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4387 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4388 proceeding.
4389
4390 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4391 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4392 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4393 this to be repeated periodically.
4394
4395 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4396 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4397 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4398 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4399
4400 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4401 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4402 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4403
4404 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4405 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4406 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4407 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4408
4409 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4410 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4411 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4412 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4413 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4414 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4415 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4416 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4417 transports are run.
4418
4419 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4420 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4421 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4422 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4423 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4424 delivered down a single SMTP
4425 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4426 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4427 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4428 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4429 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4430 intermittently.
4431
4432 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4433 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4434 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4435 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4436 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4437 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4438 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4439
4440 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4441 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4442 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4443 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4444 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4445 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4446 their retry times are tried.
4447
4448 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4449 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4450 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4451 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4452 frozen or not.
4453
4454 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4455 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4456 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4457 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4458 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4459 for later delivery.
4460
4461 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4462 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4463 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4464 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4465 starting message id. For example:
4466 .code
4467 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4468 .endd
4469 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4470 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4471 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4472 .code
4473 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4474 .endd
4475 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4476 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4477 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4478 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4479 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4480 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4481
4482 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4483 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4484 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4485 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4486 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4487 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4488 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4489 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4490 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4491 .code
4492 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4493 .endd
4494 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4495 process every 30 minutes.
4496
4497 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4498 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4499
4500 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4501 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4502 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4503 compatibility.
4504
4505 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4506 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4507 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4508
4509 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4510 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4511 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4512 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4513 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4514 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4515 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4516 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4517 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4518
4519 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4520 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4521 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4522 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4523 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4524 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4525
4526 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4527 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4528 .code
4529 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4530 .endd
4531 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4532 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4533 applied to each queue run.
4534
4535 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4536 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4537 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4538 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4539 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4540 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4541 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4542 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4543 address will be skipped.
4544
4545 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4546 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4547 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4548 &'ff'& is present.
4549
4550 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4551 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4552 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4553 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4554 an arbitrary command instead.
4555
4556 .vitem &%-r%&
4557 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4558 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4559
4560 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4561 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4562 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4563 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4564 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4565 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4566 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4567 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4568
4569 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4570 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4571 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4572 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4573 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4574
4575 .vitem &%-t%&
4576 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4577 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4578 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4579 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4580 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4581 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4582 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4583 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4584 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4585 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4586
4587 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4588 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4589 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4590 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4591 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4592 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4593 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4594 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4595 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4596 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4597 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4598
4599 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4600 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4601 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4602 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4603 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4604 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4605
4606 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4607 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4608 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4609 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4610 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4611 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4612 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4613 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4614 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4615
4616 .vitem &%-ti%&
4617 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4618 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4619 compatibility with Sendmail.
4620
4621 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4622 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4623 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4624 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4625 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4626 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4627 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4628 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4629
4630
4631 .vitem &%-U%&
4632 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4633 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4634 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4635 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4636 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4637 set. Exim ignores this option.
4638
4639 .vitem &%-v%&
4640 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4641 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4642 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4643 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4644 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4645 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4646 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4647 unconditional.
4648
4649 .vitem &%-x%&
4650 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4651 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4652 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4653 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4654 this option.
4655
4656 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4657 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4658 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4659 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4660
4661 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4662 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4663 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4664 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4665 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4666 under most shells.
4667 .endlist
4668
4669 .ecindex IIDclo1
4670 .ecindex IIDclo2
4671
4672
4673 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4674 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4675 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4676 . creates a man page for the options.
4677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4678
4679 .literal xml
4680 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4681 .literal off
4682
4683
4684
4685
4686
4687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4689
4690
4691 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4692 "The runtime configuration file"
4693
4694 .cindex "run time configuration"
4695 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4696 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4697 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4698 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4699 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4700 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4701 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4702 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4703 control.
4704
4705 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4706 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4707 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4708 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4709 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4710 actually alter the string.
4711
4712 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4713 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4714 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4715 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4716 existing file in the list.
4717
4718 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4719 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4720 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4721 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4722 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4723 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4724 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4725 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4726 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4727 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4728 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4729
4730 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4731 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4732 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4733 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4734 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4735
4736 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4737 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4738 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4739 compromise the Exim user account.
4740
4741 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4742 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4743 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4744 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4745 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4746 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4747 configuration.
4748
4749
4750
4751 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4752 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4753 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4754 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4755 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4756 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4757 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4758 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4759 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4760 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4761 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4762
4763 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4764 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4765 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4766 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4767 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4768 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4769 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4770 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4771 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4772 &%-M%&).
4773
4774 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4775 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4776 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4777 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4778 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4779
4780 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4781 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4782 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4783 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4784 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4785 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4786
4787 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4788 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4789 necessarily be discarded.
4790 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4791 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4792 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4793 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4794 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4795 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4796
4797 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4798 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4799 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4800 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4801 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4802 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4803 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4804
4805 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4806 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4807 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4808
4809
4810
4811 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4812 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4813 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4814 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4815 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4816 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4817 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4818 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4819
4820 .ilist
4821 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4822 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4823 .next
4824 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4825 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4826 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4827 .next
4828 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4829 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4830 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4831 .next
4832 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4833 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4834 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4835 .next
4836 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4837 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4838 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4839 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4840 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4841 .next
4842 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4843 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4844 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4845 .next
4846 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4847 want to use this feature, you must set
4848 .code
4849 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4850 .endd
4851 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4852 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4853 .endlist
4854
4855 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4856 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4857 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4858 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4859
4860 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4861 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4862 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4863 and does not introduce a comment.
4864
4865 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4866 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4867 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4868 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4869 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4870
4871 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4872 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4873 change settings as required.
4874
4875 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4876 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4877 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4878 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4879 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4880 described.
4881
4882
4883
4884 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4885 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4886 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4887 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4888 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4889 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4890 using this syntax:
4891 .display
4892 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4893 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4894 .endd
4895 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4896 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4897 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4898 name is required.
4899
4900 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4901 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4902 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4903 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4904
4905 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4906 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4907 for example:
4908 .code
4909 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4910 .include /some/file
4911 .endd
4912 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4913 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4914 inclusion appears.
4915
4916
4917
4918 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4919 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4920 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4921 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4922 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4923 definition, and must be of the form
4924 .display
4925 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4926 .endd
4927 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4928 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4929 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4930 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4931 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4932
4933 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4934 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4935 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4936
4937 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4938 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4939 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4940 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4941 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4942 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4943 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4944 define
4945 .display
4946 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4947 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4948 .endd
4949 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4950 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4951 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4952 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4953 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4954 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4955
4956
4957 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4958 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4959 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4960 &'='&. For example:
4961 .code
4962 MAC = initial value
4963 ...
4964 MAC == updated value
4965 .endd
4966 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4967 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4968 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4969 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4970 .code
4971 MAC = initial value
4972 ...
4973 MAC == MAC and something added
4974 .endd
4975 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4976 from a number of other files.
4977
4978 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4979 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4980 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4981 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4982 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4983 file to be ignored.
4984
4985
4986
4987 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4988 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4989 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4990 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4991 .code
4992 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4993 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4994 .endd
4995 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4996 .code
4997 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4998 .endd
4999 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5000 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5001 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5002
5003
5004 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5005 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5006 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5007 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5008 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5009 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5010 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5011
5012 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5013 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5014 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5015 line. Thus:
5016 .code
5017 .ifdef AAA
5018 message_size_limit = 50M
5019 .else
5020 message_size_limit = 100M
5021 .endif
5022 .endd
5023 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5024 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5025 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5026 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5027 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5028
5029 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5030 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5031 in this line"& will always be true.
5032
5033 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5034 to clarify complicated nestings.
5035
5036
5037
5038 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5039 .cindex "common option syntax"
5040 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5041 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5042 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5043 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5044 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5045 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5046 space) and then the value. For example:
5047 .code
5048 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5049 .endd
5050 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5051 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5052 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5053 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5054 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5055 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5056 word &"hide"&. For example:
5057 .code
5058 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5059 .endd
5060 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5061 .code
5062 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5063 .endd
5064 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5065 all instances of the same driver.
5066
5067 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5068 that are found in option settings.
5069
5070
5071 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5072 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5073 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5074 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5075 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5076 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5077 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5078 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5079 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5080 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5081 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5082 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5083 .code
5084 queue_only
5085 queue_only = true
5086 .endd
5087 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5088 .code
5089 no_queue_only
5090 queue_only = false
5091 .endd
5092 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5093
5094
5095
5096
5097 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5098 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5099 .cindex "format" "integer"
5100 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5101 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5102 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5103 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5104 hexadecimal number.
5105
5106 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5107 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5108 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5109 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5110 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5111 used.
5112
5113
5114 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5115 .cindex "integer format"
5116 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5117 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5118 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5119 Such options are always output in octal.
5120
5121
5122 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5123 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5124 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5125 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5126 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5127
5128
5129
5130 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5131 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5132 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5133 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5134 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5135
5136 .table2 30pt
5137 .irow &%s%& seconds
5138 .irow &%m%& minutes
5139 .irow &%h%& hours
5140 .irow &%d%& days
5141 .irow &%w%& weeks
5142 .endtable
5143
5144 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5145 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5146 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5147
5148
5149
5150 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5151 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5152 .cindex "format" "string"
5153 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5154 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5155 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5156 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5157 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5158 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5159 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5160 therefore equivalent:
5161 .code
5162 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5163 trusted_users = uucp:\
5164 # This comment line is ignored
5165 mail
5166 .endd
5167 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5168 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5169 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5170 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5171 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5172
5173 .table2 100pt
5174 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5175 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5176 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5177 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5178 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5179 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5180 character"
5181 .endtable
5182
5183 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5184 character, that character replaces the pair.
5185
5186 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5187 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5188 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5189 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5190 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5191 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5192
5193
5194 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5195 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5196 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5197 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5198 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5199 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5200 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5201 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5202 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5203 within a quoted configuration string.
5204
5205
5206 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5207 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5208 .cindex "format" "user name"
5209 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5210 .cindex "format" "group name"
5211 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5212 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5213 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5214 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5215
5216
5217 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5218 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5219 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5220 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5221 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5222 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5223 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5224 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5225 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5226 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5227 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5228
5229 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5230 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5231 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5232 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5233 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5234 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5235 example, the list
5236 .code
5237 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5238 .endd
5239 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5240
5241 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5242 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5243 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5244 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5245
5246 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5247 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5248 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5249 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5250 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5251 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5252 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5253 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5254 .code
5255 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5256 .endd
5257 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5258 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5259 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5260
5261 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5262 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5263 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5264 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5265 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5266 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5267 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5268 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5269 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5270 .code
5271 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5272 .endd
5273 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5274 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5275 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5276 the value in quotes. For example:
5277 .code
5278 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5279 .endd
5280 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5281 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5282 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5283 enclosing an empty list item.
5284
5285
5286
5287 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5288 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5289 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5290 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5291 .code
5292 senders = user@domain :
5293 .endd
5294 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5295 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5296 items, the second of which is empty:
5297 .code
5298 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5299 .endd
5300 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5301 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5302 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5303 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5304 .code
5305 senders = :
5306 .endd
5307 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5308 is at the end of the list.
5309
5310
5311
5312
5313 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5314 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5315 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5316 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5317 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5318 a sequence of lines like this:
5319 .display
5320 <&'instance name'&>:
5321 <&'option'&>
5322 ...
5323 <&'option'&>
5324 .endd
5325 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5326 followed by three options settings:
5327 .code
5328 localuser:
5329 driver = accept
5330 check_local_user
5331 transport = local_delivery
5332 .endd
5333 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5334 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5335 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5336 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5337 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5338 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5339
5340 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5341 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5342
5343 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5344 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5345 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5346 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5347 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5348 server.
5349
5350 .cindex "generic options"
5351 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5352 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5353 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5354 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5355 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5356 .cindex "private options"
5357 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5358 they all have default values.
5359
5360 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5361 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5362 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5363
5364 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5365 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5366 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5367 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5368 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5369 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5370 configuration lines:
5371 .code
5372 remote_smtp:
5373 driver = smtp
5374 .endd
5375 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5376 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5377 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5378 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5379 thus:
5380 .code
5381 special_smtp:
5382 driver = smtp
5383 port = 1234
5384 command_timeout = 10s
5385 .endd
5386 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5387 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5388 lines.
5389
5390 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5391 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5392 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5393 option.
5394
5395
5396
5397
5398
5399
5400 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5402
5403 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5404 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5405 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5406 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5407 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5408 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5409 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5410 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5411 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5412 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5413 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5414
5415
5416
5417 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5418 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5419 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5420 the line
5421 .code
5422 # primary_hostname =
5423 .endd
5424 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5425 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5426 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5427 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5428
5429 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5430 .code
5431 domainlist local_domains = @
5432 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5433 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5434 .endd
5435 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5436 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5437 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5438 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5439
5440 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5441 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5442 on the local host.
5443
5444 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5445 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5446 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5447 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5448 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5449 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5450
5451 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5452 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5453 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5454 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5455 domain is permitted.
5456
5457 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5458 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5459 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5460 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5461 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5462 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5463
5464 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5465 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5466 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5467
5468 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5469 .code
5470 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5471 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5472 .endd
5473 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5474 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5475 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5476 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5477 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5478 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5479 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5480 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5481 contents of a message to be checked.
5482
5483 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5484 .code
5485 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5486 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5487 .endd
5488 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5489 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5490 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5491 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5492
5493 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5494 .code
5495 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5496 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5497 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5498 .endd
5499 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5500 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5501 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5502 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5503 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5504 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5505 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5506
5507 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5508 .code
5509 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5510 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5511 .endd
5512 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5513 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5514 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5515 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5516 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5517 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5518 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5519 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5520 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5521 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5522 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5523 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5524 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5525 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5526 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5527 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5528
5529 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5530 .code
5531 # qualify_domain =
5532 # qualify_recipient =
5533 .endd
5534 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5535 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5536 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5537 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5538 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5539 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5540
5541 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5542 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5543 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5544 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5545 .code
5546 # allow_domain_literals
5547 .endd
5548 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5549 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5550 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5551 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5552 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5553 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5554
5555 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5556 .code
5557 never_users = root
5558 .endd
5559 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5560 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5561 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5562 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5563 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5564 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5565 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5566 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5567
5568 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5569 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5570 line,
5571 .code
5572 host_lookup = *
5573 .endd
5574 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5575 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5576 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5577 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5578 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5579 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5580 unreachable.
5581
5582 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5583 1413 (hence their names):
5584 .code
5585 rfc1413_hosts = *
5586 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5587 .endd
5588 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5589 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5590 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5591 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5592 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5593 information, you can change this.
5594
5595 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5596 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5597 .code
5598 prdr_enable = true
5599 .endd
5600
5601 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5602 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5603 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5604 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5605 .code
5606 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5607 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5608 .endd
5609 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5610 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5611
5612 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5613 over the default:
5614 .code
5615 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5616 +tls_certificate_verified
5617 .endd
5618
5619 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5620 .code
5621 # percent_hack_domains =
5622 .endd
5623 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5624 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5625 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5626
5627 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5628 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5629 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5630 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5631 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5632 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5633 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5634 always bounce messages.
5635 .code
5636 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5637 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5638 .endd
5639 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5640 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5641 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5642 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5643 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5644
5645
5646
5647 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5648 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5649 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5650 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5651 It starts with the line
5652 .code
5653 begin acl
5654 .endd
5655 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5656 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5657 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5658
5659 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5660 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5661 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5662 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5663 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5664 result of the ACL processing.
5665 .code
5666 acl_check_rcpt:
5667 .endd
5668 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5669 ACL, and names it.
5670 .code
5671 accept hosts = :
5672 .endd
5673 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5674 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5675 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5676 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5677 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5678 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5679
5680 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5681 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5682 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5683 manner.
5684 .code
5685 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5686 domains = +local_domains
5687 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5688
5689 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5690 domains = !+local_domains
5691 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5692 .endd
5693 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5694 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5695 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5696 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5697 in Internet mail addresses.
5698
5699 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5700 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5701 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5702 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5703 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5704 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5705 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5706 policy of being as safe as possible.
5707
5708 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5709 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5710 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5711 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5712 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5713 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5714
5715 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5716 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5717 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5718 have to modify this rule.
5719
5720 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5721 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5722 common convention of local parts constructed as
5723 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5724 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5725 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5726 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5727 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5728 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5729
5730 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5731 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5732 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5733 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5734 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5735 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5736 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5737 .code
5738 accept local_parts = postmaster
5739 domains = +local_domains
5740 .endd
5741 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5742 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5743 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5744 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5745 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5746
5747 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5748 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5749 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5750 .code
5751 require verify = sender
5752 .endd
5753 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5754 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5755 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5756 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5757 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5758 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5759 discusses the details of address verification.
5760 .code
5761 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5762 control = submission
5763 .endd
5764 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5765 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5766 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5767 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5768 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5769 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5770 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5771 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5772 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5773 .code
5774 accept authenticated = *
5775 control = submission
5776 .endd
5777 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5778 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5779 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5780 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5781 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5782 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5783 .code
5784 require message = relay not permitted
5785 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5786 .endd
5787 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5788 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5789 .code
5790 require verify = recipient
5791 .endd
5792 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5793 fails, the address is rejected.
5794 .code
5795 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5796 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5797 # $dnslist_text
5798 # dnslists = black.list.example
5799 #
5800 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5801 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5802 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5803 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5804 .endd
5805 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5806 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5807 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5808 line.
5809 .code
5810 # require verify = csa
5811 .endd
5812 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5813 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5814 records.
5815 .code
5816 accept
5817 .endd
5818 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5819 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5820 .code
5821 acl_check_data:
5822 .endd
5823 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5824 of this ACL are commented out:
5825 .code
5826 # deny malware = *
5827 # message = This message contains a virus \
5828 # ($malware_name).
5829 .endd
5830 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5831 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5832 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5833 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5834 .code
5835 # warn spam = nobody
5836 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5837 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5838 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5839 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5840 .endd
5841 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5842 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5843 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5844 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5845 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5846 whatever the spam score.
5847 .code
5848 accept
5849 .endd
5850 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5851
5852
5853 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5854 .cindex "default" "routers"
5855 .cindex "routers" "default"
5856 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5857 by the line
5858 .code
5859 begin routers
5860 .endd
5861 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5862 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5863 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5864 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5865 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5866 .code
5867 # domain_literal:
5868 # driver = ipliteral
5869 # domains = !+local_domains
5870 # transport = remote_smtp
5871 .endd
5872 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5873 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5874 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5875 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5876 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5877 .code
5878 dnslookup:
5879 driver = dnslookup
5880 domains = ! +local_domains
5881 transport = remote_smtp
5882 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5883 no_more
5884 .endd
5885 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5886 domains. This is specified by the line
5887 .code
5888 domains = ! +local_domains
5889 .endd
5890 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5891 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5892 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5893 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5894 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5895 passed on to the following routers.
5896
5897 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5898 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5899 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5900 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5901 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5902
5903 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5904 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5905 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5906 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5907 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5908 the address fails and is bounced.
5909
5910 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5911 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5912 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5913 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5914 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5915 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5916 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5917 out.
5918 .code
5919 system_aliases:
5920 driver = redirect
5921 allow_fail
5922 allow_defer
5923 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5924 # user = exim
5925 file_transport = address_file
5926 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5927 .endd
5928 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5929 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5930 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5931 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5932 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5933 the next router.
5934
5935 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5936 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5937 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5938 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5939 .code
5940 userforward:
5941 driver = redirect
5942 check_local_user
5943 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5944 # local_part_suffix_optional
5945 file = $home/.forward
5946 # allow_filter
5947 no_verify
5948 no_expn
5949 check_ancestor
5950 file_transport = address_file
5951 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5952 reply_transport = address_reply
5953 .endd
5954 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5955 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5956 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5957 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5958 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5959 namely:
5960 .code
5961 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5962 # local_part_suffix_optional
5963 .endd
5964 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5965 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5966 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5967 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5968 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5969 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5970 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5971
5972 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5973 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5974 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5975 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5976
5977 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5978 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5979 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5980 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5981 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5982 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5983 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5984
5985 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5986 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5987 There are two reasons for doing this:
5988
5989 .olist
5990 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5991 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5992 unnecessary work.
5993 .next
5994 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5995 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5996 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5997 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5998 this time.
5999 .endlist
6000
6001 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6002 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6003 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6004 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6005
6006 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6007 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6008 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6009 .code
6010 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6011 .endd
6012 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6013 transport.
6014 .code
6015 localuser:
6016 driver = accept
6017 check_local_user
6018 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6019 # local_part_suffix_optional
6020 transport = local_delivery
6021 .endd
6022 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6023 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6024 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6025 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6026 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6027
6028
6029 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6030 .cindex "default" "transports"
6031 .cindex "transports" "default"
6032 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6033 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6034 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6035 .code
6036 begin transports
6037 .endd
6038 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6039 .code
6040 remote_smtp:
6041 driver = smtp
6042 hosts_try_prdr = *
6043 .endd
6044 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6045 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6046 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6047 It is negotiated between client and server
6048 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6049 All other options are defaulted.
6050 .code
6051 local_delivery:
6052 driver = appendfile
6053 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6054 delivery_date_add
6055 envelope_to_add
6056 return_path_add
6057 # group = mail
6058 # mode = 0660
6059 .endd
6060 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6061 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6062 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6063 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6064 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6065 show how this can be done.
6066
6067 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6068 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6069 similarly-named options above.
6070 .code
6071 address_pipe:
6072 driver = pipe
6073 return_output
6074 .endd
6075 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6076 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6077 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6078 be returned to the sender.
6079 .code
6080 address_file:
6081 driver = appendfile
6082 delivery_date_add
6083 envelope_to_add
6084 return_path_add
6085 .endd
6086 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6087 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6088 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6089 .code
6090 address_reply:
6091 driver = autoreply
6092 .endd
6093 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6094 filter files.
6095
6096
6097
6098 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6099 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6100 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6101 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6102 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6103 introduced by the line
6104 .code
6105 begin retry
6106 .endd
6107 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6108 errors:
6109 .code
6110 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6111 .endd
6112 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6113 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6114 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6115 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6116
6117 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6118 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6119 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6120
6121
6122 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6123 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6124 .code
6125 begin rewrite
6126 .endd
6127 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6128 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6129
6130
6131
6132 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6133 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6134 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6135 .code
6136 begin authenticators
6137 .endd
6138 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6139 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6140 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6141 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6142 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6143 to support most MUA software.
6144
6145 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6146 .code
6147 #PLAIN:
6148 # driver = plaintext
6149 # server_set_id = $auth2
6150 # server_prompts = :
6151 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6152 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6153 .endd
6154 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6155 .code
6156 #LOGIN:
6157 # driver = plaintext
6158 # server_set_id = $auth1
6159 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6160 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6161 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6162 .endd
6163
6164 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6165 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6166 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6167 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6168 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6169 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6170 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6171 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6172
6173 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6174 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6175 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6176 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6177
6178 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6179 usercode and password are in different positions.
6180 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6181
6182 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6183
6184
6185
6186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6187 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6188
6189 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6190
6191 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6192 .cindex "PCRE"
6193 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6194 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6195 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6196 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6197 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6198 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6199
6200 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6201 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6202 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6203 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6204 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6205 case-insensitive.
6206
6207 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6208 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6209 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6210 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6211 .code
6212 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6213 .endd
6214 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6215 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6216 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6217 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6218 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6219 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6220 matched.
6221
6222 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6223 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6224 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6225 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6226 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6227 match anywhere in the subject string.
6228
6229 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6230 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6231 .code
6232 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6233 .endd
6234 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6235 You need to use:
6236 .code
6237 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6238 .endd
6239 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6240 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6241
6242
6243
6244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6246
6247 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6248 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6249 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6250 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6251 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6252 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6253
6254 .olist
6255 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6256 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6257 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6258 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6259 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6260 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6261 .next
6262 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6263 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6264 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6265 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6266 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6267 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6268 .endlist
6269
6270 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6271 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6272 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6273 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6274 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6275 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6276
6277 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6278 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6279 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6280 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6281 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6282 .code
6283 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6284 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6285 .endd
6286 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6287 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6288 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6289 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6290 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6291 .code
6292 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6293 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6294 .endd
6295 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6296 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6297
6298 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6299 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6300 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6301 .code
6302 domain1:
6303 domain2:
6304 .endd
6305 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6306 matches the list item.
6307
6308 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6309 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6310 .code
6311 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6312 .endd
6313 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6314 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6315 causes a second lookup to occur.
6316
6317 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6318 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6319 lookup is permitted.
6320
6321
6322 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6323 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6324 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6325 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6326
6327 .ilist
6328 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6329 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6330 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6331 .next
6332 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6333 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6334 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6335 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6336 .endlist
6337
6338 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6339 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6340 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6341 .code
6342 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6343 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6344 .endd
6345 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6346 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6347 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6348
6349
6350
6351
6352 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6353 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6354 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6355 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6356
6357 .ilist
6358 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6359 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6360 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6361 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6362 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6363 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6364 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6365 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6366 be found in several places:
6367 .display
6368 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6369 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6370 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6371 .endd
6372 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6373 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6374 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6375 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6376 .next
6377 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6378 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6379 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6380 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6381 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6382 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6383 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6384
6385 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6386 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6387 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6388 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6389 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6390 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6391 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6392 .next
6393 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6394 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6395 .cindex "sasldb2"
6396 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6397 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6398 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6399 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6400 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6401 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6402 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6403 .next
6404 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6405 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6406 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6407 .cindex "Courier"
6408 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6409 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6410 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6411 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6412 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6413 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6414 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6415 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6416 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6417 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6418 .next
6419 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6420 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6421 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6422 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6423 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6424 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6425 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6426 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6427 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6428 .next
6429 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6430 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6431 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6432 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6433 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6434 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6435 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6436 .code
6437 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6438 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6439 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6440 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6441 .endd
6442 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6443 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6444 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6445 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6446 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6447
6448 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6449 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6450 lookup types support only literal keys.
6451
6452 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6453 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6454 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6455 .next
6456 .cindex "linear search"
6457 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6458 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6459 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6460 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6461 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6462 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6463 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6464 in the file is used.
6465
6466 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6467 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6468 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6469 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6470 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6471 colon, for example:
6472 .code
6473 baduser: :fail:
6474 .endd
6475 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6476 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6477 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6478 wildcarding of any kind.
6479
6480 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6481 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6482 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6483 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6484 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6485 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6486 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6487 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6488 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6489
6490 .next
6491 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6492 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6493 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6494 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6495 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6496 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6497 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6498 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6499
6500 .next
6501 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6502 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6503 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6504 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6505 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6506 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6507 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6508 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6509 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6510
6511 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6512 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6513 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6514 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6515
6516 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6517 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6518
6519 .olist
6520 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6521 .code
6522 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6523 *fish data for anythingfish
6524 .endd
6525 .next
6526 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6527 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6528 .code
6529 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6530 .endd
6531 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6532 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6533 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6534 .code
6535 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6536 .endd
6537 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6538 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6539 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6540 .code
6541 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6542 .endd
6543
6544 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6545 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6546 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6547 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6548 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6549
6550 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6551 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6552 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6553 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6554 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6555
6556 .next
6557 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6558 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6559 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6560 example:
6561 .code
6562 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6563 .endd
6564 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6565 .endlist olist
6566
6567 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6568 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6569 be followed by optional colons.
6570
6571 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6572 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6573 lookup types support only literal keys.
6574 .endlist ilist
6575
6576
6577 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6579 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6580 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6581 many of them are given in later sections.
6582
6583 .ilist
6584 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6585 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6586 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6587 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6588 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6589 .next
6590 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6591 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6592 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6593 .next
6594 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6595 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6596 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6597 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6598 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6599 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6600 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6601 .next
6602 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6603 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6604 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6605 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6606 .next
6607 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6608 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6609 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6610 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6611 .next
6612 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6613 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6614 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6615 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6616 .next
6617 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6618 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6619 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6620 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6621 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6622 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6623 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6624 password value. For example:
6625 .code
6626 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6627 .endd
6628 .next
6629 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6630 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6631 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6632 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6633
6634 .next
6635 .new
6636 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6637 .cindex lookup Redis
6638 &(redis)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6639 Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6640 .wen
6641
6642 .next
6643 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6644 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6645 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6646 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6647
6648 .next
6649 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6650 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6651 .next
6652 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6653 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6654 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6655 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6656 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6657 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6658 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6659 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6660 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6661 .code
6662 require condition = \
6663 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6664 .endd
6665 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6666 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6667 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6668 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6669 .endlist
6670
6671
6672
6673 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6674 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6675 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6676 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6677 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6678 options such as a list of local domains.
6679
6680 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6681 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6682 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6683 or may give up altogether.
6684
6685
6686
6687 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6688 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6689 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6690 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6691 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6692 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6693 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6694 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6695
6696 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6697 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6698 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6699
6700 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6701 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6702 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6703
6704 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6705 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6706 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6707 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6708 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6709 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6710 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6711 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6712 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6713 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6714 .code
6715 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6716 .endd
6717 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6718 looks up these keys, in this order:
6719 .code
6720 jane@eyre.example
6721 *@eyre.example
6722 *
6723 .endd
6724 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6725 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6726 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6727 Exim move on to try the next key.
6728
6729
6730
6731 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6732 .cindex "partial matching"
6733 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6734 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6735 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6736 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6737 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6738 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6739 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6740 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6741 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6742 a key in a DBM file is
6743 .code
6744 *.dates.fict.example
6745 .endd
6746 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6747 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6748 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6749 file.
6750
6751 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6752 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6753 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6754
6755 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6756 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6757 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6758 partial matching keys
6759 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6760 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6761 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6762
6763 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6764 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6765 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6766 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6767 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6768 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6769 remains.
6770
6771 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6772 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6773 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6774 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6775 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6776 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6777 .code
6778 2250.dates.fict.example
6779 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6780 *.dates.fict.example
6781 *.fict.example
6782 .endd
6783 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6784 finishes.
6785
6786 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6787 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6788 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6789 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6790 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6791 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6792 .code
6793 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6794 .endd
6795 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6796 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6797 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6798 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6799 .code
6800 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6801 .endd
6802 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6803 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6804
6805 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6806 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6807 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6808
6809 .ilist
6810 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6811 .next
6812 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6813 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6814 .next
6815 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6816 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6817 for &"*"& on its own.
6818 .next
6819 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6820 .endlist
6821
6822
6823 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6824 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6825 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6826 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6827 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6828 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6829 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6830
6831 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6832 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6833 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6834 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6835 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6836
6837
6838
6839
6840 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6842 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6843 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6844 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6845 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6846 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6847
6848 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6849 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6850 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6851 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6852 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6853 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6854
6855 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6856 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6857 complete.
6858
6859
6860
6861
6862 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6863 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6864 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6865 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6866 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6867 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6868 .code
6869 [name=$local_part]
6870 .endd
6871 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6872 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6873 .code
6874 [name="$local_part"]
6875 .endd
6876 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6877 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6878 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6879 of the following form is provided:
6880 .code
6881 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6882 .endd
6883 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6884 .code
6885 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6886 .endd
6887 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6888 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6889 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6890
6891
6892
6893
6894 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6895 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6896 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6897 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6898 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6899 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6900 an expansion string could contain:
6901 .code
6902 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6903 .endd
6904 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6905 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6906 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6907 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6908
6909 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6910 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6911 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6912
6913 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6914 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6915 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6916 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6917 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6918 .code
6919 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6920 .endd
6921 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6922 white space is ignored.
6923 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6924 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6925 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6926
6927 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6928 When the type is PTR,
6929 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6930 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6931 .code
6932 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6933 .endd
6934 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6935 altered and nothing is added.
6936
6937 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6938 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6939 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6940 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6941 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6942 The field separator can be modified as above.
6943
6944 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6945 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6946 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6947 unless a field separator is specified.
6948 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6949 For SPF records the
6950 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6951 .code
6952 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6953 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6954 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6955 .endd
6956 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6957 white space is ignored.
6958
6959 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6960 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6961 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6962 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6963 specified.
6964 .code
6965 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6966 .endd
6967
6968 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6969 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6970 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6971 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6972 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6973 each followed by a comma,
6974 that may appear before the record type.
6975
6976 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6977 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6978 a defer-option modifier.
6979 The possible keywords are
6980 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6981 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6982 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6983 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6984 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6985 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6986 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6987 .code
6988 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6989 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6990 .endd
6991 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6992 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6993
6994 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6995 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6996 The possible keywords are
6997 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6998 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6999 with the lookup.
7000 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7001 is not labelled as authenticated data
7002 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7003 The default is &"never"&.
7004
7005 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7006
7007 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7008 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7009 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7010 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7011 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7012 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7013
7014 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7015 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7016 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7017
7018 .new
7019 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7020 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7021 .cindex DNS TTL
7022 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7023 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7024 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7025 .wen
7026
7027
7028 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7029 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7030 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7031 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7032 the pseudo-type MXH:
7033 .code
7034 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7035 .endd
7036 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7037 returned.
7038
7039 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7040 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7041 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7042 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7043 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7044 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7045 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7046 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7047 .code
7048 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7049 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7050 .endd
7051 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7052 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7053 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7054
7055 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7056 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7057 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7058 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7059 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7060 such a list.
7061
7062 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7063 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7064 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7065 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7066 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7067 result of a successful lookup such as:
7068 .code
7069 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7070 .endd
7071 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7072 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7073 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7074
7075 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7076 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7077 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7078 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7079 .code
7080 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7081 .endd
7082
7083
7084 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7085 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7086 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7087 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7088 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7089 .code
7090 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7091 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7092 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7093 .endd
7094 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7095 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7096 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7097 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7098
7099 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7100 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7101 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7102
7103
7104
7105
7106 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7107 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7108 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7109 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7110 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7111 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7112 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7113 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7114 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7115 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7116 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7117 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7118 .code
7119 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7120 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7121 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7122 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7123 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7124 .endd
7125 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7126 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7127
7128 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7129 the way they handle the results of a query:
7130
7131 .ilist
7132 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7133 gives an error.
7134 .next
7135 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7136 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7137 .next
7138 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7139 from all of them are returned.
7140 .endlist
7141
7142
7143 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7144 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7145 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7146 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7147
7148
7149 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7150 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7151 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7152 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7153 .code
7154 data = ${lookup ldap \
7155 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7156 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7157 .endd
7158 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7159 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7160 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7161 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7162
7163 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7164 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7165 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7166
7167 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7168 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7169 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7170 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7171 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7172 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7173 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7174 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7175 &_exim.conf_&.
7176
7177
7178 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7179 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7180 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7181 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7182 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7183 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7184
7185 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7186 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7187 the string:
7188 .code
7189 * => \2A
7190 ( => \28
7191 ) => \29
7192 \ => \5C
7193 .endd
7194 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7195 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7196 .code
7197 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7198 .endd
7199 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7200 .code
7201 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7202 .endd
7203 yields
7204 .code
7205 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7206 .endd
7207 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7208 .code
7209 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7210 .endd
7211 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7212 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7213 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7214 .code
7215 , + " \ < > ;
7216 .endd
7217 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7218 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7219 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7220 .code
7221 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7222 .endd
7223 yields
7224 .code
7225 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7226 .endd
7227 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7228 .code
7229 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7230 .endd
7231 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7232 authentication below.
7233
7234
7235 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7236 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7237 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7238 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7239 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7240 by starting it with
7241 .code
7242 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7243 .endd
7244 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7245 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7246 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7247 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7248 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7249 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7250 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7251 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7252 failures, and timeouts.
7253
7254 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7255 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7256 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7257 doubled. For example
7258 .code
7259 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7260 .endd
7261 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7262 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7263 the local host) is used.
7264
7265 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7266 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7267 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7268 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7269 not available.
7270
7271 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7272 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7273 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7274 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7275 .code
7276 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7277 .endd
7278 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7279 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7280 .code
7281 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7282 .endd
7283 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7284 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7285 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7286 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7287 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7288 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7289 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7290 backup host.
7291
7292 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7293 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7294 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7295
7296 .ilist
7297 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7298 interface.
7299 .next
7300 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7301 .endlist
7302
7303
7304 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7305 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7306
7307
7308
7309 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7310 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7311 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7312 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7313 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7314 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7315 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7316 them. The following names are recognized:
7317 .display
7318 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7319 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7320 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7321 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7322 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7323 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7324 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7325 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7326 .endd
7327 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7328 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7329 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7330 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7331
7332 .cindex LDAP timeout
7333 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7334 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7335 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7336 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7337 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7338 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7339 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7340 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7341 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7342 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7343
7344 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7345 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7346
7347 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7348 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7349 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7350 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7351 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7352 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7353 alternate list (colon-separated).
7354
7355 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7356 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7357 .code
7358 ${lookup ldap
7359 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7360 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7361 {$value}fail}
7362 .endd
7363 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7364 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7365 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7366 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7367
7368 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7369 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7370 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7371
7372 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7373 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7374 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7375 quoting has two advantages:
7376
7377 .ilist
7378 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7379 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7380 .next
7381 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7382 .endlist
7383
7384 For example, a setting such as
7385 .code
7386 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7387 .endd
7388 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7389
7390 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7391 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7392 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7393 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7394 .code
7395 PASS=${quote:$3}
7396 .endd
7397 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7398 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7399 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7400
7401
7402
7403 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7404 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7405 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7406 as a sequence of values, for example
7407 .code
7408 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7409 .endd
7410 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7411 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7412 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7413 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7414 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7415 directory.
7416
7417 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7418 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7419 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7420 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7421
7422 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7423 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7424 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7425 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7426 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7427 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7428 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7429 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7430 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7431
7432 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7433 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7434 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7435 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7436 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7437
7438 .code
7439 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7440 value1.1,value1,,2
7441
7442 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7443 value two
7444
7445 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7446 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7447
7448 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7449 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7450
7451 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7452 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7453 .endd
7454 You can
7455 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7456 results of LDAP lookups.
7457 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7458 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7459 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7460 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7461 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7462 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7463
7464
7465
7466
7467 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7468 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7469 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7470 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7471 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7472 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7473 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7474 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7475 .code
7476 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7477 .endd
7478 might return the string
7479 .code
7480 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7481 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7482 .endd
7483 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7484 .code
7485 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7486 .endd
7487 would just return
7488 .code
7489 Martin Guerre
7490 .endd
7491 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7492 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7493 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7494
7495
7496
7497 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7498 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7499 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7500 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7501 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7502 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7503 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7504 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7505 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7506 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7507 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7508 .cindex lookup Redis
7509 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7510 and SQLite
7511 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7512 might be
7513 .code
7514 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7515 {$value}fail}
7516 .endd
7517 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7518 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7519 .code
7520 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7521 {$value}}
7522 .endd
7523 might be
7524 .code
7525 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7526 .endd
7527 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7528 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7529 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7530 .code
7531 Mister X
7532 .endd
7533 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7534 with a newline between the data for each row.
7535
7536
7537 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7538 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7539 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7540 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7541 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7542 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7543 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7544 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7545 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7546 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7547 .cindex lookup Redis
7548 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7549 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7550 or &%redis_servers%&
7551 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7552 information.
7553 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7554 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7555 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7556 For all but Redis
7557 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7558 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7559 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7560 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7561 .code
7562 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7563 .endd
7564 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7565 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7566 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7567 .code
7568 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7569 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7570 .endd
7571 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7572 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7573 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7574 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7575 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7576 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7577
7578 .new
7579 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7580 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7581 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7582 information.
7583 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7584 host, database number, and password.
7585 .olist
7586 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7587 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7588 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7589 .next
7590 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7591 .next
7592 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7593 .endlist
7594 .wen
7595
7596 .new
7597 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7598 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7599 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7600 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7601
7602 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7603 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7604 .wen
7605
7606 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7607 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7608 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7609 done by starting the query with
7610 .display
7611 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7612 .endd
7613 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7614 .olist
7615 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7616 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7617 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7618 taken from there.
7619 .next
7620 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7621 .endlist
7622 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7623 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7624 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7625
7626 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7627 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7628 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7629 like this:
7630 .code
7631 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7632 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7633 master/db/name/pw
7634 .endd
7635 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7636 .code
7637 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7638 .endd
7639 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7640 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7641 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7642 .code
7643 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7644 .endd
7645
7646
7647 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7648 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7649 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7650 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7651 .new
7652 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7653 the default value is &"exim"&.
7654 .wen
7655 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7656 .display
7657 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7658 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7659 .endd
7660 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7661 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7662
7663 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7664 the queries.
7665
7666 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7667 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7668
7669 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7670 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7671 is zero because no rows are affected.
7672
7673
7674 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7675 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7676 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7677 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7678 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7679 looks like this:
7680 .code
7681 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7682 .endd
7683 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7684 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7685 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7686
7687 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7688 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7689 affected.
7690
7691 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7692 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7693 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7694 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7695 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7696 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7697 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7698 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7699 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7700 .code
7701 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7702 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7703 .endd
7704 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7705 .code
7706 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7707 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7708 .endd
7709 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7710 quote, which it doubles.
7711
7712 .cindex timeout SQLite
7713 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7714 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7715 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7716 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7717 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7718 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7719 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7720 option.
7721 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7722 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7723
7724
7725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7727
7728 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7729 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7730 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7731 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7732 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7733 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7734 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7735 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7736 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7737
7738 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7739 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7740 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7741 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7742
7743 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7744 support all the complexity available in
7745 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7746
7747
7748
7749 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7750 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7751 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7752 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7753 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7754 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7755 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7756 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7757
7758
7759 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7760 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7761 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7762
7763 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7764 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7765 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7766 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7767 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7768 .code
7769 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7770 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7771 .endd
7772 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7773 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7774 senders based on the receiving domain.
7775
7776
7777
7778
7779 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7780 .cindex "list" "negation"
7781 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7782 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7783 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7784 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7785 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7786 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7787
7788 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7789 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7790 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7791 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7792 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7793 .code
7794 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7795 .endd
7796 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7797 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7798 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7799 .code
7800 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7801 .endd
7802 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7803 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7804 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7805
7806 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7807 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7808 item.
7809
7810
7811
7812 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7813 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7814 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7815 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7816 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7817 file names are not allowed,
7818 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7819 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7820 lines:
7821
7822 .ilist
7823 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7824 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7825 .next
7826 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7827 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7828 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7829 .code
7830 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7831 .endd
7832 .endlist
7833
7834 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7835 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7836 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7837 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7838
7839 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7840 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7841 .code
7842 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7843 .endd
7844 and the file contains the lines
7845 .code
7846 !a.b.c
7847 *.b.c
7848 .endd
7849 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7850 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7851
7852
7853
7854 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7855 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7856 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7857 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7858 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7859 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7860 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7861 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7862
7863 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7864 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7865 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7866 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7867
7868
7869
7870
7871 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7872 .cindex "named lists"
7873 .cindex "list" "named"
7874 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7875 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7876 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7877 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7878 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7879 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7880 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7881 .code
7882 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7883 .endd
7884 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7885 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7886 configured with the line
7887 .code
7888 domains = +local_domains
7889 .endd
7890 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7891 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7892 .code
7893 dnslookup:
7894 driver = dnslookup
7895 domains = ! +local_domains
7896 transport = remote_smtp
7897 no_more
7898 .endd
7899 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7900 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7901 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7902 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7903 .code
7904 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7905 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7906 .endd
7907 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7908 .code
7909 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7910 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7911 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7912 .endd
7913 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7914 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7915 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7916 .code
7917 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7918 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7919 .endd
7920 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7921 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7922 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7923 .code
7924 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7925 .endd
7926 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7927 referenced lists if you can.
7928
7929 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7930 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7931 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7932 .code
7933 domains = +local_domains
7934 .endd
7935 on several of your routers
7936 or in several ACL statements,
7937 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7938 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7939 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7940 the same each time they are referenced.
7941
7942 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7943 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7944 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7945 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7946
7947
7948
7949 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7950 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7951 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7952 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7953 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7954 write
7955 .code
7956 ALIST = host1 : host2
7957 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7958 .endd
7959 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7960 .code
7961 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7962 .endd
7963 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7964 list, and write
7965 .code
7966 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7967 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7968 .endd
7969 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7970 .code
7971 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7972 .endd
7973
7974
7975 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7976 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7977 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7978 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7979 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7980 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7981 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7982 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7983 message. For example:
7984 .code
7985 domainlist special_domains = \
7986 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7987 .endd
7988 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7989 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7990 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7991 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7992 same list each time.
7993
7994 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7995 cache the result anyway. For example:
7996 .code
7997 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7998 .endd
7999 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8000 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8001
8002
8003
8004 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8005 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8006 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8007 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8008 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8009
8010 .ilist
8011 .cindex "primary host name"
8012 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8013 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8014 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8015 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8016 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8017 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8018 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8019 differ only in their names.
8020 .next
8021 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8022 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8023 .cindex "domain literal"
8024 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8025 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8026 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8027 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8028 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8029 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8030 .next
8031 .cindex "@mx_any"
8032 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8033 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8034 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8035 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8036 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8037 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8038 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8039 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8040 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8041 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8042 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8043
8044 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8045 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8046 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8047 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8048 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8049
8050 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8051 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8052 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8053 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8054 on a router). For example:
8055 .code
8056 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8057 .endd
8058 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8059 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8060
8061 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8062 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8063 contain negative items.
8064
8065 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8066 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8067 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8068 .code
8069 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8070 an.other.domain : ...
8071 .endd
8072 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8073 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8074 .code
8075 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8076 an.other.domain ? ...
8077 .endd
8078 .next
8079 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8080 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8081 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8082 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8083 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8084 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8085 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8086 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8087 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8088 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8089
8090 .next
8091 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8092 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8093 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8094 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8095 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8096 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8097 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8098 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8099 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8100
8101 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8102 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8103 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8104 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8105 expression by expansion, of course).
8106 .next
8107 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8108 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8109 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8110 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8111 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8112 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8113 .code
8114 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8115 .endd
8116 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8117 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8118 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8119 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8120 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8121 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8122 other statements in the same ACL.
8123
8124 .next
8125 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8126 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8127 .code
8128 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8129 .endd
8130 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8131 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8132
8133 .next
8134 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8135 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8136 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8137 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8138 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8139 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8140 expansion variable.
8141 .next
8142 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8143 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8144 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8145 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8146 .code
8147 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8148 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8149 .endd
8150 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8151 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8152 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8153 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8154 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8155 .next
8156 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8157 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8158 between the pattern and the domain.
8159 .endlist
8160
8161 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8162 .code
8163 domainlist funny_domains = \
8164 @ : \
8165 lib.unseen.edu : \
8166 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8167 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8168 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8169 nis;domains.byname : \
8170 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8171 .endd
8172 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8173 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8174 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8175 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8176 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8177 patterns earlier.
8178
8179
8180
8181 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8182 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8183 .cindex "list" "host list"
8184 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8185 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8186 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8187 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8188 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8189 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8190 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8191
8192
8193 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8194 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8195 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8196 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8197 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8198 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8199 not used.
8200
8201 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8202 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8203 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8204
8205
8206
8207 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8208 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8209 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8210 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8211 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8212 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8213 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8214 concerns.)
8215
8216 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8217 inspecting its IP address:
8218
8219 .ilist
8220 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8221 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8222 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8223 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8224 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8225 with the IP address of the subject host.
8226
8227 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8228 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8229 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8230 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8231 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8232
8233 .next
8234 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8235 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8236 domain name, as just described.
8237
8238 .next
8239 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8240 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8241 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8242 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8243 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8244 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8245 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8246 that can never match a client host.
8247
8248 .next
8249 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8250 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8251 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8252 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8253 .code
8254 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8255 accept hosts = @[]
8256 .endd
8257 .next
8258 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8259 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8260 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8261 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8262 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8263 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8264 significant end of the address.
8265
8266 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8267 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8268 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8269 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8270 .code
8271 192.168.23.236/31
8272 .endd
8273 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8274 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8275 matches.
8276
8277 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8278 .code
8279 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8280 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8281 .endd
8282 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8283 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8284 For example:
8285 .code
8286 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8287 .endd
8288 could make use of a file containing
8289 .code
8290 172.16.0.0/12
8291 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8292 .endd
8293 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8294 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8295 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8296 .code
8297 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8298 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8299 .endd
8300 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8301 list.
8302 .endlist
8303
8304
8305
8306 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8307 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8308 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8309 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8310 address, the pattern takes this form:
8311 .display
8312 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8313 .endd
8314 For example:
8315 .code
8316 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8317 .endd
8318 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8319 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8320 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8321 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8322 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8323 returned by the lookup is not used.
8324
8325 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8326 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8327 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8328 patterns of this form:
8329 .display
8330 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8331 .endd
8332 For example:
8333 .code
8334 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8335 .endd
8336 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8337 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8338 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8339 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8340 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8341
8342 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8343 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8344 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8345 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8346 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8347 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8348 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8349 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8350 addresses are always used.
8351
8352 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8353 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8354 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8355 configurations.
8356
8357 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8358 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8359 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8360 case the IP address is used on its own.
8361
8362
8363
8364 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8365 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8366 .cindex "unknown host name"
8367 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8368 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8369 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8370 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8371 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8372 above.)
8373
8374 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8375 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8376 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8377 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8378 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8379 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8380 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8381
8382 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8383 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8384
8385 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8386 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8387 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8388 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8389 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8390 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8391 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8392 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8393 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8394
8395 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8396 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8397
8398 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8399 .cindex "alias for host"
8400 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8401 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8402
8403 .ilist
8404 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8405 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8406 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8407 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8408 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8409 expression.
8410 .next
8411 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8412 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8413 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8414 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8415 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8416 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8417 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8418 example,
8419 .code
8420 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8421 .endd
8422 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8423 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8424 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8425 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8426 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8427 .code
8428 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8429 .endd
8430 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8431 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8432 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8433 required.
8434 .endlist
8435
8436
8437
8438
8439 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8440 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8441 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8442 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8443 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8444 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8445
8446 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8447 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8448
8449 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8450 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8451 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8452 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8453 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8454 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8455 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8456 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8457 not recognized in an indirected file).
8458
8459 .ilist
8460 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8461 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8462 .code
8463 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8464 .endd
8465 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8466 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8467
8468 .next
8469 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8470 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8471 example:
8472 .code
8473 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8474 192.168.4.5
8475 .endd
8476 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8477 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8478 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8479 .endlist
8480
8481 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8482 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8483 list.
8484
8485 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8486 "SECTmixwilhos"
8487 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8488
8489 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8490 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8491 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8492
8493 .ilist
8494 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8495 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8496 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8497 .code
8498 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8499 .endd
8500 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8501 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8502 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8503 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8504 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8505 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8506 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8507
8508 .next
8509 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8510 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8511 .code
8512 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8513 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8514 .endd
8515 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8516 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8517 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8518 this section.
8519 .endlist
8520
8521
8522 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8523 "SECTtemdnserr"
8524 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8525 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8526 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8527 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8528 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8529 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8530 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8531 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8532 host lists such as whitelists.
8533
8534
8535
8536 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8537 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8538 .cindex "unknown host name"
8539 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8540 If a pattern is of the form
8541 .display
8542 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8543 .endd
8544 for example
8545 .code
8546 dbm;/host/accept/list
8547 .endd
8548 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8549 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8550 is not used.
8551
8552 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8553 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8554 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8555 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8556 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8557 lookup, both using the same file.
8558
8559
8560
8561 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8562 If a pattern is of the form
8563 .display
8564 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8565 .endd
8566 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8567 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8568 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8569 .code
8570 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8571 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8572 .endd
8573 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8574 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8575 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8576 operator.
8577
8578 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8579 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8580 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8581
8582 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8583 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8584 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8585 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8586 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8587 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8588
8589
8590
8591
8592
8593 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8594 .cindex "list" "address list"
8595 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8596 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8597 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8598 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8599 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8600 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8601 using this option setting:
8602 .code
8603 senders = :
8604 .endd
8605 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8606 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8607 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8608 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8609
8610 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8611 example:
8612 .code
8613 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8614 .endd
8615 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8616 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8617 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8618 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8619 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8620 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8621 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8622 .code
8623 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8624 *@+hostile_domains:\
8625 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8626 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8627 .endd
8628 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8629 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8630 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8631 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8632 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8633
8634 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8635 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8636 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8637 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8638 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8639 .code
8640 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8641 .endd
8642
8643 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8644 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8645 senders:
8646
8647 .ilist
8648 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8649 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8650 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8651 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8652 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8653 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8654 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8655 .code
8656 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8657 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8658 .endd
8659 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8660 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8661
8662 .next
8663 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8664 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8665 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8666 example:
8667 .code
8668 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8669 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8670 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8671 .endd
8672 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8673 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8674 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8675 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8676
8677 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8678 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8679 panic log.
8680 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8681 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8682 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8683 default. For example, with this lookup:
8684 .code
8685 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8686 .endd
8687 the file could contains lines like this:
8688 .code
8689 user1@domain1.example
8690 *@domain2.example
8691 .endd
8692 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8693 that are tried is:
8694 .code
8695 nimrod@jaeger.example
8696 *@jaeger.example
8697 *
8698 .endd
8699 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8700 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8701
8702 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8703 .code
8704 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8705 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8706 .endd
8707 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8708 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8709 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8710 .endlist
8711
8712
8713 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8714 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8715 always fails.
8716
8717
8718 .ilist
8719 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8720 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8721 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8722 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8723 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8724 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8725 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8726 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8727 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8728
8729 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8730 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8731 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8732 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8733 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8734 with
8735 .code
8736 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8737 .endd
8738 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8739 .code
8740 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8741 .endd
8742 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8743
8744 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8745 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8746 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8747 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8748 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8749 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8750 .code
8751 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8752 spammer3 : spammer4
8753 .endd
8754 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8755 doubling.
8756
8757 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8758 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8759 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8760 might have entries like
8761 .code
8762 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8763 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8764 *: ^\d{8}$
8765 .endd
8766 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8767 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8768 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8769 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8770
8771 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8772 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8773 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8774
8775 .next
8776 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8777 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8778 can only return a single list of local parts.
8779 .endlist
8780
8781 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8782 in these two examples:
8783 .code
8784 senders = +my_list
8785 senders = *@+my_list
8786 .endd
8787 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8788 example it is a named domain list.
8789
8790
8791
8792
8793 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8794 .cindex "case of local parts"
8795 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8796 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8797 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8798 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8799 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8800 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8801 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8802 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8803 default.
8804
8805 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8806 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8807 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8808 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8809 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8810 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8811 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8812 case-independent.
8813
8814 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8815 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8816 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8817 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8818 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8819 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8820 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8821 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8822
8823
8824
8825 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8826 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8827 .cindex "local part" "list"
8828 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8829 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8830 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8831 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8832 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8833 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8834 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8835 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8836
8837 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8838 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8839 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8840 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8841 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8842 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8843 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8844 types.
8845 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8846
8847
8848
8849
8850 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8851 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8852
8853 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8854 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8855 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8856 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8857
8858 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8859 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8860 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8861 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8862 escape character, as described in the following section.
8863
8864 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8865 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8866 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8867 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8868 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8869 reasons.
8870
8871
8872
8873 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8874 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8875 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8876 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8877 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8878 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8879 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8880 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8881
8882 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8883 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8884 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8885 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8886 .code
8887 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8888 .endd
8889 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8890 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8891 string.
8892
8893
8894
8895 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8896 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8897 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8898 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8899 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8900 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8901 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8902 encoding.
8903
8904 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8905 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8906 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8907
8908
8909 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8910 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8911 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8912 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8913 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8914 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8915 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8916 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8917 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8918 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8919 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8920 and &%nhash%&.
8921
8922 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8923 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8924 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8925
8926 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8927 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8928 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8929 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8930 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8931 .code
8932 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8933 .endd
8934 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8935 Exim message identifier. For example:
8936 .code
8937 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8938 .endd
8939 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8940 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8941
8942
8943 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8944 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8945 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8946 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8947 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8948 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8949 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8950 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8951 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8952 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8953 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8954 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8955 being expanded.
8956
8957
8958
8959
8960 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8961 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8962 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8963 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8964 white space is significant.
8965
8966 .vlist
8967 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8968 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8969 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8970 .code
8971 $local_part
8972 ${domain}
8973 .endd
8974 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8975 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8976 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8977 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8978 given, the expansion fails.
8979
8980 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8981 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8982 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8983 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8984 .code
8985 ${lc:$local_part}
8986 .endd
8987 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8988 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8989 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8990 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8991 string easier to understand.
8992
8993 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8994 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8995 expansion item below.
8996
8997
8998 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8999 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9000 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9001 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9002 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9003 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9004 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9005 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9006 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9007 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9008 the result of the expansion.
9009 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9010 the expansion result is an empty string.
9011 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9012
9013
9014 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9015 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9016 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
9017 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9018 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9019 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9020 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9021 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9022 .display
9023 &`version `&
9024 &`serial_number `&
9025 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9026 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9027 &`notbefore `& time
9028 &`notafter `& time
9029 &`sig_algorithm `&
9030 &`signature `&
9031 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9032 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9033 &`crl_uri `& list
9034 .endd
9035 If the field is found,
9036 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9037 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9038 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9039 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9040
9041 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9042 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9043 extracted is used.
9044
9045 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9046
9047 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9048 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9049 not quite
9050 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9051 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9052 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9053 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9054 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9055 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9056 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9057 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9058
9059 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9060 take an optional modifier of "int"
9061 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9062 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9063 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9064
9065 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9066 newline-separated by default,
9067 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9068 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9069 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9070
9071 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9072 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9073 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9074 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9075 if so the element tags are omitted.
9076
9077 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9078
9079 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9080 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9081 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9082 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9083 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9084 .code
9085 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9086 .endd
9087 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9088 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9089 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9090
9091 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9092 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9093 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9094 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9095 must have the following type:
9096 .code
9097 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9098 .endd
9099 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9100 function should return one of the following values:
9101
9102 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9103 into the expanded string that is being built.
9104
9105 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9106 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9107
9108 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9109 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9110
9111 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9112
9113 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9114 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9115 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9116
9117
9118 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9119 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9120 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9121 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9122 removed.
9123 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9124 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9125 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9126
9127 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9128 appear, for example:
9129 .code
9130 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9131 .endd
9132 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9133 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9134
9135 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9136 search failure.
9137 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9138 search success.
9139
9140
9141 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9142 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9143 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9144 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9145 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9146 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9147 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9148 form:
9149 .display
9150 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9151 .endd
9152 .vindex "&$value$&"
9153 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9154 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9155 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9156 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9157 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9158 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9159 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9160 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9161 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9162
9163 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9164 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9165 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9166 yield &"2001"&:
9167 .code
9168 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9169 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9170 .endd
9171 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9172 appear, for example:
9173 .code
9174 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9175 .endd
9176 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9177 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9178
9179
9180 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9181 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9182 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9183 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9184 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9185 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9186 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9187 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9188 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9189 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9190 <&'string3'&> as before.
9191
9192 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9193 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9194 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9195 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9196 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9197 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9198 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9199 provided. For example:
9200 .code
9201 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9202 .endd
9203 yields &"42"&, and
9204 .code
9205 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9206 .endd
9207 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9208 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9209
9210
9211 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9212 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9213 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9214 .vindex "&$item$&"
9215 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9216 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9217 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9218 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9219 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9220 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9221 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9222 .code
9223 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9224 .endd
9225 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9226 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9227
9228
9229 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9230 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9231 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9232 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9233 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9234 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9235
9236 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9237 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9238 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9239 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9240 .code
9241 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9242 .endd
9243 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9244 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9245 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9246 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9247 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9248 .code
9249 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9250 .endd
9251 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9252 letters appear. For example:
9253 .display
9254 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9255 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9256 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9257 .endd
9258
9259 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9260 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9261 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9262 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9263 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9264 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9265 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9266 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9267 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9268 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9269 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9270 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9271 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9272 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9273 .code
9274 $header_reply-to:
9275 .endd
9276 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9277 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9278 lines) may be present.
9279
9280 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9281 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9282
9283 .ilist
9284 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9285 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9286 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9287
9288 .next
9289 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9290 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9291 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9292 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9293 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9294 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9295 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9296 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9297
9298 .next
9299 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9300 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9301 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9302 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9303 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9304 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9305 .endlist ilist
9306
9307 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9308 command of the following form:
9309 .code
9310 headers charset "UTF-8"
9311 .endd
9312 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9313 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9314 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9315 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9316 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9317 ISO-8859-1.
9318
9319 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9320 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9321 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9322 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9323
9324 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9325 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9326 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9327 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9328 router or transport are not accessible.
9329
9330 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9331 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9332 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9333 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9334 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9335 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9336
9337 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9338 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9339 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9340 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9341 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9342 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9343 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9344 header.)
9345
9346 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9347 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9348 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9349 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9350 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9351 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9352 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9353 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9354
9355
9356 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9357 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9358 .cindex &%hmac%&
9359 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9360 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9361 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9362 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9363 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9364 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9365 present. For example:
9366 .code
9367 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9368 .endd
9369 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9370 produces:
9371 .code
9372 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9373 .endd
9374 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9375 an Exim configuration:
9376 .code
9377 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9378 .endd
9379 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9380 .code
9381 headers_add = \
9382 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9383 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9384 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9385 .endd
9386 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9387 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9388 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9389 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9390 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9391 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9392
9393
9394 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9395 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9396 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9397 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9398 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9399 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9400 .code
9401 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9402 .endd
9403 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9404 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9405 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9406 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9407 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9408
9409 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9410 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9411 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9412 .code
9413 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9414 .endd
9415 you can use
9416 .code
9417 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9418 .endd
9419
9420
9421
9422 .new
9423 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9424 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9425 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9426 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9427 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9428 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9429 .wen
9430
9431
9432
9433 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9434 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9435 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9436 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9437 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9438 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9439 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9440 some of the braces:
9441 .code
9442 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9443 .endd
9444 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9445 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9446 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9447
9448
9449 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9450 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9451 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9452 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9453 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9454 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9455 apart from an optional leading minus,
9456 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9457
9458 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9459 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9460
9461 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9462 If the number is negative, the fields are
9463 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9464 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9465 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9466
9467 If the modulus of the
9468 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9469 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9470
9471 For example:
9472 .code
9473 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9474 .endd
9475 yields &"42"&, and
9476 .code
9477 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9478 .endd
9479 yields &"result: 42"&.
9480
9481 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9482 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9483 extracted is used.
9484 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9485
9486
9487 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9488 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9489 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9490 described in the next item.
9491
9492 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9493 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9494 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9495 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9496 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9497 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9498 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9499 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9500 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9501
9502 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9503 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9504 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9505 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9506 out by the system administrator.
9507
9508 .vindex "&$value$&"
9509 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9510 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9511 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9512 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9513 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9514 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9515 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9516 original lookup fails.
9517
9518 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9519 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9520 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9521 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9522 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9523 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9524 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9525 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9526
9527 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9528 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9529 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9530 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9531
9532 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9533 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9534 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9535 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9536
9537 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9538 .code
9539 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9540 .endd
9541 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9542 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9543 .code
9544 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9545 {$value}fail}
9546 .endd
9547
9548
9549 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9550 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9551 .vindex "&$item$&"
9552 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9553 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9554 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9555 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9556 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9557 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9558 .code
9559 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9560 .endd
9561 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9562 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9563 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9564
9565 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9566 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9567 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9568 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9569 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9570 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9571 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9572 .code
9573 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9574 .endd
9575 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9576 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9577 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9578 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9579 example,
9580 .code
9581 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9582 .endd
9583 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9584
9585
9586
9587 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9588 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9589 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9590 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9591 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9592 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9593 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9594 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9595
9596 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9597 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9598 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9599 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9600 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9601 not its contents.
9602
9603 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9604 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9605 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9606
9607 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9608 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9609
9610
9611 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9612 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9613 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9614 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9615 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9616 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9617 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9618 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9619
9620 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9621 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9622 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9623 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9624 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9625 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9626 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9627 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9628 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9629 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9630
9631 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9632 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9633 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9634 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9635
9636 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9637 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9638 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9639 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9640 is the expansion of the third argument.
9641
9642 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9643 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9644 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9645
9646 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9647 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9648 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9649 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9650 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9651 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9652 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9653 newlines are left in the string.
9654 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9655 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9656 the string expansion fails.
9657
9658 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9659 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9660
9661
9662
9663 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9664 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9665 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9666 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9667 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9668 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9669 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9670 examples:
9671 .code
9672 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9673 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9674 .endd
9675 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9676 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9677 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9678 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9679 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9680 example:
9681 .code
9682 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9683 .endd
9684 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9685 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9686 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9687 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9688 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9689 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9690 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9691 .code
9692 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9693 .endd
9694 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9695 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9696 turns them into spaces:
9697 .code
9698 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9699 .endd
9700 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9701 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9702 addition, the following errors can occur:
9703
9704 .ilist
9705 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9706 .next
9707 Failure to connect the socket;
9708 .next
9709 Failure to write the request string;
9710 .next
9711 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9712 .endlist
9713
9714 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9715 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9716 errors occurs. For example:
9717 .code
9718 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9719 {socket failure}}
9720 .endd
9721 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9722 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9723 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9724 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9725 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9726
9727 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9728 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9729
9730
9731 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9732 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9733 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9734 .vindex "&$value$&"
9735 .vindex "&$item$&"
9736 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9737 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9738 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9739 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9740 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9741 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9742 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9743 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9744 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9745 .code
9746 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9747 .endd
9748 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9749 can be found:
9750 .code
9751 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9752 .endd
9753 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9754 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9755 expansion items.
9756
9757 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9758 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9759 expansion item above.
9760
9761 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9762 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9763 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9764 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9765 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9766 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9767 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9768 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9769 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9770
9771 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9772 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9773 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9774 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9775 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9776 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9777 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9778 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9779 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9780 character.
9781
9782 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9783 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9784 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9785 .vindex "&$value$&"
9786 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9787 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9788 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9789 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9790 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9791 &$value$&.
9792
9793 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9794 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9795 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9796 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9797
9798 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9799 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9800 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9801 troubleshoot:
9802 .code
9803 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9804 log_message = Output of id: $value
9805 .endd
9806 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9807 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9808 .code
9809 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9810 .endd
9811
9812 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9813 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9814 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9815 .code
9816 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9817 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9818 ...
9819 endif
9820 .endd
9821 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9822 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9823 commands.
9824
9825 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9826 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9827 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9828 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9829
9830 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9831 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9832
9833
9834 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9835 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9836 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9837 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9838 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9839 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9840 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9841 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9842 .code
9843 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9844 .endd
9845 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9846 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9847 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9848 .code
9849 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9850 .endd
9851 yields &"defabc"&, and
9852 .code
9853 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9854 .endd
9855 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9856 the regular expression from string expansion.
9857
9858
9859
9860 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9861 .cindex sorting "a list"
9862 .cindex list sorting
9863 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9864 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9865 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9866 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9867 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9868 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9869 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9870 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9871 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9872 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9873 to give values for comparison.
9874
9875 The item result is a sorted list,
9876 with the original list separator,
9877 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9878
9879 Examples:
9880 .code
9881 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9882 .endd
9883 sorts a list of numbers, and
9884 .code
9885 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9886 .endd
9887 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9888
9889
9890 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9891 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9892 .cindex "substring extraction"
9893 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9894 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9895 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9896 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9897 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9898 .code
9899 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9900 .endd
9901 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9902 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9903 omitted.
9904
9905 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9906 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9907 length required. For example
9908 .code
9909 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9910 .endd
9911 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9912 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9913 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9914 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9915
9916 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9917 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9918 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9919 .code
9920 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9921 .endd
9922 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9923 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9924 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9925 .code
9926 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9927 .endd
9928 yields an empty string, but
9929 .code
9930 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9931 .endd
9932 yields &"1"&.
9933
9934 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9935 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9936 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9937 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9938 .code
9939 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9940 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9941 .endd
9942 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9943
9944
9945
9946 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9947 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9948 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9949 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9950 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9951 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9952 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9953 replacement list. For example
9954 .code
9955 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9956 .endd
9957 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9958 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9959 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9960 place.
9961 .endlist
9962
9963
9964
9965 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9966 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9967 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9968 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9969 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9970 following operations can be performed:
9971
9972 .vlist
9973 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9975 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9976 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9977 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9978 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9979
9980
9981 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9982 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9983 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9984 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9985 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9986 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9987 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9988 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9989 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9990
9991 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9992 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9993 character. For example:
9994 .code
9995 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9996 .endd
9997 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9998 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9999 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10000 processing lists.
10001
10002 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10003 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10004 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10005 email address separator. For the example header line:
10006 .code
10007 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10008 .endd
10009 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10010 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10011 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10012 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10013 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10014 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10015 quoted.
10016 .code
10017 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10018 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10019 user@example.com
10020 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10021 Last:user@example.com
10022 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10023 user@example.com
10024 .endd
10025
10026 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10027 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10028 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10029 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10030 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10031 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10032 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10033 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10034 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10035
10036 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10037 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10038 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10039 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10040 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10041 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10042 string.
10043
10044 .new
10045 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10046 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10047 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10048 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10049 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10050 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10051
10052 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10053 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10054
10055
10056 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10057 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10058 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10059 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10060 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10061 .wen
10062
10063
10064 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10065 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10066 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10067 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10068 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10069
10070
10071 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10072 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10073 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10074 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10075 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10076 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10077 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10078
10079
10080 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10081 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10082 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10083 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10084 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10085 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10086 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10087 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10088 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10089 C programming language):
10090 .table2 70pt 300pt
10091 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10092 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10093 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10094 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10095 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10096 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10097 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10098 .endtable
10099 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10100 space is permitted before or after operators.
10101
10102 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10103 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10104 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10105 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10106 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10107
10108 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10109 or 1024*1024*1024,
10110 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10111 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10112
10113 .display
10114 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10115 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10116 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10117 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10118 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10119 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10120 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10121 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10122 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10123 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10124 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10125 .endd
10126
10127 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10128 .code
10129 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10130 condition = \
10131 ${if and { \
10132 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10133 { \
10134 < \
10135 {$recipients_count} \
10136 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10137 } \
10138 }{yes}{no}}
10139 .endd
10140 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10141 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10142
10143
10144 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10145 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10146 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10147 example,
10148 .code
10149 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10150 .endd
10151 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10152 and then re-expands what it has found.
10153
10154
10155 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10156 .cindex "Unicode"
10157 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10158 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10159 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10160 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10161 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10162 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10163 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10164 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10165 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10166
10167 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10168 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10169 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10170 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10171 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10172 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10173 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10174
10175
10176 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10177 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10178 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10179 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10180 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10181 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10182 .code
10183 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10184 .endd
10185 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10186 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10187
10188
10189
10190 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10191 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10192 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10193 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10194 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10195 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10196
10197
10198
10199 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10200 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10201 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10202 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10203 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10204 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10205 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10206
10207
10208 .new
10209 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10210 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10211 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10212 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10213 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10214 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10215 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10216
10217 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10218 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10219 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10220 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10221 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10222 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10223 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10224 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10225 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10226 .wen
10227
10228
10229 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10230 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10231 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10232 .cindex "lower casing"
10233 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10234 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10235 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10236 .code
10237 ${lc:$local_part}
10238 .endd
10239
10240 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10241 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10242 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10243 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10244 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10245 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10246 .code
10247 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10248 .endd
10249 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10250 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10251 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10252
10253
10254 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10255 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10256 .cindex "list" "item count"
10257 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10258 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10259 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10260
10261
10262 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10264 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10265 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10266 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10267 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10268 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10269 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10270 matching list is returned.
10271
10272
10273 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10274 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10275 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10276 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10277 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10278 empty.
10279
10280
10281 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10282 .cindex "masked IP address"
10283 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10284 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10285 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10286 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10287 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10288 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10289 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10290 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10291 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10292 .code
10293 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10294 .endd
10295 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10296 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10297 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10298 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10299 .code
10300 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10301 .endd
10302 returns the string
10303 .code
10304 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10305 .endd
10306 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10307
10308
10309 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10310 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10311 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10312 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10313 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10314 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10315 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10316
10317 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10318 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10319
10320
10321 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10322 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10323 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10324 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10325 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10326 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10327 .code
10328 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10329 .endd
10330 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10331
10332
10333 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10334 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10335 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10336 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10337 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10338 is an empty string or
10339 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10340 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10341 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10342 respectively For example,
10343 .code
10344 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10345 .endd
10346 becomes
10347 .code
10348 "ab\"*\"cd"
10349 .endd
10350 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10351 variable or a message header.
10352
10353 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10354 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10355 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10356 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10357 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10358 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10359 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10360
10361
10362 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10363 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10364 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10365 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10366 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10367 .code
10368 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10369 .endd
10370 returns
10371 .code
10372 two%20%5C2A%20two
10373 .endd
10374 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10375 yields an unchanged string.
10376
10377
10378 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10379 .cindex "random number"
10380 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10381 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10382 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10383 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10384 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10385 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10386 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10387 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10388 random().
10389
10390
10391 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10392 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10393 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10394 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10395 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10396 for DNS. For example,
10397 .code
10398 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10399 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10400 .endd
10401 returns
10402 .code
10403 4.2.0.192
10404 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10405 .endd
10406
10407
10408 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10409 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10410 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10411 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10412 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10413 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10414 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10415 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10416 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10417 characters
10418 .code
10419 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10420 .endd
10421 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10422 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10423 characters.
10424
10425
10426 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10427 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10428 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10429 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10430 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10431 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10432 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10433 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10434
10435 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10436 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10437 to use this operator as well.
10438
10439
10440
10441 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10442 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10443 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10444 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10445 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10446 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10447 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10448
10449
10450 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10451 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10452 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10453 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10454 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10455 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10456 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10457
10458 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10459 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10460
10461
10462 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10463 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10464 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10465 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10466 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10467 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10468 certificate,
10469 and returns
10470 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10471 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10472
10473
10474 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10475 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10476 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10477 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10478 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10479 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10480 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10481 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10482 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10483 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10484 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10485 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10486 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10487
10488 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10489 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10490 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10491
10492 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10493 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10494 .new
10495 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10496 .wen
10497
10498
10499
10500 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10501 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10502 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10503 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10504 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10505 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10506
10507
10508 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10509 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10510 .cindex "substring extraction"
10511 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10512 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10513 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10514 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10515 .code
10516 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10517 .endd
10518 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10519 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10520
10521 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10522 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10523 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10524 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10525 seconds.
10526
10527 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10528 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10529 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10530 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10531 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10532 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10533 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10534
10535 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10536 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10537 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10538 .cindex "upper casing"
10539 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10540 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10541 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10542
10543 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10544 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10545 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10546 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10547 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10548 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10549 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10550
10551 .new
10552 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10553 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10554 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10555 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10556 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10557 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10558 .cindex EAI
10559 .cindex internationalisation
10560 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10561 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10562 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10563 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10564 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10565 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10566 .wen
10567 .endlist
10568
10569
10570
10571
10572
10573
10574 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10575 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10576 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10577 while expanding strings:
10578
10579 .vlist
10580 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10581 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10582 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10583 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10584 condition.
10585
10586 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10587 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10588 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10589 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10590 are:
10591 .display
10592 &`= `& equal
10593 &`== `& equal
10594 &`> `& greater
10595 &`>= `& greater or equal
10596 &`< `& less
10597 &`<= `& less or equal
10598 .endd
10599 For example:
10600 .code
10601 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10602 .endd
10603 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10604 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10605 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10606 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10607 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10608 zero.
10609
10610 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10611 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10612 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10613
10614
10615 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10616 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10617 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10618 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10619 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10620 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10621 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10622 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10623 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10624 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10625 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10626 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10627 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10628 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10629
10630 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10631 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10632 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10633 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10634 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10635 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10636 false if zero.
10637 An empty string is treated as false.
10638 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10639 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10640 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10641
10642 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10643 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10644 For example:
10645 .code
10646 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10647 .endd
10648
10649
10650 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10651 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10652 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10653 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10654 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10655 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10656 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10657 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10658
10659 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10660
10661 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10662 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10663 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10664 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10665 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10666 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10667 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10668 included in the binary.
10669
10670 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10671 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10672 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10673 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10674 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10675 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10676 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10677 string in LDAP form is:
10678 .code
10679 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10680 .endd
10681 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10682 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10683 .code
10684 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10685 .endd
10686 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10687 supported:
10688
10689 .ilist
10690 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10691 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10692 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10693 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10694 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10695 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10696 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10697 comparison fails.
10698
10699 .next
10700 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10701 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10702 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10703 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10704 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10705 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10706
10707 .next
10708 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10709 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10710 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10711 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10712 whatever its length.
10713
10714 .next
10715 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10716 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10717 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10718 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10719 .endlist
10720 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10721 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10722 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10723 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10724 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10725 support &[crypt16()]&.
10726
10727 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10728 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10729 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10730 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10731 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10732
10733 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10734 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10735 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10736
10737 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10738 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10739 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10740 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10741 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10742
10743 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10744 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10745 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10746 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10747 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10748 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10749 .code
10750 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10751 .endd
10752 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10753 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10754
10755 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10756 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10757 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10758 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10759 exists in the message. For example,
10760 .code
10761 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10762 .endd
10763 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10764 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10765
10766 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10767 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10768 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10769 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10770 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10771 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10772 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10773 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10774 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10775
10776 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10777 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10778 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10779 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10780 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10781 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10782 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10783 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10784
10785 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10786 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10787 .cindex "first delivery"
10788 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10789 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10790 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10791 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10792
10793
10794 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10795 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10796 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10797 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10798 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10799 .vindex "&$item$&"
10800 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10801 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10802 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10803 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10804 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10805 .ilist
10806 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10807 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10808 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10809 .next
10810 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10811 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10812 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10813 .endlist
10814 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10815 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10816 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10817 list separator is changed to a comma:
10818 .code
10819 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10820 .endd
10821 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10822 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10823
10824 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10825
10826
10827 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10828 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10829 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10830 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10831 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10832 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10833 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10834 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10835 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10836 case-independent.
10837
10838 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10839 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10840 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10841 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10842 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10843 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10844 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10845 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10846 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10847 case-independent.
10848
10849 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10850 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10851 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10852 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10853 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10854 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10855 is true.
10856
10857 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10858 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10859 .code
10860 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10861 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10862 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10863 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10864 .endd
10865
10866 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10867 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10868 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10869 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10870 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10871 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10872 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10873 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10874 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10875 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10876 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10877
10878 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10879 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10880 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10881 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10882 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10883
10884 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10885 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10886 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10887 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10888 .code
10889 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10890 .endd
10891 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10892
10893 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10894 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10895 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10896 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10897 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10898 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10899 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10900 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10901 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10902 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10903 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10904 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10905 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10906 this can be used.
10907
10908
10909 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10910 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10911 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10912 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10913 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10914 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10915 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10916 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10917 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10918 case-independent.
10919
10920 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10921 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10922 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10923 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10924 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10925 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10926 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10927 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10928 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10929 case-independent.
10930
10931
10932 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10933 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10934 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10935 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10936 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10937 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10938 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10939 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10940 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10941 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10942 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10943 For example,
10944 .code
10945 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10946 .endd
10947 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10948 backslashes is also required.
10949
10950 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10951 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10952 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10953 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10954 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10955 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10956
10957 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10958 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10959 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10960 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10961 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10962 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10963 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10964 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10965
10966 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10967 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10968 See &*match_local_part*&.
10969
10970 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10971 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10972 See &*match_local_part*&.
10973
10974 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10975 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10976 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10977 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10978 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10979 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10980 .code
10981 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10982 .endd
10983 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10984
10985 .ilist
10986 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10987 .next
10988 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10989 .next
10990 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10991 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10992 in a single test such as
10993 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10994 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10995 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10996 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10997 .code
10998 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10999 .endd
11000 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11001 .next
11002 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11003 .next
11004 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11005 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11006 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11007 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11008 masks. For example:
11009 .code
11010 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11011 .endd
11012 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11013 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11014 address mask, for example:
11015 .code
11016 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11017 .endd
11018 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11019 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11020 .code
11021 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11022 .endd
11023 .endlist ilist
11024
11025 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11026 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11027
11028 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11029
11030 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11031 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11032 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11033 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11034 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11035 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11036 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11037 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11038 example is:
11039 .code
11040 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11041 .endd
11042 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11043 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
11044 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11045 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11046 .code
11047 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11048 .endd
11049 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11050 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11051 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11052 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11053 caselessly.
11054
11055 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11056 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11057
11058 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11059 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11060 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11061 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11062
11063 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11064 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11065 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11066 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11067 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11068 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11069 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11070 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11071 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11072 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11073 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11074 .code
11075 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11076 .endd
11077 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11078 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11079
11080 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11081 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11082 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11083 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11084 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11085 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11086 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11087
11088 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11089 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11090 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11091 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11092 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11093 .code
11094 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11095 .endd
11096 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11097 .code
11098 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11099 .endd
11100 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11101 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11102 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11103 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11104 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11105 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11106 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11107 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11108
11109
11110 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11111 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11112 .cindex "Cyrus"
11113 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11114 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11115 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11116 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11117 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11118 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11119
11120 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11121 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11122 building Exim. For example:
11123 .code
11124 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11125 .endd
11126 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11127 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11128 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11129 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11130
11131 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11132 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11133 configuration, you might have this:
11134 .code
11135 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11136 .endd
11137 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11138 .code
11139 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11140 .endd
11141 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11142 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11143 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11144 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11145 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11146 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11147
11148
11149 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11150 .cindex "Radius"
11151 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11152 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11153 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11154 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11155 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11156 support.
11157
11158 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11159 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11160 this library, you need to set
11161 .code
11162 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11163 .endd
11164 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11165 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11166 .code
11167 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11168 .endd
11169 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11170 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11171 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11172
11173 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11174 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11175 the authentication is successful. For example:
11176 .code
11177 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11178 .endd
11179
11180
11181 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11182 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11183 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11184 .cindex "Cyrus"
11185 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11186 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11187 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11188 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11189 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11190 by a process that is not running as root.
11191
11192 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11193 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11194 building Exim. For example:
11195 .code
11196 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11197 .endd
11198 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11199 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11200 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11201
11202 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11203 two are mandatory. For example:
11204 .code
11205 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11206 .endd
11207 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11208 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11209 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11210 .endlist vlist
11211
11212
11213
11214 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11215 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11216 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11217 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11218 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11219 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11220 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11221
11222
11223 .vlist
11224 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11225 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11226 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11227 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11228 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11229 For example,
11230 .code
11231 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11232 .endd
11233 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11234 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11235 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11236
11237 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11238 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11239 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11240 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11241 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11242 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11243 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11244 parsed but not evaluated.
11245 .endlist
11246 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11247
11248
11249
11250
11251 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11252 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11253 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11254 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11255 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11256
11257 .vlist
11258 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11259 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11260 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11261 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11262 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11263 In the expansion condition case
11264 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11265 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11266 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11267 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11268 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11269 matching condition.
11270
11271 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11272 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11273 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11274 any unused variables being made empty.
11275
11276 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11277 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11278 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11279 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11280 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11281 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11282 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11283 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11284 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11285 during subsequent delivery.
11286
11287 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11288 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11289 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11290 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11291 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11292 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11293 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11294 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11295 delivery.
11296
11297 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11298 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11299 this variable has the number of arguments.
11300
11301 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11302 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11303 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11304 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11305 be preserved by coding like this:
11306 .code
11307 warn !verify = sender
11308 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11309 .endd
11310 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11311 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11312 failure.
11313
11314 .vitem &$address_data$&
11315 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11316 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11317 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11318 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11319 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11320 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11321 user filter files.
11322
11323 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11324 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11325 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11326 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11327 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11328 from the child's routing.
11329
11330 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11331 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11332 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11333 address.
11334
11335 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11336 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11337 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11338
11339 .vitem &$address_file$&
11340 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11341 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11342 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11343 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11344 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11345 .code
11346 /home/r2d2/savemail
11347 .endd
11348 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11349 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11350 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11351 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11352 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11353 to the relevant file.
11354
11355 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11356 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11357 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11358 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11359
11360 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11361 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11362 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11363 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11364
11365 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11366 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11367 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11368 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11369 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11370 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11371 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11372 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11373 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11374 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11375 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11376 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11377 command line option.
11378
11379 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11380 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11381 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11382 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11383 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11384 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11385 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11386 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11387 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11388 the ACL's as well.
11389
11390
11391 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11392 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11393 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11394 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11395 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11396 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11397 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11398 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11399 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11400 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11401 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11402
11403 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11404 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11405 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11406 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11407 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11408
11409
11410 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11411 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11412 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11413 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11414 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11415 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11416 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11417 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11418 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11419 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11420 an undefined mechanism.
11421
11422 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11423 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11424 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11425 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11426 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11427 the ACL malware condition.
11428
11429 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11430 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11431 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11432 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11433 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11434 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11435
11436 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11437 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11438 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11439 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11440 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11441 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11442 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11443
11444 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11445 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11446 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11447 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11448 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11449
11450 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11451 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11452 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11453 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11454 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11455
11456 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11457 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11458 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11459 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11460 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11461 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11462 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11463
11464 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11465 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11466 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11467 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11468 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11469 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11470 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11471
11472 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11473 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11474 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11475 address that was connected to.
11476
11477 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11478 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11479 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11480 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11481 compilations of the same version of the program.
11482
11483 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11484 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11485 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11486 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11487 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11488 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11489
11490 .vitem &$config_file$&
11491 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11492 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11493
11494 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11495 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11496 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11497 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11498 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11499
11500 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11501 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11502 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11503 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11504 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11505
11506 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11507 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11508 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11509 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11510 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11511 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11512 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11513 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11514 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11515 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11516 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11517 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11518 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11519 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11520 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11521 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11522 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11523 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11524 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11525 &$dkim_key_length$&
11526 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11527 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11528
11529 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11530 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11531 When a message has been received this variable contains
11532 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11533 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11534
11535 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11536 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11537 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11538 &$dnslist_value$&
11539 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11540 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11541 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11542 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11543 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11544 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11545 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11546 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11547 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11548
11549 .vitem &$domain$&
11550 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11551 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11552 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11553 case for &$domain$&.
11554
11555 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11556 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11557 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11558 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11559
11560 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11561 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11562 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11563 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11564 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11565 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11566
11567 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11568 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11569 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11570
11571 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11572
11573 .ilist
11574 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11575 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11576 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11577 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11578 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11579 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11580 the &(smtp)& transport.
11581
11582 .next
11583 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11584 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11585 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11586 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11587
11588 .next
11589 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11590 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11591 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11592 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11593 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11594 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11595
11596 .next
11597 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11598 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11599 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11600 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11601 .endlist
11602
11603
11604 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11605 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11606 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11607 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11608 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11609 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11610 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11611 used.
11612
11613 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11614 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11615 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11616 to nothing.
11617
11618 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11619 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11620 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11621
11622 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11623 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11624 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11625
11626 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11627 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11628 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11629
11630 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11631 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11632 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11633 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11634 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11635 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11636
11637 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11638 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11639 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11640 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11641 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11642
11643 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11644 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11645 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11646 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11647 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11648
11649 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11650 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11651 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11652 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11653 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11654
11655 .vitem &$home$&
11656 .vindex "&$home$&"
11657 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11658 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11659 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11660 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11661 by a setting on the transport itself.
11662
11663 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11664 of the environment variable HOME.
11665
11666 .vitem &$host$&
11667 .vindex "&$host$&"
11668 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11669 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11670 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11671 to local and remote transports.
11672
11673 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11674 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11675 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11676 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11677 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11678 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11679 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11680 is connected.
11681
11682 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11683 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11684 client is connected.
11685
11686
11687 .vitem &$host_address$&
11688 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11689 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11690 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11691 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11692
11693 .vitem &$host_data$&
11694 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11695 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11696 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11697 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11698 .code
11699 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11700 message = $host_data
11701 .endd
11702 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11703 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11704 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11705 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11706 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11707 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11708 variables is set to &"1"&.
11709
11710 .ilist
11711 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11712 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11713
11714 .next
11715 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11716 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11717 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11718 .endlist ilist
11719
11720 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11721 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11722 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11723 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11724 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11725 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11726 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11727 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11728 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11729 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11730
11731 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11732 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11733 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11734
11735 .vitem &$host_port$&
11736 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11737 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11738 for an outbound connection.
11739
11740
11741 .vitem &$inode$&
11742 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11743 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11744 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11745 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11746 a unique name for the file.
11747
11748 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11749 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11750 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11751
11752 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11753 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11754 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11755
11756 .vitem &$item$&
11757 .vindex "&$item$&"
11758 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11759 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11760 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11761 empty.
11762
11763 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11764 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11765 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11766 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11767 lookup.
11768
11769 .vitem &$load_average$&
11770 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11771 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11772 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11773 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11774
11775 .vitem &$local_part$&
11776 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11777 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11778 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11779 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11780 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11781
11782 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11783 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11784 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11785 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11786 once.
11787
11788 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11789 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11790 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11791 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11792 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11793 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11794
11795 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11796 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11797 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11798 &$address_pipe$&).
11799
11800 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11801 local part of the recipient address.
11802
11803 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11804 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11805 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11806
11807 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11808 the addresses
11809 .code
11810 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11811 abc\:xyz@test.example
11812 .endd
11813 the value of &$local_part$& is
11814 .code
11815 abc:xyz
11816 .endd
11817 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11818 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11819 have:
11820 .code
11821 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11822 .endd
11823 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11824 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11825 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11826
11827 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11828 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11829 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11830 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11831 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11832 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11833 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11834
11835 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11836 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11837 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11838 variable expands to nothing.
11839
11840 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11841 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11842 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11843 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11844 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11845
11846 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11847 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11848 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11849 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11850 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11851
11852 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11853 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11854 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11855 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11856
11857 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11858 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11859 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11860
11861 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11862 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11863 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11864 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11865 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11866 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11867 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11868 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11869
11870 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11871 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11872 This contains the expanded value of the
11873 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11874 been read.
11875
11876 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11877 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11878 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11879 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11880 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11881 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11882
11883 .vitem &$log_space$&
11884 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11885 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11886 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11887 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11888 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11889 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11890
11891
11892 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11893 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11894 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11895 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11896 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11897 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11898 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11899 and &"yes"& if it was.
11900 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11901 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11902 as authenticated data.
11903
11904 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11905 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11906 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11907 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11908 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11909 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11910 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11911 variable is empty.
11912
11913 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11914 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11915 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11916 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11917 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11918
11919 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11920 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11921 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11922 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11923 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11924 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11925 character(s).
11926
11927 .vitem &$message_age$&
11928 .cindex "message" "age of"
11929 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11930 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11931 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11932 delivery attempt.
11933
11934 .vitem &$message_body$&
11935 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11936 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11937 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11938 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11939 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11940 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11941 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11942 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11943 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11944
11945 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11946 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11947 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11948 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11949 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11950
11951 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11952 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11953 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11954 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11955 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11956 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11957 &$message_body$&.
11958
11959 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11960 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11961 .cindex "message body" "size"
11962 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11963 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11964 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11965 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11966 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11967
11968 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11969 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11970 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11971 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11972 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11973 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11974 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11975 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11976
11977 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11978 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11979 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11980 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11981 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11982 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11983
11984 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11985 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11986 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11987 contents of header lines is done.
11988
11989 .vitem &$message_id$&
11990 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11991
11992 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11993 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11994 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11995 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11996 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11997 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11998 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11999 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12000 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12001 from the body is not counted.
12002
12003 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12004 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12005 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12006 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12007 header and the body).
12008
12009 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12010 .code
12011 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12012 condition = \
12013 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12014 .endd
12015 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12016 message has not yet been received.
12017
12018 .vitem &$message_size$&
12019 .cindex "size" "of message"
12020 .cindex "message" "size"
12021 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12022 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12023 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12024 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12025 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12026 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12027 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12028 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12029 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12030
12031 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12032 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12033 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12034 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12035
12036 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12037 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12038 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12039 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12040
12041 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12042 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12043 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12044
12045 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12046 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12047 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12048 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12049 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12050 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12051 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12052 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12053 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12054 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12055
12056 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12057 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12058 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12059
12060 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12061 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12062 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12063 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12064 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12065 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12066 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12067 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12068 the original address.
12069
12070 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12071 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12072 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12073 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12074 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12075
12076 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12077 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12078 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12079
12080 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12081 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12082 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12083 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12084 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12085 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12086 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12087 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12088 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12089
12090 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12091 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12092 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12093 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12094 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
12095 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12096 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12097 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12098 user.
12099
12100 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12101 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12102 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12103 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12104
12105 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12106 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12107 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12108 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12109
12110 .vitem &$pid$&
12111 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12112 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12113 This variable contains the current process id.
12114
12115 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12116 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12117 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12118 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12119 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12120 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12121 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12122 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12123 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12124 variable"& error if encountered.
12125
12126 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12127 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12128 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12129 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12130 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12131 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12132 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12133
12134
12135 .new
12136 .vitem &$proxy_host_address$& &&&
12137 &$proxy_host_port$& &&&
12138 &$proxy_target_address$& &&&
12139 &$proxy_target_port$& &&&
12140 &$proxy_session$&
12141 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12142 or Socks5 support
12143 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12144 .wen
12145
12146 .new
12147 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12148 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12149 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12150 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12151 .wen
12152
12153 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12154 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12155 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12156 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12157
12158 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12159 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12160 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12161 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12162
12163 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12164 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12165 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12166 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12167
12168 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12169 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12170 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12171
12172 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12173 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12174 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12175 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12176
12177 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12178 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12179 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12180 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12181 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12182
12183 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12184 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12185 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12186 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12187 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12188 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12189
12190 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12191 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12192 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12193 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12194 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12195
12196 .vitem &$received_count$&
12197 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12198 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12199 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12200 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12201 delivering.
12202
12203 .vitem &$received_for$&
12204 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12205 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12206 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12207 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12208 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12209
12210 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12211 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12212 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12213 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12214 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12215 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12216 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12217 option.
12218
12219 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12220 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12221 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12222 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12223 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12224 time.
12225 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12226
12227 .vitem &$received_port$&
12228 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12229 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12230
12231 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12232 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12233 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12234 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12235 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12236 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12237 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12238 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12239 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12240
12241 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12242 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12243 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12244 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12245 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12246 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12247
12248 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12249 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12250 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12251
12252 .vitem &$received_time$&
12253 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12254 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12255 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12256
12257 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12258 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12259 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12260 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12261 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12262 .display
12263 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12264 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12265 .endd
12266 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12267 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12268 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12269 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12270
12271 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12272 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12273 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12274 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12275
12276 .ilist
12277 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12278 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12279
12280 .next
12281 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12282
12283 .next
12284 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12285 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12286 MAIL).
12287
12288 .next
12289 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12290 .next
12291
12292 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12293 .endlist
12294
12295 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12296 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12297
12298 .vitem &$recipients$&
12299 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12300 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12301 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12302 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12303 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12304 cases:
12305
12306 .olist
12307 In a system filter file.
12308 .next
12309 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12310 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12311 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12312 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12313 .next
12314 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12315 .endlist
12316
12317
12318 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12319 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12320 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12321 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12322 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12323 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12324
12325
12326 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12327 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12328 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12329 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12330
12331 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12332 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12333 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12334 these variables contain the
12335 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12336
12337
12338 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12339 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12340 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12341 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12342 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12343 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12344 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12345
12346 .vitem &$return_path$&
12347 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12348 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12349 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12350 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12351 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12352 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12353 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12354 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12355 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12356 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12357 envelope sender.
12358
12359 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12360 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12361 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12362
12363 .vitem &$router_name$&
12364 .cindex "router" "name"
12365 .cindex "name" "of router"
12366 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12367 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12368
12369 .vitem &$runrc$&
12370 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12371 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12372 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12373 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12374 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12375 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12376 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12377 another.
12378
12379 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12380 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12381 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12382 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12383 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12384 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12385 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12386 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12387
12388 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12389 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12390 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12391 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12392 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12393 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12394
12395 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12396 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12397 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12398 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12399 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12400 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12401 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12402 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12403
12404 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12405 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12406 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12407
12408 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12409 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12410 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12411
12412 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12413 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12414 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12415 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12416 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12417 this:
12418 .display
12419 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12420 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12421 .endd
12422 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12423 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12424 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12425 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12426
12427 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12428 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12429 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12430 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12431 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12432 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12433 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12434 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12435 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12436 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12437 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12438 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12439 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12440
12441 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12442 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12443 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12444 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12445 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12446
12447 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12448 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12449 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12450 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12451 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12452 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12453
12454 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12455 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12456 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12457 this variable contains that
12458 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12459
12460 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12461 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12462 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12463 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12464 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12465 &$authenticated_id$&.
12466
12467 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12468 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12469 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12470 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12471 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12472 resolver library states that both
12473 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12474 other times, this variable is false.
12475
12476 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12477 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12478 library, by setting:
12479 .code
12480 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12481 .endd
12482
12483 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12484 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12485
12486 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12487 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12488
12489
12490 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12491 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12492 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12493 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12494 other means, this variable is empty.
12495
12496 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12497 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12498 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12499 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12500 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12501 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12502 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12503
12504 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12505 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12506 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12507 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12508
12509 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12510 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12511 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12512 is set to &"1"&.
12513
12514 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12515 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12516 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12517 following are true:
12518
12519 .ilist
12520 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12521 .next
12522 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12523 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12524 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12525 .next
12526 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12527 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12528 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12529 .next
12530 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12531 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12532 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12533 .next
12534 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12535 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12536 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12537 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12538 .code
12539 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12540 .endd
12541 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12542 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12543 .endlist
12544
12545
12546 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12547 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12548 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12549 number that was used on the remote host.
12550
12551 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12552 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12553 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12554 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12555 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12556 called Exim.
12557
12558 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12559 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12560 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12561 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12562
12563 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12564 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12565 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12566 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12567 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12568 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12569 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12570 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12571 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12572 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12573 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12574 the parentheses.
12575
12576 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12577 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12578 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12579 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12580 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12581
12582 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12583 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12584 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12585 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12586 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12587
12588 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12589 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12590 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12591 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12592 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12593 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12594 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12595
12596 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12597 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12598 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12599 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12600 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12601
12602 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12603 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12604 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12605 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12606 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12607 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12608
12609 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12610 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12611 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12612 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12613 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12614 .code
12615 MAIL FROM:<>
12616 MAIL FROM: <>
12617 .endd
12618 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12619 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12620 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12621 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12622
12623 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12624 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12625 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12626 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12627 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12628 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12629 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12630
12631 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12632 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12633 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12634 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12635 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12636 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12637 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12638 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12639 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12640 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12641 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12642
12643 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12644 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12645 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12646 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12647 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12648 message is junk mail.
12649
12650 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12651 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12652 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12653 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12654
12655
12656 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12657 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12658 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12659
12660 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12661 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12662 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12663 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12664 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12665 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12666
12667 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12668 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12669 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12670 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12671 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12672 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12673 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12674 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12675 .code
12676 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12677 .endd
12678 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12679
12680
12681 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12682 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12683 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12684 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12685 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12686 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12687
12688 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12689 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12690 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12691 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12692 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12693 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12694 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12695 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12696
12697 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12698 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12699 the outbound.
12700
12701 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12702 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12703 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12704 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12705 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12706 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12707
12708 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12709 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12710 .cindex certificate veriables
12711 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12712 inbound connection when the message was received.
12713 It is only useful as the argument of a
12714 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12715 or a &%def%& condition.
12716
12717 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12718 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12719 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12720 inbound connection when the message was received.
12721 It is only useful as the argument of a
12722 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12723 or a &%def%& condition.
12724 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12725 which is not the leaf.
12726
12727 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12728 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12729 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12730 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12731 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12732 or a &%def%& condition.
12733
12734 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12735 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12736 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12737 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12738 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12739 or a &%def%& condition.
12740 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12741 which is not the leaf.
12742
12743 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12744 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12745 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12746 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12747
12748 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12749 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12750 the outbound.
12751
12752 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12753 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12754 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12755 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12756 and &"0"& otherwise.
12757
12758 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12759 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12760 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12761 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12762 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12763 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12764 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12765 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12766 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12767
12768 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12769 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12770 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12771
12772 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12773 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12774 This variable is
12775 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12776 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12777 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12778 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12779
12780 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12781 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12782 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12783 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12784 .code
12785 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12786 1 No response to request
12787 2 Response not verified
12788 3 Verification failed
12789 4 Verification succeeded
12790 .endd
12791
12792 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12793 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12794 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12795 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12796 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12797
12798 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12799 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12800 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12801 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12802 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12803 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12804 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12805 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12806 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12807 which is not the leaf.
12808
12809 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12810 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12811 the outbound.
12812
12813 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12814 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12815 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12816 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12817 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12818 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12819 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12820 which is not the leaf.
12821
12822 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12823 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12824 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12825 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12826 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12827 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12828 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12829 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12830 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12831 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12832 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12833
12834 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12835 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12836 the outbound.
12837
12838 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12839 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12840 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12841 During outbound
12842 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12843 the transport.
12844
12845 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12846 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12847 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12848 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12849
12850 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12851 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12852 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12853
12854 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12855 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12856 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12857
12858 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12859 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12860 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12861 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12862 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12863 values for those that are behind (west).
12864
12865 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12866 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12867 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12868 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12869
12870 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12871 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12872 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12873 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12874 flag.
12875
12876 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12877 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12878 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12879 -0500.
12880
12881 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12882 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12883 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12884 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12885
12886 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12887 .cindex "transport" "name"
12888 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12889 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12890 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12891
12892 .vitem &$value$&
12893 .vindex "&$value$&"
12894 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12895 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12896 &*reduce*& expansion.
12897
12898 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12899 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12900 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12901 or for cutthrough delivery,
12902 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12903 Otherwise, empty.
12904
12905 .vitem &$version_number$&
12906 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12907 The version number of Exim.
12908
12909 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12910 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12911 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12912 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12913
12914 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12915 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12916 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12917 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12918 .endlist
12919 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12920
12921
12922
12923 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12924 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12925
12926 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12927 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12928 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12929 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12930 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12931 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12932 the line
12933 .code
12934 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12935 .endd
12936 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12937
12938
12939 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12940 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12941 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12942 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12943 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12944 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12945 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12946 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12947 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12948
12949 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12950 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12951 should usually be something like
12952 .code
12953 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12954 .endd
12955 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12956 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12957 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12958 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12959 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12960 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12961 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12962 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12963 two ways:
12964
12965 .ilist
12966 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12967 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12968 a startup when Exim is entered.
12969 .next
12970 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12971 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12972 .endlist
12973
12974 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12975 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12976
12977
12978 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12979 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12980 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12981 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12982 forms:
12983 .code
12984 ${perl{foo}}
12985 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12986 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12987 .endd
12988 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12989 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12990 with an error message of the form
12991 .code
12992 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12993 .endd
12994 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12995 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12996 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12997 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12998 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12999 that was passed to &%die%&.
13000
13001
13002 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13003 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13004 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13005 the Perl code
13006 .code
13007 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13008 .endd
13009 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13010 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13011 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13012
13013 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13014 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13015 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13016 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13017
13018 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13019 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13020 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13021 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13022 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13023 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13024 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13025
13026
13027 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13028 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13029 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13030 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13031 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13032 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13033 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13034 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13035 avoided, but the output is lost.
13036
13037 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13038 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13039 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13040 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13041 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13042 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13043 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13044 .code
13045 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13046 .endd
13047 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13048 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13049 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13050 as the first subroutine argument.
13051 .ecindex IIDperl
13052
13053
13054 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13055 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13056
13057 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13058 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13059 "Starting the daemon"
13060 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13061 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13062 .cindex "network interface"
13063 .cindex "interface" "network"
13064 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13065 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13066 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13067 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13068 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13069 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13070 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13071 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13072 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13073 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13074 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13075
13076 .olist
13077 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13078 and ports to listen on.
13079 .next
13080 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13081 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13082 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13083 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13084 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13085 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13086 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13087 as an error situation.
13088 .next
13089 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13090 for the outgoing connection.
13091 .endlist
13092
13093
13094 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13095 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13096 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13097 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13098 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13099
13100 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13101 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13102 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13103 chapter describes how they operate.
13104
13105 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13106 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13107
13108
13109
13110 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13111 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13112 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13113 following options:
13114
13115 .ilist
13116 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13117 or service names.
13118 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13119 .next
13120 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13121 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13122 .endlist
13123
13124 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13125 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13126 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13127 colons. For example:
13128 .code
13129 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13130 192.168.23.65 ; \
13131 ::1 ; \
13132 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13133 .endd
13134 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13135 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13136
13137 .olist
13138 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13139 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13140 .code
13141 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13142 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13143 .endd
13144 .next
13145 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13146 with a colon separator, for example:
13147 .code
13148 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13149 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13150 .endd
13151 .endlist
13152
13153 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13154 default setting contains just one port:
13155 .code
13156 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13157 .endd
13158 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13159 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13160 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13161 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13162 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13163
13164
13165
13166 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13167 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13168 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13169 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13170 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13171 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13172 .code
13173 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13174 .endd
13175 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13176 .code
13177 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13178 .endd
13179 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13180
13181
13182
13183 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13184 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13185 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13186 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13187 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13188 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13189 exim.
13190
13191 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13192 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13193 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13194 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13195 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13196 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13197 .code
13198 -oX 1225
13199 .endd
13200 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13201 whereas
13202 .code
13203 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13204 .endd
13205 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13206 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13207 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13208
13209
13210
13211 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13212 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13213 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13214 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13215 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13216 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13217 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13218 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13219 list of port numbers or service names,
13220 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13221 common use of this option is expected to be
13222 .code
13223 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13224 .endd
13225 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13226 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13227 this way when a daemon is started.
13228
13229 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13230 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13231 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13232 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13233 connections via the daemon.)
13234
13235
13236
13237
13238 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13239 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13240 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13241 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13242 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13243 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13244 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13245 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13246 .code
13247 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13248 .endd
13249 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13250 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13251 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13252 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13253 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13254 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13255 .code
13256 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13257 .endd
13258 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13259 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13260 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13261 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13262 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13263
13264 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13265 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13266 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13267 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13268 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13269 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13270 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13271 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13272 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13273 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13274 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13275 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13276
13277 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13278 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13279 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13280 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13281 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13282
13283
13284
13285 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13286 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13287 .code
13288 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13289 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13290 .endd
13291 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13292 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13293 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13294 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13295
13296 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13297 .code
13298 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13299 .endd
13300 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13301 .code
13302 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13303 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13304 .endd
13305 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13306 IPv4 loopback address only:
13307 .code
13308 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13309 .endd
13310 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13311 .code
13312 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13313 .endd
13314 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13315
13316
13317
13318 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13319 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13320 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13321 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13322 treated as local.
13323
13324 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13325 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13326 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13327 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13328
13329 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13330 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13331 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13332 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13333 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13334 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13335 used for listening. Consider this example:
13336 .code
13337 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13338 192.168.53.235 ; \
13339 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13340
13341 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13342 .endd
13343 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13344 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13345 Exim is routing.
13346
13347 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13348 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13349 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13350 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13351 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13352 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13353 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13354 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13355
13356
13357
13358 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13359 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13360 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13361 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13362 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13363 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13364 details.
13365
13366
13367
13368
13369 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13370 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13371
13372 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13373 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13374 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13375 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13376
13377 .ilist
13378 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13379 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13380 .next
13381 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13382 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13383 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13384 .next
13385 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13386 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13387 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13388 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13389 settings.
13390 .endlist
13391
13392 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13393 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13394 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13395 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13396 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13397 listed in more than one group.
13398
13399 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13400 .table2
13401 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13402 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13403 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13404 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13405 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13406 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13407 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13408 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13409 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13410 .endtable
13411
13412
13413 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13414 .table2
13415 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13416 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13417 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13418 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13419 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13420 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13421 .endtable
13422
13423
13424
13425 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13426 .table2
13427 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13428 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13429 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13430 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13431 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13432 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13433 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13434 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13435 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13436 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13437 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13438 .endtable
13439
13440
13441
13442 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13443 .table2
13444 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13445 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13446 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13447 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13448 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13449 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13450 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13451 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13452 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13453 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13454 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13455 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13456 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13457 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13458 .endtable
13459
13460
13461
13462 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13463 .table2
13464 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13465 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13466 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13467 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13468 .endtable
13469
13470
13471
13472 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13473 .table2
13474 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13475 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13476 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13477 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13478 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13479 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13480 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13481 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13482 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13483 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13484 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13485 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13486 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13487 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13488 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13489 .endtable
13490
13491
13492
13493 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13494 .table2
13495 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13496 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13497 .endtable
13498
13499
13500
13501 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13502 .table2
13503 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13504 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13505 .endtable
13506
13507
13508
13509 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13510 .table2
13511 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13512 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13513 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13514 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13515 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13516 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13517 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13518 .endtable
13519
13520
13521
13522 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13523 .table2
13524 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13525 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13526 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13527 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13528 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13529 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13530 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13531 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13532 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13533 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13534 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13535 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13536 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13537 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13538 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13539 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13540 connection"
13541 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13542 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13543 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13544 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13545 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13546 .endtable
13547
13548
13549
13550 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13551 .table2
13552 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13553 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13554 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13555 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13556 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13557 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13558 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13559 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13560 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13561 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13562 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13563 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13564 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13565 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13566 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13567 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13568 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13569 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13570 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13571 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13572 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13573 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13574 words""&"
13575 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13576 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13577 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13578 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13579 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13580 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13581 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13582 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13583 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13584 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13585 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13586 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13587 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13588 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13589 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13590 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13591 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13592 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13593 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13594 .endtable
13595
13596
13597
13598 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13599 .table2
13600 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13601 item"
13602 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13603 item"
13604 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13605 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13606 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13607 .endtable
13608
13609
13610
13611 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13612 .table2
13613 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13614 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13615 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13616 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13617 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13618 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13619 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13620 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13621 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13622 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13623 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13624 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13625 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13626 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13627 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13628 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13629 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13630 .endtable
13631
13632
13633
13634 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13635 .table2
13636 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13637 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13638 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13639 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13640 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13641 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13642 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13643 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13644 .endtable
13645
13646
13647
13648 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13649 .table2
13650 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13651 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13652 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13653 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13654 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13655 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13656 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13657 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13658 .endtable
13659
13660
13661
13662
13663 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13664 .table2
13665 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13666 .endtable
13667
13668
13669
13670
13671
13672 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13673 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13674
13675 .table2
13676 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13677 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13678 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13679 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13680 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13681 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13682 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13683 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13684 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13685 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13686 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13687 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13688 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13689 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13690 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13691 connection"
13692 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13693 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13694 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13695 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13696 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13697 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13698 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13699 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13700 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13701 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13702 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13703 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13704 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13705 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13706 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13707 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13708 .endtable
13709
13710
13711
13712 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13713 .table2
13714 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13715 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13716 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13717 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13718 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13719 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13720 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13721 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13722 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13723 .endtable
13724
13725
13726
13727 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13728 .table2
13729 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13730 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13731 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13732 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13733 words""&"
13734 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13735 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13736 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13737 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13738 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13739 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13740 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13741 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13742 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13743 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13744 .endtable
13745
13746
13747
13748 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13749 .table2
13750 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13751 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13752 directory"
13753 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13754 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13755 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13756 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13757 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13758 .endtable
13759
13760
13761
13762 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13763 .table2
13764 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13765 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13766 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13767 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13768 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13769 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13770 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13771 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13772 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13773 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13774 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13775 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13776 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13777 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13778 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13779 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13780 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13781 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13782 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13783 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13784 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13785 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13786 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13787 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13788 .endtable
13789
13790
13791
13792 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13793 .table2
13794 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13795 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13796 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13797 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
13798 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13799 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13800 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13801 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13802 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13803 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13804 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13805 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13806 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13807 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13808 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13809 .endtable
13810
13811
13812
13813 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13814 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13815 &dagger;.
13816
13817 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13818 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13819 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13820 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13821 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13822 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13823 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13824 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13825 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13826
13827 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13828 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13829 It now defaults to true.
13830 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13831 .display
13832 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13833 .endd
13834
13835 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13836 .code
13837 log_selector = +8bitmime
13838 .endd
13839
13840 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13841 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13842 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13843 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13844 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13845 further details.
13846
13847 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13848 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13849 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13850 SMTP messages.
13851
13852 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13853 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13854 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13855 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13856 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13857
13858 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13859 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13860 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13861 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13862 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13863
13864 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13865 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13866 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13867 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13868
13869 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13870 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13871 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13872 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13873 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13874
13875 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13876 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13877 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13878 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13879 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13880 This option defines the ACL that,
13881 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13882 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13883 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13884 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13885
13886 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13887 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13888 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13889 of a received message.
13890 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13891
13892 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13893 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13894 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13895 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13896
13897 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13898 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13899 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13900 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13901
13902 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13903 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13904 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13905 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13906 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13907
13908
13909 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13910 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13911 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13912 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13913
13914 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13915 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13916 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13917 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13918 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13919
13920 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13921 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13922 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13923 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13924 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13925
13926 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13927 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13928 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13929 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13930 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13931
13932 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13933 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13934 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13935 further details.
13936
13937 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13938 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13939 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13940 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13941
13942 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13943 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13944 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13945 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13946
13947 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13948 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13949 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13950 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13951
13952 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13953 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13954 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13955 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13956
13957 .new
13958 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
13959 .cindex "environment" "inherited"
13960 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
13961 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
13962 default list is empty,
13963 .wen
13964
13965 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13966 .cindex "admin user"
13967 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13968 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13969 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13970 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13971 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13972 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13973 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13974
13975 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13976 .cindex "domain literal"
13977 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13978 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13979 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13980 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13981
13982 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13983 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13984 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13985 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13986 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13987 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13988 the local host's IP addresses.
13989
13990
13991 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13992 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13993 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13994 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13995 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13996 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13997 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13998 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13999 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14000
14001 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14002 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14003 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14004 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14005 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14006 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14007 experiment if they wish.
14008
14009 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14010 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14011 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14012 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14013 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14014 suitable setting is:
14015 .code
14016 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14017 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14018 .endd
14019 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14020 .code
14021 dns_check_names_pattern =
14022 .endd
14023 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14024
14025
14026 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14027 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14028 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14029 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14030 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14031 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14032 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14033 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14034 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14035 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14036 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14037
14038 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14039 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14040 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14041 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14042 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14043 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14044
14045 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14046 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14047 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14048 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14049 .code
14050 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14051 .endd
14052 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14053 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14054 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14055 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14056
14057
14058 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14059 .cindex "thawing messages"
14060 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14061 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14062 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14063 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14064 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14065 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14066
14067 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14068 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14069 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14070
14071
14072 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14073 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14074 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14075 .code
14076 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14077 .endd
14078 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14079 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14080
14081
14082 .option bi_command main string unset
14083 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14084 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14085 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14086 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14087 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14088
14089
14090 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14091 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14092 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14093 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14094 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14095 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14096
14097
14098 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14099 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14100 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14101 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14102
14103 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14104 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14105 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14106 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14107 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14108 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14109 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14110 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14111 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14112 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14113
14114 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14115 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14116 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14117 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14118 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14119 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14120 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14121 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14122 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14123 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14124
14125 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14126 during reception of a messsage.
14127 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14128
14129 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14130
14131
14132 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14133 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14134 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14135 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14136
14137
14138 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14139 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14140 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14141 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14142 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14143 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14144 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14145 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14146 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14147
14148 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14149 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14150 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14151 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14152 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14153 messages.
14154
14155 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14156 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14157 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14158 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14159 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14160 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14161 connection. A typical setting might be:
14162 .code
14163 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14164 .endd
14165 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14166 .code
14167 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14168 .endd
14169 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14170 address.
14171
14172 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14173 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14174 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14175 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14176 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14177 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14178
14179
14180 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14181 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14182 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14183 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14184
14185
14186 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14187 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14188 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14189 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14190
14191
14192 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14193 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14194 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14195 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14196
14197
14198 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14199 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14200 callout verification. The default value is
14201 .code
14202 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14203 .endd
14204 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14205
14206
14207 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14208 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14209
14210
14211 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14212 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14213
14214 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14215 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14216 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14217 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14218 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14219 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14220 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14221 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14222 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14223 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14224
14225
14226 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14227 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14228
14229
14230 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14231 .cindex "checking disk space"
14232 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14233 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14234 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14235 message is accepted.
14236
14237 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14238 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14239 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14240 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14241 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14242 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14243 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14244 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14245
14246
14247 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14248 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14249 .code
14250 check_spool_space = 10M
14251 check_spool_inodes = 100
14252 .endd
14253 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14254 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14255 transit.
14256
14257 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14258 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14259 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14260
14261 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14262 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14263 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14264 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14265 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14266 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14267
14268 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14269 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14270
14271 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14272 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14273 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14274
14275 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14276 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14277 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14278 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14279 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14280 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14281
14282 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14283 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14284 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14285 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14286 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14287 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14288 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14289
14290 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14291 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14292
14293 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14294 .cindex "warning of delay"
14295 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14296 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14297 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14298 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14299 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14300 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14301 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14302 with
14303 .code
14304 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14305 .endd
14306 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14307 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14308 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14309 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14310 .code
14311 delay_warning = 6h
14312 .endd
14313 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14314 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14315 .code
14316 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14317 .endd
14318 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14319 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14320 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14321
14322 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14323 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14324 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14325 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14326 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14327 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14328 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14329 not sent. The default is:
14330 .code
14331 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14332 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14333 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14334 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14335 } {no}{yes}}
14336 .endd
14337 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14338 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14339 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14340 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14341
14342 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14343 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14344 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14345 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14346 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14347 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14348 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14349 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14350
14351 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14352 .cindex "load average"
14353 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14354 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14355 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14356 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14357 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14358
14359
14360 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14361 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14362 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14363 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14364 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14365 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14366 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14367 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14368
14369 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14370 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14371 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14372 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14373 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14374 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14375 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14376 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14377
14378 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14379 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14380 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14381 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14382
14383
14384 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14385 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14386 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14387 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14388 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14389 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14390 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14391
14392
14393 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14394 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14395 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14396 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14397 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14398 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14399
14400
14401 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14402 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14403 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14404 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14405 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14406 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14407 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14408 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14409 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14410 by a setting such as this:
14411 .code
14412 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14413 .endd
14414 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14415 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14416 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14417 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14418 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14419 options are applied after this global option.
14420
14421 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14422 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14423 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14424 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14425 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14426 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14427 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14428 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14429 value of this option. The default pattern is
14430 .code
14431 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14432 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14433 .endd
14434 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14435 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14436 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14437 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14438 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14439 empty string.
14440
14441 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14442 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14443 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14444
14445 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14446 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14447 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14448 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14449
14450
14451 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14452 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14453 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14454 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14455 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14456 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14457
14458 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14459
14460
14461 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14462 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14463 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14464 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14465 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14466 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14467 domain matches this list.
14468
14469 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14470 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14471 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14472
14473
14474 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14475 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14476 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14477 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14478 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14479 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14480 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14481 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14482 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14483 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14484 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14485 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14486 to set in them.
14487 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14488
14489
14490 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14491 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14492
14493
14494 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14495 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14496 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14497 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14498 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14499 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14500 match with this expanded domain list.
14501
14502 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14503 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14504 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14505 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14506 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14507 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14508
14509 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14510 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14511 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14512
14513 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14514 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14515 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14516 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14517 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14518
14519 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14520 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14521 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14522 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14523 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14524 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14525 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14526 on.
14527
14528 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14529
14530
14531 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14532 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14533 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14534 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14535
14536 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14537 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14538 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14539 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14540 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14541 and accepted from, these hosts.
14542 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14543 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14544 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14545 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14546 are sent.
14547
14548 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14549 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14550 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14551 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14552 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14553 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14554 .code
14555 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14556 .endd
14557 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14558 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14559
14560 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14561 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14562 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14563 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14564 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14565 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14566 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14567 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14568 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14569
14570
14571 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14572 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14573 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14574 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14575 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14576 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14577 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14578 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14579 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14580
14581 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14582 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14583 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14584 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14585 are examined. For example:
14586 .code
14587 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14588 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14589 postmaster@mydomain.example
14590 .endd
14591 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14592 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14593 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14594 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14595 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14596 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14597 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14598
14599
14600 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14601 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14602 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14603 .display
14604 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14605 .endd
14606 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14607 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14608 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14609 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14610 overrides the default.
14611
14612 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14613 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14614 and warning messages. For example:
14615 .code
14616 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14617 .endd
14618 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14619 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14620 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14621 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14622 not used.
14623
14624
14625 .new
14626 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14627 .cindex events
14628 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14629 For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14630 .wen
14631
14632
14633 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14634 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14635 .cindex "Exim group"
14636 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14637 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14638 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14639 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14640 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14641 security issues.
14642
14643
14644 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14645 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14646 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14647 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14648 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14649 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14650 other place.
14651 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14652 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14653 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14654 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14655
14656
14657 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14658 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14659 .cindex "Exim user"
14660 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14661 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14662 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14663 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14664
14665 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14666 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14667 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14668 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14669
14670
14671 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14672 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14673 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14674 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14675
14676
14677 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14678 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14679
14680 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14681 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14682 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14683 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14684 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14685 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14686 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14687 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14688 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14689 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14690 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14691 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14692 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14693 addresses.
14694
14695
14696 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14697 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14698 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14699 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14700 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14701 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14702 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14703 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14704 retries.
14705
14706 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14707 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14708 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14709 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14710
14711
14712
14713 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14714 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14715 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14716 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14717 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14718 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14719 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14720 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14721 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14722 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14723 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14724 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14725 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14726 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14727 logging that you require.
14728
14729
14730 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14731 .cindex "HP-UX"
14732 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14733 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14734 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14735 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14736 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14737 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14738 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14739 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14740
14741 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14742 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14743 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14744 user's name.
14745
14746 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14747 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14748 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14749 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14750 .code
14751 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14752 gecos_name = $1
14753 .endd
14754
14755 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14756 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14757
14758
14759 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14760 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14761 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14762 implementations of TLS.
14763
14764
14765 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14766 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14767 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14768
14769 See
14770 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14771 for documentation.
14772
14773
14774
14775 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14776 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14777 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14778 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14779 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14780 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14781
14782
14783
14784 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14785 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14786 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14787 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14788 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14789 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14790 sections are rejected.
14791
14792
14793 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14794 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14795 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14796 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14797 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14798 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14799 zero means &"no limit"&.
14800
14801
14802
14803
14804 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14805 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14806 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14807 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14808 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14809 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14810 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14811 if you want to do semantic checking.
14812 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14813 set.
14814
14815
14816 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14817 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14818 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14819 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14820 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14821 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14822 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14823 .code
14824 helo_allow_chars = _
14825 .endd
14826 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14827
14828
14829 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14830 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14831 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14832 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14833 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14834 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14835 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14836 do.
14837
14838
14839 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14840 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14841 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14842 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14843 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14844 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14845 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14846 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14847 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14848 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14849 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14850 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14851
14852 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14853 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14854 EHLO command either:
14855
14856 .ilist
14857 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14858 .next
14859 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14860 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14861 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14862 calling host address, or
14863 .next
14864 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14865 .endlist
14866
14867 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14868 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14869 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14870
14871 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14872 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14873 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14874
14875 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14876 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14877 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14878 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14879 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14880 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14881 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14882 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14883 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14884 error.
14885
14886 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14887 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14888 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14889 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14890 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14891 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14892 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14893 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14894 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14895
14896 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14897 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14898 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14899 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14900 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14901
14902 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14903 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14904 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14905 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14906
14907
14908 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14909 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14910 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14911 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14912 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14913 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14914 default configuration file contains
14915 .code
14916 host_lookup = *
14917 .endd
14918 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14919 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14920
14921 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14922 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14923 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14924
14925 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14926 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14927 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14928 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14929 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14930 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14931
14932
14933 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14934 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14935 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14936 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14937 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14938 if you want.
14939
14940 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14941 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14942 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14943 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14944
14945
14946
14947 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14948 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14949 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14950 as soon as the connection is made.
14951 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14952 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14953 connections immediately.
14954
14955 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14956 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14957 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14958 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14959 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14960
14961
14962 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14963 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14964 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14965 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14966 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14967 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14968 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14969 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14970 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14971 .code
14972 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14973 .endd
14974 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14975
14976
14977
14978 .new
14979 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
14980 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
14981 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
14982 connections. For details see &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
14983 .wen
14984
14985
14986 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14987 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14988 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14989 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14990 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14991 records
14992 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14993 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14994
14995 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14996 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14997 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14998 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14999 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15000 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15001 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15002
15003
15004 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15005 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15006 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15007 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15008 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15009
15010
15011
15012 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15013 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15014 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15015 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15016 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15017 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15018
15019 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15020 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15021 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15022 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15023 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15024 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15025 for frozen messages. For example,
15026 .code
15027 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15028 .endd
15029 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15030 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15031 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15032 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15033 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15034 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15035
15036
15037 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15038 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15039 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15040 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15041 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15042 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15043 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15044 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15045 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15046 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15047
15048
15049 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15050 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15051
15052 .new
15053 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15054 .cindex "environment" "inherited"
15055 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15056 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15057 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15058 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15059 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15060 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15061 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15062
15063 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15064 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15065
15066 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15067 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15068 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15069 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15070
15071 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startupif you do not mention
15072 &%keep_environment%& or &%add_environment%& in your runtime configuration
15073 file.
15074 .wen
15075
15076
15077 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15078 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15079 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15080 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15081 logged.
15082
15083
15084 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15085 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15086 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15087 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15088 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15089 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15090 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15091 and constrained to be a directory.
15092
15093
15094 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15095 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15096 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15097 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15098 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15099 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15100 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15101 and constrained to be a file.
15102
15103
15104 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15105 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15106 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15107 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15108 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15109 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15110
15111
15112 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15113 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15114 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15115 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15116 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15117 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15118 identity to be proven.
15119
15120
15121 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15122 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15123 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15124 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15125 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15126
15127
15128 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15129 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15130 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15131 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15132 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15133 with LDAP support.
15134
15135
15136 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15137 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15138 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15139 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15140 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15141 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15142 to hard/demand.
15143
15144
15145 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15146 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15147 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15148 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15149 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15150 of SSL-on-connect.
15151 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15152 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15153
15154
15155 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15156 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15157 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15158 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15159 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15160 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15161 has been built with LDAP support.
15162
15163
15164
15165 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15166 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15167 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15168 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15169 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15170 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15171 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15172
15173 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15174 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15175 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15176
15177 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15178 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15179 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15180 and the default qualify domain.
15181
15182 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15183 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15184 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15185 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15186
15187 .cindex "envelope sender"
15188 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15189 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15190 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15191
15192 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15193 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15194 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15195
15196
15197
15198
15199 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15200 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15201 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15202 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15203 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15204 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15205 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15206 example, if
15207 .code
15208 local_from_prefix = *-
15209 .endd
15210 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15211 .code
15212 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15213 .endd
15214 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15215 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15216 qualify domain.
15217
15218
15219 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15220 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15221
15222
15223 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15224 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15225 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15226 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15227 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15228 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15229 &%local_interfaces%& is
15230 .code
15231 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15232 .endd
15233 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15234 .code
15235 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15236 .endd
15237
15238 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15239 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15240 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15241 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15242 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15243 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15244 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15245 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15246
15247
15248
15249 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15250 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15251 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15252 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15253 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15254 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15255 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15256 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15257
15258
15259
15260
15261 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15262 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15263 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15264 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15265 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15266 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15267 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15268 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15269 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15270 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15271 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15272 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15273 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15274 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15275 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15276
15277
15278
15279 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15280 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15281 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15282 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15283 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15284 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15285 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15286 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15287 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15288 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15289 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15290 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15291 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15292 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15293 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15294
15295
15296 .option log_selector main string unset
15297 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15298 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15299 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15300 minus characters. For example:
15301 .code
15302 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15303 .endd
15304 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15305 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15306
15307
15308 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15309 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15310 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15311 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15312 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15313 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15314 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15315 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15316 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15317 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15318 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15319 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15320 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15321
15322
15323 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15324 .cindex "too many open files"
15325 .cindex "open files, too many"
15326 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15327 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15328 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15329 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15330 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15331 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15332 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15333 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15334 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15335 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15336 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15337 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15338
15339
15340 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15341 .cindex "length of login name"
15342 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15343 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15344 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15345 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15346 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15347 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15348
15349
15350 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15351 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15352 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15353 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15354 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15355 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15356 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15357 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15358
15359
15360 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15361 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15362 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15363 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15364 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15365 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15366 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15367
15368
15369 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15370 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15371 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15372 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15373 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15374 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15375 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15376 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15377 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15378 empty string, the option is ignored.
15379
15380
15381 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15382 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15383 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15384 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15385 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15386 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15387 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15388 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15389 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15390 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15391 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15392 colons will become hyphens.
15393
15394
15395 .option message_logs main boolean true
15396 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15397 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15398 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15399 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15400 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15401 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15402 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15403 which is not affected by this option.
15404
15405
15406 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15407 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15408 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15409 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15410 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15411 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15412 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15413 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15414 optionally followed by K or M.
15415
15416 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15417 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15418 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15419 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15420 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15421
15422 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15423 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15424 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15425 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15426 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15427 message that an individual transport can process.
15428
15429 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15430 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15431 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15432 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15433 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15434 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15435 some problems may result.
15436
15437 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15438 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15439 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15440
15441
15442 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15443 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15444 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15445 .code
15446 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15447 .endd
15448 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15449 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15450 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15451 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15452 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15453
15454
15455 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15456 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15457 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15458 contains a full description of this facility.
15459
15460
15461
15462 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15463 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15464 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15465 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15466 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15467
15468
15469 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15470 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15471 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15472 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15473 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15474 safety precaution.
15475
15476 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15477 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15478 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15479 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15480 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15481
15482 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15483 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15484 example is
15485 .code
15486 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15487 .endd
15488 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15489 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15490 transport driver.
15491
15492
15493 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use"
15494 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15495 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15496 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15497 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15498
15499 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15500 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15501 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15502 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15503 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15504 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15505 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15506
15507 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15508 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15509 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15510 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15511 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15512
15513 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15514
15515 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15516 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15517 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15518 some now infamous attacks.
15519
15520 Examples:
15521 .code
15522 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15523 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15524 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15525
15526 # Disable older protocol versions:
15527 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15528 .endd
15529
15530 Possible options may include:
15531 .ilist
15532 &`all`&
15533 .next
15534 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15535 .next
15536 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15537 .next
15538 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15539 .next
15540 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15541 .next
15542 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15543 .next
15544 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15545 .next
15546 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15547 .next
15548 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15549 .next
15550 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15551 .next
15552 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15553 .next
15554 &`no_compression`&
15555 .next
15556 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15557 .next
15558 &`no_sslv2`&
15559 .next
15560 &`no_sslv3`&
15561 .next
15562 &`no_ticket`&
15563 .next
15564 &`no_tlsv1`&
15565 .next
15566 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15567 .next
15568 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15569 .next
15570 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15571 .next
15572 &`single_dh_use`&
15573 .next
15574 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15575 .next
15576 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15577 .next
15578 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15579 .next
15580 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15581 .next
15582 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15583 .next
15584 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15585 .endlist
15586
15587 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15588 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15589 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15590 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15591 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15592 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15593
15594
15595 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15596 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15597 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15598 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15599 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15600
15601
15602 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15603 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15604 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15605 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15606 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15607 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15608 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15609 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15610 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15611 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15612 an ACL.
15613
15614 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15615 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15616 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15617 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15618 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15619 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15620 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15621
15622
15623 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15624 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15625 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15626
15627
15628 .option perl_startup main string unset
15629 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15630 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15631
15632
15633 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15634 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15635 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15636 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15637 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15638 PostgreSQL support.
15639
15640
15641 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15642 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15643 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15644 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15645 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15646 to the host name:
15647 .code
15648 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15649 .endd
15650 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15651 spool directory.
15652 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15653 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15654 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15655
15656
15657 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15658 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15659 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15660 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15661 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15662 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15663 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15664 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15665 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15666
15667
15668 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15669 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15670 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15671 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15672 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15673 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15674 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15675 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15676
15677 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15678 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15679 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15680 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15681 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15682 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15683 volume of mail. Use with care!
15684
15685
15686 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15687 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15688 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15689 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15690 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15691 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15692 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15693 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15694 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15695 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15696
15697 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15698 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15699 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15700 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15701 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15702 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15703
15704
15705 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15706 .cindex "printing characters"
15707 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15708 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15709 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15710 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15711 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15712 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15713 characters.
15714
15715 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15716 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15717 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15718 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15719 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15720 standards.
15721
15722
15723 .option process_log_path main string unset
15724 .cindex "process log path"
15725 .cindex "log" "process log"
15726 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15727 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15728 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15729 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15730 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15731 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15732 different spool directories.
15733
15734
15735 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15736 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15737 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15738 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15739 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15740 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15741 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15742
15743
15744 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15745 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15746 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15747 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15748 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15749 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15750 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15751 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15752 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15753
15754 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15755 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15756 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15757 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15758 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15759 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15760 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15761
15762
15763 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15764 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15765 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15766
15767
15768
15769 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15770 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15771 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15772 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15773 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15774 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15775 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15776 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15777
15778
15779 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15780 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15781 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15782 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15783 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15784
15785
15786 .option queue_only main boolean false
15787 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15788 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15789 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15790 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15791 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15792 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15793
15794 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15795 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15796 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15797 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15798
15799
15800 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15801 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15802 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15803 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15804 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15805 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15806 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15807 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15808 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15809 .code
15810 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15811 .endd
15812 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15813 &_/some/file_& exists.
15814
15815
15816 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15817 .cindex "load average"
15818 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15819 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15820 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15821 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15822 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15823 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15824 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15825 false.
15826
15827 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15828 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15829 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15830 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15831
15832
15833 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15834 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15835 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15836 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15837 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15838 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15839 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15840 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15841 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15842 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15843 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15844 re-evaluated for each message.
15845
15846
15847 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15848 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15849 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15850 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15851 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15852 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15853
15854
15855 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15856 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15857 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15858 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15859 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15860 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15861 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15862 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15863 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15864 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15865 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15866 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15867 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15868
15869
15870
15871 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15872 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15873 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15874 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15875 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15876 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15877 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15878 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15879 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15880
15881 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15882 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15883 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15884 the daemon's command line.
15885
15886 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15887 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15888 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15889 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15890 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15891 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15892 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15893 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15894 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15895 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15896 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15897 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15898 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15899 &%queue_domains%&.
15900
15901
15902 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15903 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15904 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15905 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15906 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15907 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15908 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15909
15910 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15911 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15912 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15913 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15914 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15915 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15916 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15917 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15918 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15919 header lines. The default setting is:
15920
15921 .code
15922 received_header_text = Received: \
15923 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15924 {${if def:sender_ident \
15925 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15926 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15927 by $primary_hostname \
15928 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15929 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15930 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15931 ${if def:sender_address \
15932 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15933 id $message_exim_id\
15934 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15935 .endd
15936
15937 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15938 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15939 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15940 header lines such as the following:
15941 .code
15942 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15943 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15944 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15945 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15946 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15947 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15948 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15949 .endd
15950 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15951 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15952 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15953 message was accepted.
15954
15955
15956 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15957 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15958 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15959 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15960 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15961 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15962 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15963 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15964
15965
15966 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15967 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15968 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15969 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15970 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15971 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15972 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15973 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15974 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15975 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15976 option was not set.
15977
15978
15979 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15980 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15981 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15982 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15983 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15984 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15985 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15986 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15987 done.
15988
15989 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15990 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15991 RCPT commands in a single message.
15992
15993
15994 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15995 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15996 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15997 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15998 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15999 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16000 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16001
16002
16003 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16004 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16005 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16006 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16007 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16008 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16009 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16010 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16011 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16012 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16013 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16014 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16015 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16016 tagged with its process id.
16017
16018 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16019 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16020 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16021 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16022 is received.
16023
16024 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16025 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16026 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16027 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16028 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16029 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16030 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16031 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16032 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16033 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16034 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16035
16036 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16037 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16038 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16039 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16040
16041
16042 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16043 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16044 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16045 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16046 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16047 .code
16048 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16049 .endd
16050 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16051 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16052
16053
16054 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16055 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16056 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16057 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16058 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16059 past failures.
16060
16061
16062 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16063 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16064 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16065 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16066 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16067 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16068 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16069 the default value.
16070
16071
16072 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16073 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16074 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16075 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16076 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16077 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16078 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16079 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16080 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16081 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16082
16083
16084 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16085 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16086
16087
16088 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16089 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16090 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16091 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16092 an item in the list.
16093 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16094 for the system.
16095
16096 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16097 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16098 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16099 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16100 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16101
16102
16103 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16104 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16105 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16106 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16107 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16108 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16109 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16110 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16111 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16112 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16113
16114 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16115 .cindex "environment"
16116 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16117 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16118 default list is empty,
16119
16120
16121 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16122 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16123 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16124 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16125 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16126 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16127 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16128
16129
16130
16131 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16132 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16133 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16134 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16135 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16136 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16137 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16138 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16139 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16140 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16141 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16142
16143
16144
16145 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16146 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16147 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16148 .cindex "inetd"
16149 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16150 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16151 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16152 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16153 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16154 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16155
16156 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16157 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16158 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16159 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16160
16161
16162 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16163 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16164 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16165 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16166 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16167 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16168 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16169 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16170
16171 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16172 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16173 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16174 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16175 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16176 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16177 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16178 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16179
16180
16181 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16182 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16183 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16184 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16185 live with.
16186
16187
16188 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16189 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16190 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16191 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16192 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16193 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16194 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16195 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16196 . the option name to split.
16197
16198 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16199 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16200 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16201 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16202 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16203 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16204 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16205 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16206 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16207 seen).
16208
16209
16210 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16211 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16212 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16213 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16214 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16215 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16216 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16217 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16218 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16219 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16220 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16221
16222 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16223 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16224 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16225 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16226 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16227 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16228
16229
16230
16231 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16232 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16233 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16234 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16235 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16236 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16237 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16238 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16239 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16240 to all messages received in the same connection.
16241
16242 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16243 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16244 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16245 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16246
16247
16248 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16249
16250 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16251 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16252 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16253 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16254 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16255 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16256 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16257 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16258 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16259 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16260 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16261 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16262 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16263
16264
16265 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16266 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16267 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16268 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16269 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16270 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16271 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16272 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16273 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16274 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16275 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16276 individual host.
16277
16278 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16279 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16280 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16281 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16282
16283
16284 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16285 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16286 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16287 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16288 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16289 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16290 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16291 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16292 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16293
16294 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16295 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16296 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16297 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16298
16299 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16300 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16301 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16302 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16303 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16304 For example:
16305 .code
16306 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16307 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16308 .endd
16309
16310 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16311 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16312 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16313 &%helo_data%& value.
16314
16315 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16316 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16317 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16318 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16319 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16320 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16321 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16322 .code
16323 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16324 $version_number $tod_full
16325 .endd
16326 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16327 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16328 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16329 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16330 multiline response).
16331
16332
16333 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16334 .cindex "checking disk space"
16335 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16336 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16337 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16338 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16339 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16340 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16341 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16342
16343
16344 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16345 .cindex "connection backlog"
16346 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16347 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16348 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16349 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16350 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16351 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16352 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16353 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16354 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16355 attacks by SYN flooding.
16356
16357
16358 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16359 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16360 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16361 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16362 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16363 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16364 fewer, but they still exist.
16365
16366 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16367 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16368 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16369 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16370 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16371 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16372 does detect many instances.
16373
16374 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16375 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16376 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16377 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16378
16379
16380
16381 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16382 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16383 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16384 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16385 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16386 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16387 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16388 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16389 example:
16390 .code
16391 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16392 $sender_host_address
16393 .endd
16394 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16395 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16396 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16397 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16398 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16399 the command.
16400
16401
16402 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16403 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16404 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16405 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16406 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16407
16408
16409 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16410 .cindex "load average"
16411 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16412 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16413 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16414 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16415 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16416 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16417
16418
16419
16420 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16421 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16422 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16423 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16424 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16425 .code
16426 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16427 .endd
16428 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16429 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16430 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16431 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16432 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16433
16434 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16435 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16436 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16437 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16438 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16439 not count towards the limit.
16440
16441
16442
16443 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16444 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16445 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16446 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16447 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16448 that subvert web
16449 clients
16450 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16451 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16452
16453
16454
16455 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16456 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16457 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16458 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16459 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16460 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16461 recipients.
16462
16463 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16464 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16465 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16466 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16467
16468 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16469 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16470 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16471 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16472 values:
16473
16474 .ilist
16475 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16476 .next
16477 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16478 fractional parts are allowed here.
16479 .next
16480 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16481 .next
16482 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16483 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16484 .endlist
16485
16486 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16487 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16488 .code
16489 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16490 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16491 .endd
16492 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16493 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16494 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16495 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16496
16497
16498 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16499 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16500
16501
16502 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16503 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16504
16505
16506 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16507 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16508 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16509 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16510 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16511 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16512 the message is abandoned.
16513 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16514 .code
16515 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16516 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16517 .endd
16518 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16519 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16520
16521 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16522 expanded before use and may depend on
16523 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16524
16525
16526 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16527 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16528 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16529 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16530 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16531 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16532
16533
16534 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16535 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16536 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16537
16538
16539 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16540 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16541 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16542 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16543 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16544 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16545 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16546 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16547 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16548 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16549 .code
16550 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16551 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16552 .endd
16553
16554
16555 .new
16556 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16557 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16558 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16559 the availability therof is advertised in
16560 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16561 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16562 .wen
16563
16564
16565 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16566 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16567 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16568 The default value is
16569 .code
16570 127.0.0.1 783
16571 .endd
16572 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16573
16574
16575
16576 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16577 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16578 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16579 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16580 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16581 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16582 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16583 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16584 arrival of the message.
16585
16586 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16587 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16588 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16589 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16590 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16591
16592 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16593 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16594 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16595 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16596 automatically deleted.
16597
16598 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16599 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16600 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16601 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16602 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16603 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16604 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16605 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16606 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16607
16608
16609 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16610 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16611 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16612 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16613 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16614 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16615 &$primary_hostname$&.
16616
16617 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16618 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16619 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16620 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16621 as failures in the configuration file.
16622
16623 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16624 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16625
16626 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16627 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16628 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16629 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16630
16631 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16632 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16633 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16634 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16635 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16636 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16637
16638 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16639 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16640 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16641 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16642 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16643 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16644 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16645
16646
16647 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16648 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16649 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16650 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16651 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16652 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16653 domain causes a syntax error.
16654 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16655 syntax checking.
16656
16657
16658 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16659 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16660 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16661 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16662 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16663 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16664 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16665 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16666 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16667 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16668 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16669 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16670
16671
16672 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16673 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16674 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16675 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16676 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16677 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16678 details of Exim's logging.
16679
16680
16681
16682 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16683 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16684 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16685 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16686 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16687
16688
16689
16690 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16691 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16692 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16693 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16694 details of Exim's logging.
16695
16696
16697 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16698 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16699 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16700 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16701 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16702 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16703 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16704 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16705 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16706 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16707 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16708
16709
16710 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16711 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16712 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16713 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16714 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16715 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16716
16717
16718 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16719 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16720 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16721 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16722 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16723
16724 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16725 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16726 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16727 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16728 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16729
16730 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16731 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16732 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16733 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16734 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16735 contains the pipe command.
16736
16737
16738 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16739 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16740 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16741 is used in a system filter.
16742
16743
16744 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16745 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16746 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16747 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16748 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16749 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16750 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16751 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16752 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16753 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16754
16755 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16756 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16757 transport option overrides.
16758
16759
16760 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16761 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16762 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16763 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16764 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16765 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16766 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16767 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16768 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16769 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16770 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16771 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16772 TCP_NODELAY.
16773
16774
16775 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16776 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16777 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16778 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16779 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16780 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16781 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16782 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16783 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16784 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16785
16786 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16787 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16788 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16789
16790
16791 .option timezone main string unset
16792 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16793 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16794 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16795 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16796 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16797 .code
16798 timezone = UTC
16799 .endd
16800 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16801 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16802 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16803 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16804 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16805 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16806
16807
16808 .new
16809 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16810 .wen
16811 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16812 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16813 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16814 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16815 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16816 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16817 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16818 .new
16819 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16820 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16821 the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16822 .wen
16823
16824
16825 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16826 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16827 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16828 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16829 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16830 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16831 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16832
16833 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16834 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16835 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16836 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16837
16838 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16839 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16840 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16841 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16842
16843 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16844 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16845 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16846 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16847 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16848
16849 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16850
16851
16852 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16853 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16854 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16855 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16856 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16857 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16858
16859 The value must be at least 1024.
16860
16861 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16862 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16863 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16864
16865 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16866 number.
16867
16868 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16869 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16870 larger prime than requested.
16871
16872
16873 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16874 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16875 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16876 to be used by Exim.
16877
16878 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16879 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16880 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16881 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16882 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16883 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16884 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16885
16886 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16887 loaded by Exim.
16888
16889 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16890 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16891 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16892 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16893
16894 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16895 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16896 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16897 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16898
16899 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16900 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16901 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16902 "ike23".
16903
16904 The available primes are:
16905 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16906 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16907 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16908
16909 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16910 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16911
16912 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16913 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16914 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16915 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16916 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16917 userbase.
16918
16919 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16920 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16921 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16922 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16923 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16924 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16925 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16926
16927
16928 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16929 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16930 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16931 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16932
16933 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16934 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16935 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16936 which tell the library to choose.
16937
16938 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16939
16940
16941 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16942 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16943 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16944 This option
16945 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16946 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16947 Certificate Authority.
16948
16949 .new
16950 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16951 .wen
16952
16953
16954 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16955 .cindex SSMTP
16956 .cindex SMTPS
16957 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16958 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16959 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16960 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16961
16962
16963
16964 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16965 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16966 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16967 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16968 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16969 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16970 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16971
16972 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16973
16974
16975 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16976 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16977 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16978 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16979 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16980 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16981 TLS session.
16982
16983
16984 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16985 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16986 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16987 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16988 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16989 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16990 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16991 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16992 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16993 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16994 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16995
16996
16997 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16998 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16999 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17000 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17001
17002
17003 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17004 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17005 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17006 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17007 word "system"
17008 or the absolute path to
17009 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17010 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17011
17012 The "system" value for the option will use a
17013 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17014 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17015 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17016 must be specified.
17017
17018 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17019 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17020
17021 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17022 explicitly
17023 either by file or directory
17024 are added to those given by the system default location.
17025
17026 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17027 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17028 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17029 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17030 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17031 use the explicit directory version.
17032
17033 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17034
17035 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17036 being unset.
17037
17038
17039 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17040 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17041 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17042 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17043 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17044 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17045 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17046 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17047
17048 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17049 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17050 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17051 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17052 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17053 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17054 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17055
17056 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17057 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17058 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17059 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17060 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17061 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17062 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17063 certificate"&.
17064
17065 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17066 certificates.
17067
17068
17069 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17070 .cindex "trusted groups"
17071 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17072 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17073 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17074 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17075 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17076 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17077 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17078 are trusted.
17079
17080 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17081 .cindex "trusted users"
17082 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17083 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17084 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17085 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17086 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17087 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17088 Exim user are trusted.
17089
17090 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17091 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17092 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17093 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17094 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17095 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17096 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17097 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17098 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17099 &%-F%& option.
17100
17101 .option unknown_username main string unset
17102 See &%unknown_login%&.
17103
17104 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17105 .cindex "trusted users"
17106 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17107 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17108 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17109 .cindex "envelope sender"
17110 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17111 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17112 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17113 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17114 is used) is ignored.
17115
17116 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17117 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17118 .code
17119 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17120 .endd
17121 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17122 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17123 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17124 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17125 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17126 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17127 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17128 followed by a hyphen
17129 by a setting like this:
17130 .code
17131 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17132 .endd
17133 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17134 restriction, you can use
17135 .code
17136 untrusted_set_sender = *
17137 .endd
17138 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17139 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17140 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17141 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17142 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17143 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17144 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17145 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17146
17147 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17148 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17149 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17150 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17151 sender address.
17152
17153
17154 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17155 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17156 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17157 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17158 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17159 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17160 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17161 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17162 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17163 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17164 .code
17165 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17166 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17167 .endd
17168 The pattern can be seen by running
17169 .code
17170 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17171 .endd
17172 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17173 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17174 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17175 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17176 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17177 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17178
17179
17180 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17181 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17182
17183
17184 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17185 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17186 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17187 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17188 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17189 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17190 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17191 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17192
17193
17194 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17195 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17196 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17197 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17198 .ecindex IIDconfima
17199 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17200
17201
17202
17203
17204 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17206
17207 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17208 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17209 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17210 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17211 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17212
17213 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17214 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17215 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17216 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17217 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17218
17219
17220
17221 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17222 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17223 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17224 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17225 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17226 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17227 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17228
17229 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17230 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17231 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17232 routers, and the eventual transport.
17233
17234 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17235 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17236 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17237 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17238 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17239
17240 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17241 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17242 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17243 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17244 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17245
17246 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17247 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17248 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17249 .code
17250 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17251 .endd
17252 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17253 .code
17254 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17255 .endd
17256 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17257 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17258
17259 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17260 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17261 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17262 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17263 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17264 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17265 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17266
17267
17268
17269 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17270 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17271 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17272 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17273 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17274 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17275 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17276 routing.
17277
17278
17279
17280 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17281 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17282 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17283 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17284 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17285 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17286 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17287 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17288 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17289 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17290 you could put:
17291 .code
17292 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17293 .endd
17294 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17295 and
17296 .code
17297 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17298 .endd
17299 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17300 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17301 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17302 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17303
17304
17305 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17306 .cindex "case of local parts"
17307 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17308 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17309 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17310 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17311 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17312 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17313 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17314 more details.
17315
17316 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17317 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17318 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17319 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17320 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17321 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17322 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17323 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17324 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17325
17326 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17327 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17328 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17329 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17330
17331
17332
17333 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17334 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17335 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17336 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17337 .vindex "&$home$&"
17338 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17339 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17340 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17341 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17342 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17343 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17344 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17345 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17346 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17347 the router is skipped.
17348
17349 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17350 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17351 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17352 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17353 setting to achieve this. For example:
17354 .code
17355 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17356 .endd
17357 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17358 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17359 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17360
17361
17362
17363 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17364 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17365 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17366 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17367 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17368 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17369 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17370 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17371
17372 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17373 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17374
17375 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17376 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17377
17378 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17379 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17380 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17381 .code
17382 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17383 .endd
17384 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17385 .code
17386 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17387 .endd
17388
17389 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17390 .code
17391 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17392 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17393 condition = foobar
17394 .endd
17395
17396 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17397 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17398 be specified using &%condition%&.
17399
17400 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17401 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17402 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17403 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17404 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17405 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17406 Router rules processing behavior.
17407
17408 This is best illustrated in an example:
17409 .code
17410 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17411 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17412
17413 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17414 true {yes} {no}}
17415
17416 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17417 {yes} {no}}
17418 .endd
17419 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17420 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17421 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17422 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17423 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17424 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17425 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17426 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17427
17428 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17429 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17430 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17431 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17432 string characters.
17433
17434 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17435 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17436 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17437 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17438 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17439
17440
17441 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17442 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17443 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17444 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17445 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17446 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17447 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17448 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17449 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17450 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17451 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17452 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17453 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17454 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17455
17456
17457
17458 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17459 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17460 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17461 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17462 transport option of the same name.
17463
17464 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17465 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17466 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17467 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17468 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17469 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17470 the dnssec request bit set.
17471 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17472
17473 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17474 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17475 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17476 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17477 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17478 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17479 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17480 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17481 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17482
17483
17484 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17485 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17486 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17487 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17488 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17489 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17490 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17491 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17492
17493
17494
17495 .option driver routers string unset
17496 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17497 to be used.
17498
17499
17500 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17501 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17502 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17503 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17504 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17505 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17506 Not effective on redirect routers.
17507
17508
17509
17510 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17511 .cindex "envelope sender"
17512 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17513 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17514 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17515 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17516 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17517 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17518 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17519
17520 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17521 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17522 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17523 setting.
17524
17525 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17526 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17527 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17528 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17529
17530 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17531 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17532 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17533 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17534 settings:
17535 .code
17536 errors_to =
17537 errors_to = ""
17538 .endd
17539 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17540 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17541 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17542 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17543 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17544
17545 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17546 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17547 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17548 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17549 setting &%return_path%&.
17550
17551 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17552 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17553 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17554
17555
17556
17557 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17558 .cindex "address" "testing"
17559 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17560 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17561 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17562 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17563 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17564 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17565 on for the system alias file.
17566 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17567 are evaluated.
17568
17569 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17570 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17571 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17572
17573
17574
17575 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17576 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17577 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17578 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17579
17580
17581
17582 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17583 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17584 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17585
17586
17587
17588 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17589 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17590 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17591
17592
17593
17594 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17595 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17596 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17597 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17598 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17599 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17600 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17601 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17602 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17603
17604 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17605 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17606 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17607 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17608 transport for further details.
17609
17610
17611 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17612 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17613 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17614 .cindex "transport" "local"
17615 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17616 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17617 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17618 process.
17619 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17620 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17621 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17622 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17623 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17624
17625
17626
17627 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17628 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17629 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17630 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17631 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17632 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17633 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17634 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17635 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17636 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17637 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17638 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17639 &"see"& the added header lines.
17640
17641 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17642 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17643 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17644 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17645
17646 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17647 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17648
17649 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17650 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17651
17652 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17653 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17654 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17655 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17656 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17657 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17658 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17659 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17660 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17661 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17662
17663
17664
17665 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17666 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17667 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17668 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17669 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17670 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17671 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17672 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17673 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17674 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17675 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17676 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17677 &"see"& the original header lines.
17678
17679 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17680 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17681 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17682 errors.
17683
17684 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17685 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17686
17687 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17688 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17689
17690 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17691 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17692 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17693 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17694
17695 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17696 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17697 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17698
17699
17700
17701 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17702 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17703 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17704 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17705 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17706 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17707 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17708 like
17709 .code
17710 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17711 .endd
17712 by setting
17713 .code
17714 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17715 .endd
17716 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17717 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17718 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17719 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17720 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17721 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17722
17723 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17724 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17725 .code
17726 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17727 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17728 .endd
17729 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17730 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17731
17732 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17733 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17734 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17735 domain that is being routed.
17736
17737 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17738 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17739 checked.
17740
17741 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17742 .cindex "additional groups"
17743 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17744 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17745 .cindex "transport" "local"
17746 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17747 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17748 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17749 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17750 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17751
17752
17753
17754 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17755 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17756 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17757 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17758 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17759 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17760 evaluated.
17761
17762 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17763 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17764 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17765 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17766 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17767 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17768 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17769 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17770 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17771
17772 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17773 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17774 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17775 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17776 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17777 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17778 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17779 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17780 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17781 the relevant transport.
17782
17783 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17784 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17785 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17786 callout.
17787
17788 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17789 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17790 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17791 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17792 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17793 .code
17794 real_localuser:
17795 driver = accept
17796 local_part_prefix = real-
17797 check_local_user
17798 transport = local_delivery
17799 .endd
17800 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17801 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17802 .code
17803 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17804 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17805 .endd
17806
17807 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17808 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17809 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17810 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17811
17812
17813 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17814 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17815
17816
17817
17818 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17819 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17820 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17821 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17822 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17823 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17824 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17825 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17826 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17827 &%username-foo%&.
17828
17829
17830 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17831 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17832
17833
17834
17835 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17836 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17837 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17838 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17839 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17840 are evaluated, and
17841 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17842 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17843 example:
17844 .code
17845 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17846 .endd
17847 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17848 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17849 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17850 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17851 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17852 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17853 each virtual domain:
17854 .code
17855 postmaster:
17856 driver = redirect
17857 local_parts = postmaster
17858 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17859 .endd
17860
17861
17862 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17863 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17864 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17865 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17866 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17867 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17868 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17869 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17870 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17871 redirect addresses.
17872
17873
17874
17875 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17876 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17877 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17878 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17879 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17880 delivery to be deferred.
17881
17882 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17883 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17884 .oindex "&%self%&"
17885 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17886 means of the setting
17887 .code
17888 self = pass
17889 .endd
17890 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17891 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17892 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17893
17894 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17895 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17896 controls what happens next.
17897
17898
17899 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17900 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17901 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17902 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17903 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17904 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17905 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17906 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17907
17908 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17909 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17910 applies to all of them.
17911
17912
17913
17914 .option pass_router routers string unset
17915 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17916 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17917 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17918 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17919 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17920 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17921 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17922 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17923 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17924 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17925
17926
17927
17928 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17929 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17930 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17931 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17932 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17933 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17934
17935 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17936 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17937 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17938 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17939
17940
17941
17942 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17943 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17944 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17945 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17946 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17947 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17948 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17949
17950 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17951 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17952 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17953 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17954
17955 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17956 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17957 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17958 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17959 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17960
17961 .cindex "NFS"
17962 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17963 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17964 unavailable.
17965
17966 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17967 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17968 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17969 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17970 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17971 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17972 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17973 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17974
17975 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17976 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17977 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17978 operates as follows:
17979
17980 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17981 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17982 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17983 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17984 used. For example:
17985 .code
17986 require_files = mail:/some/file
17987 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17988 .endd
17989 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17990 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17991
17992 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17993 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17994 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17995 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17996
17997 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17998 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17999 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18000 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18001 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18002
18003 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18004 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18005 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18006 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18007 check again in that process.
18008
18009 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18010 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18011 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18012 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18013 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18014 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18015 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18016 .code
18017 require_files = +/some/file
18018 .endd
18019 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18020 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18021 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18022
18023
18024
18025 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18026 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18027 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18028 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18029 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18030 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18031 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18032 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18033 latter kind.
18034
18035 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18036 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18037 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18038 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18039 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18040 same name.
18041
18042 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18043 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18044 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18045
18046
18047
18048 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18049 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18050 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18051 .vindex "&$home$&"
18052 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18053 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18054 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18055 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18056 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18057 cause the router to defer.
18058
18059 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18060 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18061 place.
18062 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18063 are evaluated.)
18064 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18065 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18066
18067 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18068 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18069 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18070 of these values that is set:
18071
18072 .ilist
18073 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18074 .next
18075 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18076 .next
18077 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18078 .next
18079 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18080 .endlist
18081
18082 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18083 router, but not for the transport.
18084
18085
18086
18087 .option self routers string freeze
18088 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18089 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18090 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18091 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18092 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18093 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18094 of remote hosts.
18095 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18096 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18097 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18098 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18099 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18100
18101 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18102 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18103 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18104 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18105 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18106 cases:
18107
18108 .vlist
18109 .vitem &%defer%&
18110 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18111
18112 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18113 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18114 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18115 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18116
18117 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18118 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18119 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18120 rewritten.
18121
18122 .vitem &%pass%&
18123 .oindex "&%more%&"
18124 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18125 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18126 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18127 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18128 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18129 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18130 combination
18131 .code
18132 self = pass
18133 no_more
18134 .endd
18135 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18136 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18137 be passed to the next router.
18138
18139 .vitem &%fail%&
18140 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18141
18142 .vitem &%send%&
18143 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18144 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18145 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18146 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18147 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18148 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18149 .endlist
18150
18151
18152
18153 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18154 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18155 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18156 address matches something on the list.
18157 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18158 are evaluated.
18159
18160 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18161 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18162 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18163 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18164 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18165 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18166 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18167 matters.
18168
18169
18170 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18171 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18172 .cindex "packet radio"
18173 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18174 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18175 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18176 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18177 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18178 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18179 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18180 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18181
18182 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18183 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18184 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18185 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18186 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18187 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18188 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18189 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18190 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18191 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18192 .code
18193 translate_ip_address = \
18194 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18195 {$value}fail}}
18196 .endd
18197 The file would contain lines like
18198 .code
18199 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18200 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18201 .endd
18202 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18203 are doing.
18204
18205
18206
18207 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18208 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18209 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18210 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18211 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18212 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18213 delivery is deferred.
18214
18215 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18216 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18217 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18218
18219
18220
18221 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18222 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18223 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18224 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18225 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18226 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18227 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18228 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18229 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18230 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18231 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18232 environment.
18233
18234
18235
18236
18237 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18238 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18239 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18240 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18241 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18242 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18243 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18244 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18245 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18246 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18247
18248 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18249 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18250 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18251 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18252 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18253
18254 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18255 environment.
18256
18257
18258
18259
18260 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18261 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18262 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18263 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18264 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18265 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18266 delivery to be deferred.
18267
18268 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18269 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18270 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18271 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18272 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18273 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18274
18275 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18276 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18277 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18278 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18279 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18280 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18281 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18282 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18283
18284 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18285 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18286 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18287 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18288 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18289 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18290 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18291 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18292 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18293 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18294
18295 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18296 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18297 subsequent routers.
18298
18299
18300 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18301 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18302 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18303 .cindex "transport" "local"
18304 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18305 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18306 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18307 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18308 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18309 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18310 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18311 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18312 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18313 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18314 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18315 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18316
18317
18318
18319 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18320 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18321 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18322
18323
18324 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18325 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18326 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18327 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18328 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18329 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18330 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18331 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18332 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18333 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18334
18335 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18336 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18337 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18338 user or group.
18339
18340
18341 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18342 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18343 addresses,
18344 delivering in cutthrough mode
18345 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18346 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18347 are evaluated.
18348 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18349
18350
18351 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18352 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18353 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18354 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18355 are evaluated.
18356 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18357 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18358 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18359
18360
18361
18362
18363
18364
18365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18367
18368 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18369 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18370 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18371 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18372 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18373 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18374 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18375 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18376 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18377 .code
18378 localusers:
18379 driver = accept
18380 domains = mydomain.example
18381 check_local_user
18382 transport = local_delivery
18383 .endd
18384 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18385 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18386 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18387 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18388
18389
18390
18391
18392
18393
18394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18396
18397 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18398 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18399 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18400 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18401 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18402 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18403
18404 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18405 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18406 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18407 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18408 records.
18409
18410 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18411 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18412 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18413 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18414 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18415 generic option, the router declines.
18416
18417 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18418 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18419 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18420
18421 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18422 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18423 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18424 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18425 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18426 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18427
18428
18429 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18430 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18431 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18432 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18433 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18434 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18435
18436 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18437 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18438 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18439 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18440 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18441 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18442 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18443 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18444 case routing fails.
18445
18446
18447 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18448 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18449 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18450 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18451 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18452
18453 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18454 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18455
18456 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18457 .ilist
18458 The domain does not exist in DNS
18459 .next
18460 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18461 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18462 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18463 .next
18464 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18465 .next
18466 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18467 .next
18468 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18469 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18470 .next
18471 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18472 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18473 .next
18474 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18475 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18476 .next
18477 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18478 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18479 .endlist
18480
18481
18482
18483
18484 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18485 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18486 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18487
18488 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18489 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18490 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18491 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18492 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18493 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18494 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18495
18496
18497 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18498 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18499 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18500 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18501 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18502 required. For example,
18503 .code
18504 check_srv = smtp
18505 .endd
18506 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18507 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18508 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18509 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18510 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18511 normal way.
18512
18513 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18514 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18515 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18516 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18517 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18518 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18519
18520 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18521 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18522 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18523 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18524 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18525 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18526 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18527 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18528
18529 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18530 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18531
18532
18533
18534
18535 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18536 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18537 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18538 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18539 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18540 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18541 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18542 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18543 also being queued.
18544
18545
18546 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18547 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18548 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18549 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18550 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18551 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18552 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18553 setting:
18554 .code
18555 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18556 .endd
18557 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18558 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18559 the address record.
18560
18561
18562 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18563 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18564 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18565 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18566
18567
18568
18569
18570 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18571 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18572 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18573 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18574 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18575 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18576 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18577 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18578 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18579 &'resolv.conf'&.
18580
18581
18582
18583 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18584 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18585 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18586 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18587 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18588 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18589 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18590 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18591 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18592 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18593 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18594
18595 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18596 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18597 sense.
18598
18599 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18600 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18601 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18602 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18603 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18604 header rewriting.
18605
18606
18607 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18608 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18609 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18610 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18611 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18612 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18613 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18614 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18615
18616 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18617 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18618 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18619 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18620 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18621 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18622 without processing them independently,
18623 provided the following conditions are met:
18624
18625 .ilist
18626 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18627 &%headers_remove%&.
18628 .next
18629 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18630 the domain.
18631 .endlist
18632
18633
18634
18635
18636 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18637 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18638 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18639 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18640 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18641 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18642 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18643 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18644 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18645 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18646
18647 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18648 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18649 local wildcard.
18650
18651
18652
18653 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18654 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18655 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18656 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18657
18658
18659
18660
18661 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18662 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18663 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18664 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18665 if
18666 .code
18667 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18668 .endd
18669 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18670 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18671 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18672 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18673 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18674 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18675
18676
18677 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18678 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18679 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18680 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18681 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18682
18683 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18684 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18685 such as that implied by
18686 .code
18687 domains = @mx_any
18688 .endd
18689 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18690 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18691 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18692 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18693
18694
18695
18696
18697
18698
18699
18700
18701
18702 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18703 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18704
18705 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18706 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18707 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18708 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18709 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18710 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18711 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18712 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18713 router handles the address
18714 .code
18715 root@[192.168.1.1]
18716 .endd
18717 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18718 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18719 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18720 .code
18721 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18722 .endd
18723 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18724 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18725
18726 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18727 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18728 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18729 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18730
18731 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18732 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18733 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18734 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18735
18736
18737
18738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18740
18741 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18742 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18743 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18744 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18745 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18746 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18747 must set
18748 .code
18749 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18750 .endd
18751 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18752
18753 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18754 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18755 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18756 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18757 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18758 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18759 must not be specified for it.
18760
18761 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18762 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18763 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18764 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18765 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18766 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18767 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18768
18769
18770 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18771 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18772 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18773 delivery to the address is deferred.
18774
18775
18776 .option port iplookup integer 0
18777 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18778 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18779 call.
18780
18781
18782 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18783 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18784 protocols is to be used.
18785
18786
18787 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18788 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18789 default value is:
18790 .code
18791 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18792 .endd
18793 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18794 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18795
18796
18797 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18798 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18799 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18800 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18801 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18802 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18803 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18804 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18805
18806
18807 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18808 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18809 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18810 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18811 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18812 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18813 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18814 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18815 following could be used:
18816 .code
18817 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18818 reroute = $local_part@$1
18819 .endd
18820
18821 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18822 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18823 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18824 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18825
18826
18827
18828
18829 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18830 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18831
18832 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18833 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18834 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18835 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18836 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18837 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18838 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18839 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18840 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18841 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18842
18843 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18844 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18845 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18846 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18847 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18848 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18849 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18850
18851 .vindex "&$host$&"
18852 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18853 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18854 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18855 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18856 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18857 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18858 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18859 text string.
18860
18861 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18862 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18863 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18864 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18865 below, following the list of private options.
18866
18867
18868 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18869
18870 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18871 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18872
18873 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18874 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18875
18876 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18877 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18878 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18879 of the following values:
18880 .code
18881 decline
18882 defer
18883 fail
18884 freeze
18885 ignore
18886 pass
18887 .endd
18888 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18889 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18890 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18891 &%pass_router%&),
18892 .oindex "&%more%&"
18893 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18894 router only if &%more%& is true.
18895
18896 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18897 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18898 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18899 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18900
18901 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18902 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18903 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18904
18905
18906 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18907 .cindex "randomized host list"
18908 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18909 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18910 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18911 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18912 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18913 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18914 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18915 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18916
18917 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18918 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18919 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18920 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18921 .code
18922 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18923 .endd
18924 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18925 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18926 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18927 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18928 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18929
18930
18931 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18932 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18933 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18934 example:
18935 .code
18936 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18937 .endd
18938 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18939 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18940 deferred.
18941
18942
18943 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18944 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18945 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18946 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18947
18948
18949 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18950 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18951 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18952 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18953 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18954 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18955 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18956 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18957
18958 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18959 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18960 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18961 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18962 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18963 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18964 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18965 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18966
18967
18968
18969
18970 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18971 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18972 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18973 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18974 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18975 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18976 .display
18977 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18978 .endd
18979 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18980 no options:
18981 .code
18982 route_list = \
18983 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18984 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18985 .endd
18986 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18987 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18988 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18989 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18990 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18991 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18992 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18993 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18994 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18995 in a &%route_list%&).
18996
18997 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18998 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18999 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19000 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19001
19002
19003
19004 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19005 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19006 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19007 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19008 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19009 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19010 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19011 like this:
19012 .code
19013 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19014 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19015 .endd
19016 This data can be accessed by setting
19017 .code
19018 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19019 .endd
19020 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19021 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19022 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19023 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19024 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19025
19026
19027
19028
19029 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19030 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19031 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19032 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19033 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19034 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19035 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19036
19037 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19038 variables are set during its expansion:
19039
19040 .ilist
19041 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19042 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19043 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19044 .code
19045 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19046 .endd
19047 .next
19048 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19049 .next
19050 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19051
19052 .next
19053 .vindex "&$value$&"
19054 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19055 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19056 .code
19057 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19058 .endd
19059 .endlist
19060
19061 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19062 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19063
19064
19065
19066 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19067 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19068 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19069 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19070 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19071 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19072
19073 .ilist
19074 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19075 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19076 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19077 .code
19078 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19079 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19080 .endd
19081 .next
19082 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19083 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19084 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19085 number follows. For example:
19086 .code
19087 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19088 .endd
19089 .endlist
19090
19091 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19092 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19093 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19094 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19095 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19096 transport.
19097
19098 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19099 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19100 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19101 records in the DNS. For example:
19102 .code
19103 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19104 .endd
19105 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19106 example:
19107 .code
19108 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19109 .endd
19110 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19111 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19112 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19113 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19114 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19115 happens is controlled by the
19116 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19117 &%self%& option of the router.
19118
19119 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19120 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19121 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19122 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19123 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19124 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19125 defined by MX preferences.
19126
19127 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19128 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19129 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19130
19131 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19132 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19133 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19134 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19135
19136 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19137 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19138 router.
19139
19140 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19141 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19142 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19143
19144 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19145 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19146
19147
19148
19149 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19150 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19151 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19152 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19153 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19154 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19155 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19156
19157 .ilist
19158 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19159 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19160 .next
19161 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19162 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19163 .next
19164 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19165 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19166 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19167 .next
19168 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19169 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19170 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19171 .endlist
19172
19173 For example:
19174 .code
19175 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19176 domain2 host4:host5
19177 .endd
19178 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19179 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19180 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19181 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19182 call.
19183
19184 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19185 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19186 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19187 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19188 function called.
19189
19190
19191
19192 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19193 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19194
19195 .vindex "&$host$&"
19196 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19197 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19198
19199
19200
19201 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19202 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19203 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19204
19205 .ilist
19206 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19207 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19208 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19209 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19210 .code
19211 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19212 .endd
19213 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19214 your first router something like this:
19215 .code
19216 smart_route:
19217 driver = manualroute
19218 domains = !+local_domains
19219 transport = remote_smtp
19220 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19221 .endd
19222 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19223 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19224 they are tried in order
19225 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19226 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19227 .code
19228 smart_route:
19229 driver = manualroute
19230 transport = remote_smtp
19231 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19232 .endd
19233 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19234 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19235 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19236 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19237 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19238 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19239 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19240 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19241
19242 .next
19243 .cindex "mail hub example"
19244 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19245 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19246 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19247 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19248 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19249 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19250 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19251 lookup is easier to manage.
19252
19253 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19254 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19255 example:
19256 .code
19257 hub_route:
19258 driver = manualroute
19259 transport = remote_smtp
19260 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19261 .endd
19262 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19263 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19264 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19265 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19266 domain can be used to find the host:
19267 .code
19268 through_firewall:
19269 driver = manualroute
19270 transport = remote_smtp
19271 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19272 .endd
19273 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19274 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19275 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19276 next router.
19277
19278 .next
19279 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19280 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19281 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19282 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19283 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19284 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19285 .code
19286 save_in_file:
19287 driver = manualroute
19288 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19289 route_list = saved.domain.example
19290 .endd
19291 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19292 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19293 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19294 .code
19295 save_in_file:
19296 driver = manualroute
19297 route_list = \
19298 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19299 *.saved.domain2.example \
19300 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19301 batch_pipe
19302 .endd
19303 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19304 .vindex "&$host$&"
19305 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19306 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19307 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19308 the address if the lookup fails.
19309
19310 .next
19311 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19312 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19313 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19314 one way it can be done:
19315 .code
19316 # Transport
19317 uucp:
19318 driver = pipe
19319 user = nobody
19320 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19321 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19322 return_fail_output = true
19323
19324 # Router
19325 uucphost:
19326 transport = uucp
19327 driver = manualroute
19328 route_data = \
19329 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19330 .endd
19331 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19332 .code
19333 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19334 .endd
19335 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19336 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19337 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19338 .endlist
19339 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19340 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19341
19342
19343
19344
19345
19346
19347
19348
19349 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19350 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19351
19352 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19353 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19354 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19355 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19356 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19357 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19358 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19359 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19360 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19361 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19362 options:
19363 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19364
19365 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19366 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19367 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19368 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19369 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19370
19371
19372 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19373 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19374 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19375 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19376 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19377 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19378
19379
19380 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19381 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19382 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19383 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19384 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19385 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19386 not set, a value for the gid also.
19387
19388 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19389 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19390 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19391 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19392 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19393 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19394 gid.
19395
19396
19397 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19398 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19399 before running the command.
19400
19401
19402 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19403 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19404 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19405 timeout.
19406
19407
19408 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19409 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19410 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19411 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19412 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19413
19414 .ilist
19415 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19416 below).
19417 .next
19418 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19419 &%no_more%& is set.
19420 .next
19421 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19422 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19423 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19424 included in the SMTP response.
19425 .next
19426 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19427 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19428 included in any SMTP response.
19429 .next
19430 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19431 .next
19432 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19433 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19434 .next
19435 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19436 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19437 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19438 .endlist
19439
19440 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19441 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19442 the page):
19443 .code
19444 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19445 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19446 .endd
19447 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19448 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19449 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19450 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19451
19452 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19453 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19454 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19455 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19456 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19457
19458 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19459 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19460 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19461 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19462 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19463
19464 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19465 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19466 variable. For example, this return line
19467 .code
19468 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19469 .endd
19470 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19471 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19472 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19473 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19474
19475
19476
19477
19478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19480
19481 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19482 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19483 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19484 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19485 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19486 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19487 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19488 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19489 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19490 redirected in several different ways:
19491
19492 .ilist
19493 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19494 independently.
19495 .next
19496 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19497 .next
19498 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19499 .next
19500 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19501 .next
19502 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19503 .next
19504 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19505 .next
19506 It can be discarded.
19507 .endlist
19508
19509 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19510 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19511 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19512 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19513
19514 If success DSNs have been requested
19515 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19516 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19517 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19518
19519
19520
19521 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19522 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19523 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19524 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19525 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19526 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19527 .code
19528 system_aliases:
19529 driver = redirect
19530 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19531 .endd
19532 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19533 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19534 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19535 cause delivery to be deferred.
19536
19537 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19538 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19539 .code
19540 userforward:
19541 driver = redirect
19542 check_local_user
19543 file = $home/.forward
19544 no_verify
19545 .endd
19546 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19547 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19548 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19549 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19550 comments.
19551
19552
19553
19554 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19555 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19556 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19557 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19558
19559 .ilist
19560 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19561 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19562 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19563 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19564 .next
19565 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19566 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19567 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19568 saves some resources.
19569 .endlist
19570
19571
19572
19573
19574
19575
19576 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19577 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19578 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19579 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19580 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19581
19582 .ilist
19583 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19584 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19585 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19586 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19587 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19588 document is intended for use by end users.
19589 .next
19590 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19591 described in the next section.
19592 .endlist
19593
19594 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19595 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19596 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19597 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19598 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19599
19600
19601
19602 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19603 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19604 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19605 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19606 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19607 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19608 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19609 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19610 commas or newlines.
19611 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19612 quotes.
19613
19614 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19615 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19616 next newline character is ignored.
19617
19618 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19619 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19620 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19621 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19622 removed.
19623
19624 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19625 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19626 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19627 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19628 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19629 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19630 setting:
19631 .code
19632 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19633 .endd
19634
19635
19636 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19637 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19638 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19639 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19640 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19641 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19642 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19643 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19644 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19645 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19646 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19647
19648 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19649 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19650 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19651 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19652 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19653 .code
19654 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19655 .endd
19656 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19657 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19658 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19659 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19660 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19661 synonymously.
19662
19663 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19664 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19665 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19666 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19667 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19668
19669 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19670 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19671 contains:
19672 .code
19673 Sam.Reman: spqr
19674 .endd
19675 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19676 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19677 this forward file:
19678 .code
19679 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19680 .endd
19681 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19682 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19683 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19684 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19685 should really contain
19686 .code
19687 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19688 .endd
19689 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19690 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19691 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19692
19693
19694
19695 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19696 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19697 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19698
19699 .ilist
19700 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19701 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19702 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19703 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19704 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19705 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19706 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19707
19708 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19709 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19710 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19711 in double quotes, for example:
19712 .code
19713 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19714 .endd
19715 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19716 quote just the command. An item such as
19717 .code
19718 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19719 .endd
19720 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19721
19722 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19723 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19724 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19725 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19726 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19727 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19728 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19729 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19730 an &%accept%& router.
19731
19732 .next
19733 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19734 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19735 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19736 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19737 .code
19738 /home/world/minbari
19739 .endd
19740 is treated as a file name, but
19741 .code
19742 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19743 .endd
19744 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19745 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19746 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19747 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19748
19749 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19750 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19751
19752 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19753 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19754 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19755 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19756
19757 .next
19758 .cindex "included address list"
19759 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19760 If an item is of the form
19761 .code
19762 :include:<path name>
19763 .endd
19764 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19765 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19766 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19767 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19768 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19769 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19770 .code
19771 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19772 .endd
19773 It must be given as
19774 .code
19775 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19776 .endd
19777 .next
19778 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19779 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19780 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19781 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19782 .cindex "black hole"
19783 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19784 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19785 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19786 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19787
19788 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19789 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19790 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19791 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19792 &_/dev/null_&.
19793
19794 .next
19795 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19796 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19797 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19798 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19799 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19800 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19801 redirection items of the form
19802 .code
19803 :defer:
19804 :fail:
19805 .endd
19806 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19807 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19808 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19809 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19810 .code
19811 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19812 .endd
19813 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19814 of a
19815 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19816 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19817 default.
19818 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19819 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19820 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19821
19822 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19823 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19824 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19825 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19826 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19827 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19828 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19829 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19830 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19831 ignored.
19832
19833 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19834 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19835 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19836 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19837
19838 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19839 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19840 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19841 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19842 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19843
19844 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19845 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19846 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19847 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19848 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19849 rules still apply.
19850
19851 .next
19852 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19853 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19854 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19855 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19856 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19857 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19858 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19859 .endlist
19860
19861
19862 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19863 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19864 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19865 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19866 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19867 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19868 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19869 aliasing scheme of the type
19870 .code
19871 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19872 localpart1: pipe
19873 localpart2: pipe
19874 .endd
19875 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19876 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19877 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19878 such as
19879 .code
19880 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19881 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19882 .endd
19883 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19884 the pipes are distinct.
19885
19886
19887
19888 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19889 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19890 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19891 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19892 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19893 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19894 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19895 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19896 can be used to avoid this.
19897
19898
19899 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19900 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19901 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19902 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19903 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19904 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19905 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19906
19907
19908
19909 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19910
19911 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19912 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19913
19914
19915 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19916 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19917 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19918
19919
19920 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19921 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19922 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19923 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19924
19925
19926 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19927 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19928 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19929 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19930 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19931 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19932 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19933
19934 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19935 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19936
19937
19938 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19939 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19940 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19941 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19942 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19943
19944
19945
19946 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19947 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19948 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19949 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19950 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19951 let ordinary users do.
19952
19953
19954
19955 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19956 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19957 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19958 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19959 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19960 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19961
19962 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19963 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19964 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19965 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19966 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19967 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19968 .code
19969 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19970 .endd
19971 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19972 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19973 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19974 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19975 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19976 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19977 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19978 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19979
19980
19981 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19982 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19983 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19984 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19985 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19986 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19987 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19988 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19989
19990
19991
19992 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19993 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19994 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19995 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19996 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19997 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19998
19999
20000 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20001 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20002 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20003 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20004 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20005 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20006
20007 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20008 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20009 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20010 .code
20011 data = #Exim filter\n\
20012 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20013 .endd
20014 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20015 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20016 choice into a newline.
20017
20018
20019 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20020 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20021 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20022 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20023 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20024
20025
20026 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20027 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20028 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20029 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20030 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20031 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20032 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20033 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20034
20035 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20036 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20037 runs a check on the containing directory,
20038 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20039 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20040 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20041 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20042 not, the router declines.
20043
20044
20045 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20046 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20047 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20048 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20049 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20050 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20051 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20052
20053
20054 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20055 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20056 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20057 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20058 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20059
20060
20061 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20062 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20063 redirection list.
20064
20065
20066 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20067 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20068 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20069
20070
20071
20072
20073 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20074 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20075 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20076 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20077 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20078 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20079 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20080 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20081 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20082
20083
20084 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20085 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20086 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20087 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20088 functions.
20089
20090 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20091 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20092 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20093 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20094
20095 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20096 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20097 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20098 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20099 &_.forward_& files).
20100
20101
20102 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20103 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20104 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20105
20106
20107 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20108 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20109 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20110 of the embedded Perl support.
20111
20112
20113 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20114 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20115 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20116
20117
20118 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20119 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20120 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20121
20122
20123 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20124 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20125 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20126 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20127 &%one_time%& is set.
20128
20129
20130 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20131 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20132 to make use of &%run%& items.
20133
20134
20135 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20136 If this option is true, items of the form
20137 .code
20138 :include:<path name>
20139 .endd
20140 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20141
20142
20143 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20144 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20145 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20146 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20147 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20148
20149
20150 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20151 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20152 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20153
20154
20155 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20156 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20157 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20158 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20159 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20160
20161
20162
20163
20164 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20165 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20166 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20167 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20168 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20169 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20170 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20171
20172
20173 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20174 .cindex "EACCES"
20175 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20176 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20177 file did not exist.
20178
20179
20180 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20181 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20182 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20183 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20184 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20185
20186 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20187 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20188 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20189 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20190 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20191 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20192 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20193 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20194
20195
20196
20197 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20198 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20199 redirection list must start with this directory.
20200
20201
20202 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20203 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20204 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20205
20206
20207 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20208 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20209 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20210 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20211 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20212 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20213 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20214 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20215 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20216 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20217 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20218 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20219 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20220 before they subscribed.
20221
20222 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20223 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20224 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20225 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20226 attempt.
20227
20228 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20229 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20230 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20231 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20232
20233 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20234 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20235 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20236
20237 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20238 &%one_time%&.
20239
20240 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20241 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20242 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20243 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20244 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20245 expansion.
20246
20247
20248 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20249 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20250 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20251 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20252 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20253 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20254 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20255 See &%check_owner%& above.
20256
20257
20258 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20259 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20260 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20261 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20262
20263
20264 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20265 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20266 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20267 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20268 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20269 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20270 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20271
20272
20273 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20274 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20275 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20276 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20277 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20278 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20279 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20280 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20281
20282 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20283 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20284 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20285 addresses.
20286
20287 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20288 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20289 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20290 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20291 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20292 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20293 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20294 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20295 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20296 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20297
20298
20299 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20300 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20301 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20302 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20303 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20304 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20305
20306
20307 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20308 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20309 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20310 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20311 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20312 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20313
20314
20315 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20316 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20317 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20318 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20319 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20320
20321
20322 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20323 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20324 :subaddress part of an address.
20325
20326 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20327 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20328 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20329 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20330
20331
20332 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20333 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20334 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20335 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20336 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20337 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20338 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20339
20340
20341
20342 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20343 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20344 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20345 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20346 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20347 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20348 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20349 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20350 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20351 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20352 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20353 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20354 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20355 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20356 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20357 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20358
20359 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20360 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20361 the following routers.
20362
20363 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20364 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20365 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20366 so it is passed to the following routers.
20367
20368 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20369 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20370 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20371 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20372
20373 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20374 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20375 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20376 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20377 .code
20378 userforward:
20379 driver = redirect
20380 allow_filter
20381 check_local_user
20382 file = $home/.forward
20383 file_transport = address_file
20384 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20385 reply_transport = address_reply
20386 no_verify
20387 skip_syntax_errors
20388 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20389 syntax_errors_text = \
20390 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20391 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20392 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20393 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20394 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20395 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20396 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20397 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20398 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20399 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20400 .endd
20401 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20402 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20403 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20404 .code
20405 real_localuser:
20406 driver = accept
20407 check_local_user
20408 local_part_prefix = real-
20409 transport = local_delivery
20410 .endd
20411 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20412 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20413 .code
20414 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20415 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20416 .endd
20417
20418
20419 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20420 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20421
20422
20423 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20424 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20425 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20426 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20427
20428
20429
20430
20431
20432
20433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20435
20436 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20437 "Environment for local transports"
20438 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20439 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20440 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20441 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20442 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20443 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20444 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20445
20446 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20447 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20448 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20449 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20450
20451 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20452 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20453 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20454 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20455 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20456
20457
20458
20459 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20460 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20461 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20462 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20463 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20464 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20465 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20466 time.
20467
20468 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20469 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20470 .code
20471 my_transport:
20472 driver = pipe
20473 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20474 .endd
20475 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20476 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20477 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20478 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20479
20480
20481
20482
20483 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20484 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20485 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20486 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20487 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20488 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20489 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20490 group (set by the transport). For example:
20491 .code
20492 # Routers ...
20493 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20494 local_users:
20495 driver = accept
20496 check_local_user
20497 transport = group_delivery
20498
20499 # Transports ...
20500 # This transport overrides the group
20501 group_delivery:
20502 driver = appendfile
20503 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20504 group = mail
20505 .endd
20506 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20507 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20508 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20509 set.
20510
20511 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20512 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20513 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20514 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20515 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20516 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20517
20518 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20519 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20520 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20521 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20522 original gid is also used.
20523
20524 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20525 following that is set is used:
20526
20527 .ilist
20528 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20529 .next
20530 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20531 .next
20532 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20533 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20534 .next
20535 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20536 .next
20537 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20538 the uid is the creator's uid;
20539 .next
20540 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20541 .endlist
20542
20543 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20544 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20545 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20546 The first of the following that is set is used:
20547
20548 .ilist
20549 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20550 .next
20551 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20552 .next
20553 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20554 .next
20555 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20556 .next
20557 The Exim uid.
20558 .endlist
20559
20560 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20561 &%never_users%& list.
20562
20563
20564
20565
20566
20567 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20568 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20569 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20570 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20571 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20572 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20573 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20574 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20575 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20576 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20577
20578 .ilist
20579 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20580 .next
20581 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20582 .next
20583 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20584 .next
20585 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20586 .endlist
20587
20588 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20589
20590 .ilist
20591 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20592 .next
20593 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20594 .endlist
20595
20596
20597 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20598 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20599 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20600
20601
20602
20603 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20604 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20605 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20606 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20607 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20608 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20609 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20610 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20611 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20612 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20613 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20614 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20615 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20616 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20617
20618
20619
20620
20621
20622
20623
20624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20626
20627 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20628 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20629 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20630 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20631 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20632
20633
20634 .option body_only transports boolean false
20635 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20636 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20637 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20638 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20639 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20640 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20641 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20642 automatically suppress them.
20643
20644
20645 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20646 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20647 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20648 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20649 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20650 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20651
20652
20653 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20654 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20655 deliveries by the transport or for any
20656 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20657 what you are doing.
20658
20659
20660 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20661 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20662 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20663 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20664 transport is run.
20665 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20666 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20667 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20668 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20669 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20670 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20671 one.
20672 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20673 transport and the router that called it.
20674
20675 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20676 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20677 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20678 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20679 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20680 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20681 safely be resent to other recipients.
20682
20683
20684 .option driver transports string unset
20685 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20686 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20687
20688
20689 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20690 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20691 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20692 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20693 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20694 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20695 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20696 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20697 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20698 resent to other recipients.
20699
20700
20701 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
20702 .cindex events
20703 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
20704 For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
20705 .wen
20706
20707
20708 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20709 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20710 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20711 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20712 &%user%& (see below).
20713
20714
20715 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20716 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20717 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20718 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20719 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20720 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20721 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20722 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20723 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20724 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20725 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20726
20727 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20728 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20729
20730
20731 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20732 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20733 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20734 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20735 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20736 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20737 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20738 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20739
20740
20741 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20742 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20743 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20744 This option specifies a list of header names,
20745 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20746 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20747 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20748 routers.
20749 Each list item is separately expanded.
20750 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20751 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20752 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20753
20754 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20755 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20756
20757 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20758 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20759 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20760
20761
20762
20763 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20764 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20765 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20766 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20767 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20768 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20769 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20770 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20771 example,
20772 .code
20773 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20774 x@y w@z
20775 .endd
20776 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20777 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20778 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20779 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20780 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20781 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20782 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20783 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20784 change envelope recipients at this time.
20785
20786
20787 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20788 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20789 .vindex "&$home$&"
20790 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20791 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20792 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20793 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20794 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20795 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20796 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20797 deferred.
20798
20799
20800 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20801 .cindex "additional groups"
20802 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20803 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20804 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20805 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20806 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20807
20808
20809 .new
20810 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20811 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20812 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20813 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20814 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20815 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20816 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20817 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20818
20819 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20820 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20821 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20822 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20823 Obviously there is scope for
20824 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20825 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20826
20827 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20828 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20829 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20830 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20831 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20832 .wen
20833
20834
20835 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20836 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20837 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20838 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20839 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20840 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20841 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20842 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20843 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20844 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20845 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20846 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20847 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20848 delivered.
20849
20850
20851
20852 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20853 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20854 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20855 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20856 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20857 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20858 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20859 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20860 that contains
20861 .code
20862 local_part_prefix = *-
20863 .endd
20864 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20865 is delivered with
20866 .code
20867 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20868 .endd
20869 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20870 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20871 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20872 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20873 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20874
20875
20876 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20877 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20878 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20879 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20880 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20881 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20882 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20883 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20884 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20885
20886 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20887 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20888 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20889 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20890
20891 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20892 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20893 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20894
20895
20896 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20897 .cindex "envelope sender"
20898 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20899 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20900 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20901 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20902 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20903 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20904 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20905 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20906 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20907
20908 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20909 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20910
20911 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20912 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20913 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20914 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20915 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20916 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20917 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20918
20919 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20920 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20921 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20922 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20923 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20924
20925
20926
20927 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20928 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20929 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20930 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20931 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20932 have easy access to it.
20933
20934 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20935 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20936 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20937 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20938 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20939 recipients.
20940
20941
20942 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20943 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20944
20945
20946 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20947 .cindex "shadow transport"
20948 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20949 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20950 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20951
20952 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20953 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20954 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20955 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20956 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20957 cause a log line to be written.
20958
20959 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20960 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20961 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20962 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20963 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20964 of the form
20965 .code
20966 ST=<shadow transport name>
20967 .endd
20968 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20969 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20970 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20971 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20972 headers that some sites insist on.
20973
20974
20975 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20976 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20977 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20978 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20979 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20980 individual users or via a system filter.
20981 .new
20982 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20983 .wen
20984
20985 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20986 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20987 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20988 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20989 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20990
20991 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20992 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20993 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20994 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20995 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20996 &(pipe)& transports.
20997
20998 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20999 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21000 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21001 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21002 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21003
21004 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21005 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21006 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21007 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21008
21009 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21010 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21011 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21012 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21013 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21014 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21015
21016 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21017 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21018 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21019 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21020 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21021 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21022 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21023 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21024
21025 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21026 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21027 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21028 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21029 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21030 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21031 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21032 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21033 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21034 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21035
21036 .vindex "&$host$&"
21037 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21038 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21039 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21040 which the message is being sent. For example:
21041 .code
21042 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21043 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21044 .endd
21045
21046 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21047 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21048 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21049 .ilist
21050 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21051 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21052 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21053 example:
21054 .code
21055 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21056 .endd
21057 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21058 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21059 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21060 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21061 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21062 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21063 .next
21064 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21065 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21066 arguments. Consider this example:
21067 .code
21068 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21069 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21070 .endd
21071 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21072 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21073 .code
21074 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21075 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21076 .endd
21077 .endlist
21078
21079 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21080 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21081 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21082 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21083 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21084 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21085 bounced from a transport filter.
21086
21087 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21088 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21089 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21090
21091
21092 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21093 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21094 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21095 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21096 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21097 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21098 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21099 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21100 becomes a temporary error.
21101
21102
21103 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21104 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21105 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21106 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21107 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21108 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21109 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21110 option is not set.
21111
21112 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21113 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21114 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21115
21116 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21117 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21118 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21119 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21120 retry data.
21121 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21122 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21123 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21124
21125
21126
21127
21128
21129
21130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21132
21133 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21134 "Address batching"
21135 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21136 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21137 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21138 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21139 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21140 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21141 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21142
21143 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21144 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21145 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21146 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21147 local transport, for example:
21148
21149 .ilist
21150 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21151 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21152 recipients saves space.
21153 .next
21154 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21155 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21156 .next
21157 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21158 to a scanner program or
21159 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21160 acceptable.
21161 .endlist
21162
21163 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21164 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21165 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21166
21167 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21168 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21169 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21170 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21171 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21172 to certain conditions:
21173
21174 .ilist
21175 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21176 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21177 batching is possible.
21178 .next
21179 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21180 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21181 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21182 .next
21183 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21184 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21185 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21186 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21187 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21188 from taking place.
21189 .next
21190 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21191 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21192 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21193 be the same.
21194 .endlist
21195
21196 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21197 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21198 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21199 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21200 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21201 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21202 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21203 .code
21204 check_string = "."
21205 escape_string = ".."
21206 .endd
21207 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21208 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21209 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21210
21211 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21212 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21213 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21214 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21215 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21216 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21217
21218 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21219 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21220 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21221 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21222 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21223 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21224 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21225 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21226 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21227
21228
21229
21230
21231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21232 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21233
21234 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21235 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21236 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21237 .cindex "directory creation"
21238 .cindex "creating directories"
21239 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21240 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21241 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21242 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21243 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21244 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21245 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21246 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21247 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21248 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21249
21250 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21251 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21252 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21253 included.
21254
21255 .cindex "quota" "system"
21256 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21257 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21258 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21259
21260 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21261 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21262 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21263 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21264
21265 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21266 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21267 private options.
21268
21269 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21270 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21271 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21272 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21273 option).
21274
21275
21276
21277 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21278 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21279 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21280 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21281 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21282
21283 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21284 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21285 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21286 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21287 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21288 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21289 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21290 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21291 operation. There are two cases:
21292
21293 .ilist
21294 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21295 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21296 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21297 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21298 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21299 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21300 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21301 .next
21302 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21303 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21304 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21305 .endlist
21306
21307
21308 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21309 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21310 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21311 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21312 form:
21313 .code
21314 save folder23
21315 .endd
21316 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21317 .code
21318 require "fileinto";
21319 fileinto "folder23";
21320 .endd
21321 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21322 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21323 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21324 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21325 way of handling this requirement:
21326 .code
21327 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21328 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21329 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21330 {$address_file} \
21331 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21332 }} \
21333 }
21334 .endd
21335 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21336 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21337 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21338
21339 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21340 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21341 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21342 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21343 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21344 path to the transport.
21345
21346 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21347 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21348
21349
21350
21351
21352 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21353 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21354
21355
21356
21357 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21358 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21359 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21360 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21361 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21362 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21363 delivery is deferred.
21364
21365
21366 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21367 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21368 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21369 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21370 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21371 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21372 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21373 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21374
21375
21376 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21377 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21378 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21379 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21380 file.
21381
21382
21383 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21384 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21385
21386
21387 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21388 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21389 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21390 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21391 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21392
21393
21394 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21395 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21396 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21397 process is running.
21398
21399
21400 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21401 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21402 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21403 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21404 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21405 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21406 contains is significant.
21407
21408 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21409 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21410 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21411 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21412 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21413
21414 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21415 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21416 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21417 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21418 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21419 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21420 .code
21421 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21422 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21423 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21424 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21425 .endd
21426 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21427 .cindex "directory creation"
21428 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21429 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21430 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21431
21432 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21433 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21434 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21435 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21436 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21437
21438
21439
21440 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21441 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21442 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21443 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21444 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21445 beneath.
21446
21447 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21448 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21449 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21450 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21451 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21452 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21453 &%file_must_exist%&.
21454
21455
21456 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21457 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21458 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21459 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21460
21461 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21462 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21463 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21464 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21465 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21466
21467
21468 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21469 .cindex "base62"
21470 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21471 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21472 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21473 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21474 .code
21475 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21476 .endd
21477 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21478 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21479 option.
21480
21481
21482 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21483 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21484 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21485
21486
21487 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21488 See &%check_string%& above.
21489
21490
21491 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21492 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21493 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21494 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21495 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21496 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21497 &%file%&.
21498
21499 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21500 .cindex "locking files"
21501 .cindex "lock files"
21502 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21503 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21504
21505 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21506 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21507 examples:
21508 .code
21509 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21510 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21511 file = $home/inbox
21512 .endd
21513 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21514 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21515 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21516 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21517 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21518 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21519
21520
21521
21522 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21523 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21524 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21525 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21526 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21527 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21528 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21529 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21530 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21531 this added to it:
21532 .code
21533 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21534 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21535 .endd
21536 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21537 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21538 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21539 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21540 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21541 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21542 delivery is deferred.
21543
21544
21545 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21546 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21547 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21548 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21549
21550
21551 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21552 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21553 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21554 .cindex "locking files"
21555 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21556 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21557 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21558 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21559 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21560 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21561 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21562 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21563
21564 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21565 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21566 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21567 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21568
21569 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21570 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21571 retries is
21572 .code
21573 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21574 .endd
21575 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21576 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21577 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21578
21579 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21580 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21581 .code
21582 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21583 .endd
21584
21585 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21586 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21587 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21588 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21589
21590
21591 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21592 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21593 for details of locking.
21594
21595
21596 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21597 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21598 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21599
21600
21601 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21602 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21603 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21604
21605
21606 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21607 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21608 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21609 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21610 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21611
21612
21613 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21614 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21615 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21616 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21617 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21618 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21619 external source that maintains the data.
21620
21621
21622 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21623 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21624 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21625 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21626 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21627 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21628 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21629 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21630
21631
21632
21633 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21634 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21635 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21636 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21637 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21638 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21639 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21640 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21641 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21642 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21643
21644
21645 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21646 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21647 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21648 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21649 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21650 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21651 calculation. The default value is:
21652 .code
21653 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21654 .endd
21655 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21656 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21657 &_Trash_&
21658 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21659 .code
21660 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21661 .endd
21662 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21663 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21664 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21665 directly into that directory.
21666
21667
21668 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21669 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21670 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21671
21672
21673 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21674 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21675 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21676
21677
21678 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21679 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21680 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21681 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21682 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21683 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21684 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21685 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21686
21687 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21688 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21689 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21690 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21691 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21692 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21693 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21694 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21695 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21696 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21697
21698
21699 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21700 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21701 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21702 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21703 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21704 below for further details.
21705
21706
21707 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21708 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21709 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21710
21711
21712 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21713 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21714 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21715
21716
21717 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21718 .cindex "locking files"
21719 .cindex "file" "locking"
21720 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21721 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21722 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21723 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21724 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21725 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21726 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21727
21728 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21729 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21730 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21731 combination:
21732 .code
21733 mbx_format = true
21734 message_prefix =
21735 message_suffix =
21736 .endd
21737 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21738 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21739 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21740 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21741 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21742 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21743 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21744 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21745
21746 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21747 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21748 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21749 append messages to it.
21750
21751
21752 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21753 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21754 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21755 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21756 in which case it is:
21757 .code
21758 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21759 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21760 .endd
21761 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21762 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21763
21764 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21765 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21766 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21767 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21768 setting
21769 .code
21770 message_suffix =
21771 .endd
21772 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21773 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21774
21775 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21776 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21777 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21778 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21779 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21780 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21781 value, and this option is ignored.
21782
21783
21784 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21785 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21786 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21787 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21788 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21789
21790
21791 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21792 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21793 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21794 on users about incoming mail.
21795
21796
21797 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21798 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21799 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21800 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21801 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21802 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21803 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21804 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21805 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21806
21807 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21808 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21809 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21810
21811 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21812 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21813 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21814 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21815 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21816 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21817
21818 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21819 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21820 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21821 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21822 be handled.
21823
21824 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21825
21826 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21827 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21828 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21829 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21830 system quota failures.
21831
21832 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21833 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21834 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21835 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21836 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21837 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21838 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21839 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21840 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21841 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21842
21843
21844 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21845 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21846 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21847 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21848 delivery directory.
21849
21850
21851 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21852 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21853 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21854 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21855 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21856 &"no quota"&.
21857
21858
21859 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21860 See &%quota%& above.
21861
21862
21863 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21864 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21865 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21866 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21867 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21868 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21869 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21870
21871 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21872 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21873 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21874 the file length to the file name. For example:
21875 .code
21876 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21877 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21878 .endd
21879 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21880 number of lines in the message.
21881
21882 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21883 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21884 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21885
21886 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21887
21888
21889 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21890 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21891 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21892 .code
21893 quota_warn_message = "\
21894 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21895 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21896 This message is automatically created \
21897 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21898 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21899 a warning threshold that is\n\
21900 set by the system administrator.\n"
21901 .endd
21902
21903
21904 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21905 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21906 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21907 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21908 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21909 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21910 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21911 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21912 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21913 sign. For example:
21914 .code
21915 quota = 10M
21916 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21917 .endd
21918 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21919 percent sign is ignored.
21920
21921 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21922 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21923 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21924 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21925 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21926 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21927 .code
21928 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21929 .endd
21930 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21931 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21932 option.
21933
21934 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21935 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21936 percentage.
21937
21938
21939 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21940 .cindex "envelope sender"
21941 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21942 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21943 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21944 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21945 for details of batch SMTP.
21946
21947
21948 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21949 .cindex "carriage return"
21950 .cindex "linefeed"
21951 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21952 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21953 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21954 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21955
21956 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21957 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21958 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21959 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21960 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21961 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21962
21963
21964 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21965 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21966 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21967 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21968 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21969 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21970
21971
21972 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21973 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21974 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21975 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21976 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21977
21978 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21979 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21980 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21981 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21982
21983 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21984 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21985 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21986 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21987 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21988 error.
21989
21990 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21991 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21992
21993
21994 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21995 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21996 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21997 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21998 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21999 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22000 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22001
22002 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22003 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22004 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22005 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22006 file corruption.
22007
22008 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22009 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22010 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22011
22012
22013 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22014 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22015 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22016 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22017 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22018 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22019 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22020 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22021 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22022
22023 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22024 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22025 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22026 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22027
22028
22029
22030
22031 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22032 .cindex "appending to a file"
22033 .cindex "file" "appending"
22034 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22035
22036 .ilist
22037 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22038 return is given.
22039
22040 .next
22041 .cindex "directory creation"
22042 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22043 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22044 &%directory_mode%& option.
22045
22046 .next
22047 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22048 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22049 transport.
22050
22051 .next
22052 .cindex "file" "locking"
22053 .cindex "locking files"
22054 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22055 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22056 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22057
22058 .olist
22059 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22060 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22061 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22062 .next
22063 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22064 .next
22065 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22066 Unlink the hitching post name.
22067 .next
22068 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22069 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22070 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22071 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22072 .next
22073 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22074 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22075 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22076 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22077 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22078 it before trying again.
22079 .endlist olist
22080
22081 .next
22082 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22083 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22084 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22085
22086 .next
22087 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22088 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22089 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22090 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22091 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22092 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22093 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22094 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22095 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22096 checked.
22097
22098 .next
22099 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22100 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22101 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22102 delivery is deferred.
22103
22104 .next
22105 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22106 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22107 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22108 permissions.
22109
22110 .next
22111 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22112 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22113 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22114
22115 .next
22116 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22117 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22118 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22119
22120 .next
22121 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22122 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22123 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22124 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22125 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22126 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22127 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22128 that prevents link following.
22129
22130 .next
22131 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22132 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22133 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22134 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22135 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22136
22137 .next
22138 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22139
22140 .next
22141 .cindex "file" "locking"
22142 .cindex "locking files"
22143 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22144 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22145 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22146 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22147 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22148 .code
22149 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22150 .endd
22151 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22152 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22153 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22154
22155 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22156 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22157 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22158
22159 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22160 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22161 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22162 delivery is deferred.
22163
22164 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22165 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22166 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22167 immediately. It retries up to
22168 .code
22169 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22170 .endd
22171 times (rounded up).
22172 .endlist
22173
22174 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22175 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22176
22177
22178 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22179 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22180 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22181 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22182 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22183 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22184 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22185 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22186 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22187 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22188
22189 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22190 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22191 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22192 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22193 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22194 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22195 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22196
22197 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22198 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22199 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22200 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22201
22202
22203 .cindex "maildir format"
22204 .cindex "mailstore format"
22205 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22206 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22207 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22208 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22209 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22210
22211 .cindex "directory creation"
22212 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22213 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22214 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22215 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22216 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22217 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22218 deferred.
22219
22220
22221
22222 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22223 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22224 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22225 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22226 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22227 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22228 &_new_& subdirectory.
22229
22230 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22231 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22232 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22233 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22234 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22235 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22236 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22237
22238 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22239 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22240 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22241 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22242 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22243 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22244 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22245 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22246
22247 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22248 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22249 folders. Consider this example:
22250 .code
22251 maildir_format = true
22252 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22253 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22254 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22255 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22256 .endd
22257 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22258 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22259 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22260 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22261 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22262 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22263
22264 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22265 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22266 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22267 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22268 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22269
22270 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22271 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22272 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22273
22274 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22275 .cindex "maildir++"
22276 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22277 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22278 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22279 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22280 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22281 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22282 amount of space used.
22283
22284 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22285 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22286 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22287 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22288 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22289 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22290
22291
22292
22293
22294 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22295 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22296 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22297 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22298 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22299 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22300
22301
22302 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22303 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22304 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22305 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22306 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22307 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22308 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22309 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22310 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22311 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22312 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22313 backwards compatibility).
22314
22315 For one common implementation, you might set:
22316 .code
22317 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22318 .endd
22319 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22320
22321 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22322 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22323 &[stat()]& each message file.
22324
22325
22326 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22327 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22328 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22329 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22330 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22331 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22332 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22333 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22334 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22335
22336 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22337 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22338 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22339 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22340 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22341 need to know the quota.
22342
22343 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22344 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22345
22346 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22347 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22348 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22349 details.
22350
22351
22352 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22353 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22354 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22355 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22356 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22357 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22358 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22359 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22360
22361 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22362 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22363 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22364 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22365 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22366 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22367
22368 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22369 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22370 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22371 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22372 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22373 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22374
22375 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22376 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22377 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22378 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22379
22380
22381 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22382 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22383 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22384 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22385 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22386 .code
22387 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22388 .endd
22389 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22390 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22391 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22392 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22393 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22394
22395
22396
22397
22398
22399
22400 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22402
22403 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22404 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22405 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22406 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22407 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22408 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22409 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22410 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22411
22412 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22413 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22414 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22415 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22416 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22417
22418
22419 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22420 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22421 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22422 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22423 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22424
22425 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22426 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22427 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22428 transport is run as a consequence of a
22429 &%mail%&
22430 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22431 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22432 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22433 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22434 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22435 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22436
22437 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22438 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22439 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22440 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22441
22442 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22443 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22444 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22445 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22446 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22447 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22448 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22449
22450 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22451 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22452 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22453 the transport defers.
22454 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22455 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22456
22457 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22458 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22459 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22460 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22461
22462 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22463 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22464 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22465 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22466 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22467 problems. They are just discarded.
22468
22469
22470
22471 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22472 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22473
22474 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22475 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22476 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22477
22478
22479 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22480 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22481 when the message is specified by the transport.
22482
22483
22484 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22485 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22486 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22487 string comes first.
22488
22489
22490 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22491 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22492 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22493
22494
22495 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22496 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22497 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22498
22499
22500 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22501 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22502 specified by the transport.
22503
22504
22505 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22506 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22507 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22508 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22509
22510
22511 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22512 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22513 the message is specified by the transport.
22514
22515
22516 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22517 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22518 used.
22519
22520
22521 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22522 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22523 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22524 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22525 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22526
22527
22528
22529 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22530 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22531 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22532 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22533
22534 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22535 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22536 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22537 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22538 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22539 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22540 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22541 infinity.
22542
22543 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22544 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22545 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22546 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22547 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22548
22549 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22550 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22551 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22552 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22553 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22554 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22555
22556
22557 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22558 See &%once%& above.
22559
22560
22561 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22562 See &%once%& above.
22563 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22564
22565
22566 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22567 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22568 specified by the transport.
22569
22570
22571 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22572 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22573 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22574 configuration option.
22575
22576
22577 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22578 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22579 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22580 automatic responses. For example:
22581 .code
22582 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22583 .endd
22584 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22585 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22586 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22587 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22588 small.
22589
22590
22591
22592 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22593 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22594 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22595 the text comes first.
22596
22597
22598 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22599 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22600 when the message is specified by the transport.
22601 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22602 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22603
22604
22605
22606
22607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22609
22610 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22611 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22612 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22613 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22614 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22615 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22616 specified command
22617 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22618 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22619 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22620 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22621 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22622 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22623 .code
22624 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22625 .endd
22626 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22627 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22628 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22629 as follows:
22630
22631 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22632 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22633
22634
22635 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22636 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22637 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22638 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22639 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22640
22641
22642 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22643 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22644 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22645 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22646 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22647 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22648 LMTP protocol.
22649
22650 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22651 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22652 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22653 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22654 in its response to the LHLO command.
22655
22656 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22657 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22658 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22659 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22660
22661
22662 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22663 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22664 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22665 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22666 LMTP transport:
22667 .code
22668 lmtp:
22669 driver = lmtp
22670 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22671 batch_max = 20
22672 user = exim
22673 .endd
22674 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22675 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22676
22677
22678
22679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22681
22682 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22683 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22684 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22685 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22686 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22687 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22688 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22689 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22690 following ways:
22691
22692 .ilist
22693 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22694 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22695 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22696 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22697 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22698 .next
22699 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22700 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22701 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22702 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22703 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22704 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22705 that are routed to the transport.
22706 .next
22707 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22708 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22709 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22710 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22711 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22712 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22713 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22714 .endlist
22715
22716
22717 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22718 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22719 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22720
22721 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22722 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22723 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22724 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22725 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22726 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22727 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22728
22729
22730 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22731 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22732 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22733 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22734 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22735 .new
22736 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22737 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22738 .wen
22739
22740
22741
22742
22743 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22744 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22745 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22746 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22747 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22748 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22749 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22750 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22751 &"local delivery failed"&.
22752
22753 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22754 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22755 will be sent as normal.
22756
22757 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22758 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22759 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22760 apply in this case.
22761
22762 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22763 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22764 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22765 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22766
22767 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22768 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22769 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22770 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22771 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22772 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22773 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22774 &%temp_errors%&.
22775
22776
22777
22778 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22779 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22780 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22781 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22782 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22783 run.
22784
22785 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22786 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22787 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22788 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22789
22790 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22791 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22792 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22793 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22794 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22795 .code
22796 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22797 .endd
22798 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22799 arguments. You have to write
22800 .code
22801 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22802 .endd
22803 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22804 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22805 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22806 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22807 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22808 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22809 example:
22810 .code
22811 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22812 .endd
22813
22814 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22815 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22816 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22817 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22818 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22819 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22820 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22821 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22822 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22823 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22824
22825 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22826 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22827 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22828 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22829 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22830 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22831 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22832 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22833
22834 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22835 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22836 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22837 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22838 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22839 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22840 control what is done with it.
22841
22842 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22843 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22844 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22845 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22846 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22847 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22848 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22849 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22850 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22851 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22852 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22853
22854
22855
22856 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22857 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22858 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22859 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22860 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22861 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22862 environment.
22863 .display
22864 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22865 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22866 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22867 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22868 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22869 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22870 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22871 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22872 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22873 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22874 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22875 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22876 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22877 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22878 &`USER `& see below
22879 .endd
22880 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22881 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22882 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22883 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22884 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22885 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22886 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22887
22888 .cindex "HOST"
22889 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22890 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22891 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22892 the router.
22893
22894 .cindex "HOME"
22895 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22896 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22897 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22898 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22899
22900
22901 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22902 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22903
22904
22905
22906 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22907 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22908 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22909 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22910 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22911 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22912 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22913 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22914 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22915 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22916 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22917 example, if
22918 .code
22919 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22920 .endd
22921 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22922 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22923 &%use_shell%& is set.
22924
22925
22926 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22927 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22928
22929
22930 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22931 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22932 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22933
22934
22935 .option check_string pipe string unset
22936 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22937 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22938 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22939 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22940 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22941 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22942 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22943 ignored.
22944
22945
22946 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22947 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22948 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22949 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22950 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22951 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22952 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22953
22954
22955 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22956 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22957 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22958 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22959 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22960 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22961 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22962
22963
22964 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22965 See &%check_string%& above.
22966
22967
22968 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22969 .cindex "exec failure"
22970 .cindex "failure of exec"
22971 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22972 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22973 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22974 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22975 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22976
22977
22978 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22979 .cindex "signal exit"
22980 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22981 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22982 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22983 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22984
22985
22986 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22987 .cindex "force command"
22988 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22989 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22990 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22991 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22992 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22993 command. For example:
22994 .code
22995 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22996 force_command
22997 .endd
22998
22999 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23000 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23001 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23002
23003
23004 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23005 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23006 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23007 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23008 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23009 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23010
23011 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23012 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23013
23014
23015 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23016 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23017 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23018 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23019 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23020 written to the main log.
23021
23022
23023 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23024 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23025 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23026 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23027 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23028 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23029 be set.
23030
23031
23032 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23033 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23034 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23035 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23036 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23037
23038
23039 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23040 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23041 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23042 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23043 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23044 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23045 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23046 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23047
23048
23049 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23050 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23051 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23052 .code
23053 message_prefix = \
23054 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23055 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23056 .endd
23057 .cindex "Cyrus"
23058 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23059 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23060 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23061 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23062 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23063 setting
23064 .code
23065 message_prefix =
23066 .endd
23067 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23068 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23069
23070
23071 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23072 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23073 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23074 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23075 .code
23076 message_suffix =
23077 .endd
23078 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23079 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23080
23081
23082 .option path pipe string "see below"
23083 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23084 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
23085 .code
23086 /bin:/usr/bin
23087 .endd
23088 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23089 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23090 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23091
23092
23093 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23094 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23095 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23096 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23097 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23098 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23099 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23100 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23101 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23102
23103
23104 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23105 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23106 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23107 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23108 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23109 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23110 accept the message is used.
23111
23112
23113 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23114 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23115 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23116 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23117 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23118 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23119
23120
23121 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23122 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23123 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23124 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23125 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23126 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23127 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23128
23129
23130
23131 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23132 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23133 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23134 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23135 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23136 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23137 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23138 of them may be set.
23139
23140
23141
23142 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23143 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23144 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23145 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23146 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23147 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23148 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23149 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23150 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23151 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23152 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23153 and 73, respectively.
23154
23155
23156 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23157 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23158 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23159 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23160 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23161 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23162 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23163
23164 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23165 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23166 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23167 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23168 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23169 delivery to be deferred.
23170
23171 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23172 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23173
23174
23175 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23176 .cindex "envelope sender"
23177 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23178 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23179 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23180 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23181 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23182
23183 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23184 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23185 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23186 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23187 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23188 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23189 class database.
23190
23191
23192 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23193 .cindex "carriage return"
23194 .cindex "linefeed"
23195 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23196 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23197 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23198 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23199
23200 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23201 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23202 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23203 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23204 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23205
23206
23207 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23208 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23209 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23210 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23211 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23212 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23213 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23214 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23215 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23216 its &%-c%& option.
23217
23218
23219
23220 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23221 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23222 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23223 .cindex "external local delivery"
23224 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23225 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23226 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23227 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23228 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23229 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23230 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23231 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23232 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23233 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23234 .code
23235 # transport
23236 procmail_pipe:
23237 driver = pipe
23238 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23239 return_path_add
23240 delivery_date_add
23241 envelope_to_add
23242 check_string = "From "
23243 escape_string = ">From "
23244 umask = 077
23245 user = $local_part
23246 group = mail
23247
23248 # router
23249 procmail:
23250 driver = accept
23251 check_local_user
23252 transport = procmail_pipe
23253 .endd
23254 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23255 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23256 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23257 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23258 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23259 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23260
23261 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23262 .code
23263 IFS=" "
23264 .endd
23265 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23266 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23267
23268 .cindex "Cyrus"
23269 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23270 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23271 .code
23272 # transport
23273 local_delivery_cyrus:
23274 driver = pipe
23275 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23276 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23277 user = cyrus
23278 group = mail
23279 return_output
23280 log_output
23281 message_prefix =
23282 message_suffix =
23283
23284 # router
23285 local_user_cyrus:
23286 driver = accept
23287 check_local_user
23288 local_part_suffix = .*
23289 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23290 .endd
23291 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23292 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23293 sender.
23294 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23295 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23296
23297
23298 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23299 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23300
23301 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23302 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23303 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23304 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23305 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23306 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23307 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23308 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23309
23310
23311 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23312 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23313 two ways:
23314
23315 .ilist
23316 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23317 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23318 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23319 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23320 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23321 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23322 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23323 .next
23324 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23325 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23326 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23327 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23328 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23329 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23330 process.
23331 .endlist
23332
23333
23334 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23335 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23336 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23337
23338
23339
23340 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23341 .vindex "&$host$&"
23342 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23343 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23344 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23345 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23346 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23347 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23348 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23349 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23350
23351
23352 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23353 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23354 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23355 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23356 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23357 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23358 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23359 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23360 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23361 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23362 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23363 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23364 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23365 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23366
23367 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23368 and will be removed in a future release.
23369
23370
23371 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23372 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23373 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23374
23375
23376 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23377 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23378 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23379 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23380 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23381 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23382 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23383 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23384
23385 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23386 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23387 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23388 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23389 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23390 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23391 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23392 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23393 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23394
23395
23396 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23397 .cindex "Cyrus"
23398 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23399 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23400 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23401 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23402 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23403 ignored.
23404
23405 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23406 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23407 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23408 particular connection.
23409
23410 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23411 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23412 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23413 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23414
23415 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23416 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23417 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23418 .code
23419 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23420 .endd
23421 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23422 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23423
23424 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23425 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23426 value.
23427
23428
23429 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23430 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23431 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23432 authenticated as a client.
23433
23434
23435 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23436 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23437 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23438 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23439
23440
23441 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23442 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23443 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23444 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23445 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23446 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23447 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23448
23449
23450 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23451 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23452 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23453 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23454 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23455 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23456 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23457 option.
23458
23459
23460 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23461 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23462 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23463 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23464
23465
23466 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
23467 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23468 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23469 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23470 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23471 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
23472 DKIM signing options. For details see &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23473
23474
23475 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23476 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23477 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23478 cutoff times.
23479
23480 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23481 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23482 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23483 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23484 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23485 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23486
23487 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23488 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23489 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23490 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23491 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23492 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23493 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23494 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23495 to them.
23496
23497
23498 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23499 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23500 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23501 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23502 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23503
23504
23505 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23506 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23507 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23508 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23509 details.
23510
23511
23512 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23513 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23514 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23515 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23516 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23517 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23518 the dnssec request bit set.
23519 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23520
23521
23522
23523 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23524 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23525 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23526 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23527 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23528 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23529 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23530 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23531 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23532
23533
23534
23535 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23536 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23537 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23538 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23539 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23540 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23541 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23542
23543 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23544 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23545 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23546 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23547 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23548
23549
23550 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23551 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23552 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23553 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23554 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23555 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23556 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23557 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23558
23559 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23560 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23561 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23562 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23563 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23564 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23565
23566 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23567 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23568 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23569 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23570 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23571
23572 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23573 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23574 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23575 copy of the message is sent.
23576
23577 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23578 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23579 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23580 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23581 fails"& facility.
23582
23583
23584 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23585 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23586 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23587 zero.
23588
23589 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23590 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23591 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23592 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23593 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23594 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23595
23596 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23597 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23598 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23599 implementations of TLS.
23600
23601 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23602 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23603 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23604 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23605 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23606 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23607 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23608 option is:
23609 .code
23610 $primary_hostname
23611 .endd
23612 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23613 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23614 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23615 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23616 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23617 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23618 interface address, you could use this:
23619 .code
23620 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23621 {$primary_hostname}}
23622 .endd
23623 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23624 callouts.
23625
23626 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23627 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23628 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23629 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23630 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23631 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23632
23633 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23634 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23635 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23636 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23637
23638 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23639 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23640 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23641 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23642 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23643 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23644 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23645
23646 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23647 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23648 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23649 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23650 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23651 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23652 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23653 address are used.
23654
23655 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23656 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23657
23658
23659 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23660 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23661 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23662 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23663 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23664 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23665 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23666 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23667 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23668 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23669
23670
23671 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23672 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23673 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23674 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23675
23676
23677 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23678 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23679 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23680 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23681
23682 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23683 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23684 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23685 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23686 to any host that matches this list.
23687
23688
23689 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23690 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23691 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23692 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23693 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23694 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23695 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23696 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23697
23698
23699 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23700 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23701 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23702 why it exists.
23703
23704
23705
23706 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23707 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23708 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23709 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23710 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23711 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23712 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23713 explanation of when this might be needed.
23714
23715
23716 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23717 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23718 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23719 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23720 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23721
23722
23723 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23724 .cindex "randomized host list"
23725 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23726 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23727 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23728 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23729 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23730 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23731 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23732 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23733
23734 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23735 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23736 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23737 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23738 .code
23739 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23740 .endd
23741 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23742 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23743 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23744
23745 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23746 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23747 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23748 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23749 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23750 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23751 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23752 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23753 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23754
23755
23756 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23757 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23758 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23759 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23760 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23761
23762 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23763 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23764 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23765 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23766 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23767
23768 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23769 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23770 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23771 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23772 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23773 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23774
23775 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23776 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23777 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23778 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23779 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23780 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23781 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23782
23783 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23784 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23785 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23786 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23787 for multi-recipient messages.
23788 The option can usually be left as default.
23789
23790 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23791 .cindex "bind IP address"
23792 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23793 .vindex "&$host$&"
23794 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23795 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23796 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23797 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23798 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23799 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23800 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23801 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23802 unknown.
23803
23804 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23805 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23806 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23807 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23808 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23809 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23810 .code
23811 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23812 .endd
23813 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23814 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23815 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23816 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23817
23818
23819 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23820 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23821 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23822 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23823 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23824 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23825 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23826 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23827 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23828 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23829 unreachable hosts.
23830
23831
23832 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23833 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23834 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23835 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23836 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23837
23838 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23839 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23840 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23841 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23842 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23843 permits this.
23844
23845
23846 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23847 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23848 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23849 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23850 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23851 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23852 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23853 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23854
23855 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23856 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23857 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23858
23859 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23860 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23861 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23862 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23863 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23864 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23865 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23866 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23867
23868 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23869 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23870 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23871 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23872 is deferred.
23873
23874
23875
23876 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23877 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23878 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23879 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23880 .vindex "&$port$&"
23881 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23882 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23883 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23884 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23885 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23886
23887 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23888 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23889 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23890 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23891
23892
23893 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23894 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23895 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23896 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23897 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23898 addresses is not affected.
23899
23900 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23901 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23902 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23903 Exim to use only the host name.
23904 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23905
23906
23907 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23908 .cindex "serializing connections"
23909 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23910 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23911 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23912 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23913 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23914 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23915 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23916
23917 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23918 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23919 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23920 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23921 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23922 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23923
23924 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23925 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23926 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23927 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23928 are used for ETRN serialization.
23929
23930 .new
23931 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23932 .wen
23933
23934
23935 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23936 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23937 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23938 .cindex "size" "of message"
23939 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23940 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23941 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23942 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23943 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23944 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23945 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23946 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23947
23948 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23949 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23950
23951
23952 .new
23953 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
23954 .cindex proxy SOCKS
23955 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
23956 transport. For details see &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
23957 .wen
23958
23959
23960 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23961 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23962 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23963 .vindex "&$host$&"
23964 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23965 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23966 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23967 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23968 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23969 details of TLS.
23970
23971 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23972 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23973 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23974 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23975 client.
23976
23977
23978 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23979 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23980 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23981 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23982 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23983
23984
23985 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23986 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23987 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23988 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23989 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23990 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23991 will fail.
23992
23993 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23994
23995
23996 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23997 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23998 .vindex "&$host$&"
23999 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24000 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24001 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24002 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24003 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24004 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24005 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24006 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24007
24008
24009 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24010 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24011 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24012 .vindex "&$host$&"
24013 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24014 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24015 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24016 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24017 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24018 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24019 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24020 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24021 ciphers is a preference order.
24022
24023
24024
24025 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24026 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24027 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24028 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24029 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24030 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24031 certificate and private key for the session.
24032
24033 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24034
24035 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24036 TLS extensions.
24037
24038
24039
24040
24041 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24042 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24043 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24044 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24045 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24046 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24047 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24048 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24049 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24050 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24051 in clear.
24052
24053
24054 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24055 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24056 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24057 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24058 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24059 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24060 Note that unless the host is in this list
24061 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24062 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24063 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24064 certificate verification succeeds.
24065
24066
24067 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24068 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24069 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24070 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24071 while verifying the server certificate,
24072 checks will be included on the host name
24073 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24074 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24075 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24076
24077 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24078
24079
24080 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24081 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24082 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24083 .vindex "&$host$&"
24084 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24085 The value of this option must be either the
24086 word "system"
24087 or the absolute path to
24088 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24089 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24090
24091 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24092 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24093 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24094 must be specified.
24095
24096 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24097 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24098
24099 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24100 explicitly
24101 either by file or directory
24102 are added to those given by the system default location.
24103
24104 The values of &$host$& and
24105 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24106 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24107
24108 For back-compatibility,
24109 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24110 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24111 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24112
24113
24114 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24115 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24116 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24117 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24118 certificate verification must succeed.
24119 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24120 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24121 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24122
24123
24124
24125
24126 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24127 "SECTvalhosmax"
24128 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24129 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24130 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24131 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24132 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24133
24134
24135 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24136 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24137 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24138 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24139 retrying.
24140
24141 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24142 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24143 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24144
24145 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24146 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24147 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24148 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24149 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24150
24151 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24152 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24153 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24154 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24155 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24156 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24157 see below for an exception).
24158
24159 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24160 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24161 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24162 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24163 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24164
24165 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24166 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24167 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24168 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24169 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24170 reached their retry times.
24171
24172 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24173 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24174 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24175 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24176 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24177 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24178 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24179 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24180 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24181 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24182 reached.
24183
24184 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24185 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24186 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24187 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24188 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24189 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24190
24191 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24192 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24193 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24194 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24195 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24196 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24197
24198
24199
24200
24201
24202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24203 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24204
24205 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24206 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24207 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24208 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24209 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24210 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24211
24212 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24213 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24214 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24215 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24216 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24217 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24218 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24219
24220 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24221 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24222 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24223 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24224
24225
24226 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24227 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24228 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24229 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24230
24231 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24232 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24233 facility; you do not have to use it.
24234
24235 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24236 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24237 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24238 address to which it applies.
24239
24240 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24241 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24242 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24243 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24244 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24245 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24246 rules.
24247
24248 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24249 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24250 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24251 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24252
24253
24254 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24255 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24256 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24257 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24258 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24259 discouraged.
24260
24261 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24262 illustrated by these examples:
24263
24264 .ilist
24265 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24266 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24267 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24268 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24269 .next
24270 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24271 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24272 .endlist
24273
24274
24275
24276 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24277 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24278 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24279 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24280 message's processing.
24281
24282 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24283 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24284 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24285 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24286 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24287 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24288 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24289 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24290 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24291
24292 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24293 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24294 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24295 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24296 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24297 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24298 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24299 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24300 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24301 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24302
24303 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24304 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24305 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24306 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24307 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24308 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24309
24310 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24311 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24312 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24313
24314 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24315 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24316 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24317 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24318 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24319 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24320 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24321 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24322 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24323
24324 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24325 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24326 transport time.
24327
24328
24329
24330
24331 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24332 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24333 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24334 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24335 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24336 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24337 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24338 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24339 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24340 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24341 .code
24342 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24343 .endd
24344 might produce the output
24345 .code
24346 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24347 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24348 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24349 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24350 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24351 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24352 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24353 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24354 .endd
24355 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24356 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24357 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24358 set for a particular transport.
24359
24360
24361 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24362 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24363 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24364 rules in the form
24365 .display
24366 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24367 .endd
24368 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24369 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24370 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24371 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24372
24373 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24374 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24375 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24376 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24377 ignored.
24378
24379 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24380 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24381 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24382
24383 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24384 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24385 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24386 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24387 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24388 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24389 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24390
24391 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24392 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24393 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24394 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24395 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24396 .code
24397 *@* ${lookup ...
24398 .endd
24399 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24400 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24401
24402
24403 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24404 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24405 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24406 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24407 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24408 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24409 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24410 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24411 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24412
24413 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24414 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24415 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24416
24417 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24418 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24419 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24420 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24421 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24422 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24423 of pattern they are set as follows:
24424
24425 .ilist
24426 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24427 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24428 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24429 pattern
24430 .code
24431 *queen@*.fict.example
24432 .endd
24433 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24434 .code
24435 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24436 $1 = hearts-
24437 $2 = wonderland
24438 .endd
24439 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24440 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24441
24442 .next
24443 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24444 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24445 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24446 rewriting rule of the form
24447 .display
24448 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24449 .endd
24450 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24451 .code
24452 $1 = foo
24453 $2 = bar
24454 $3 = baz.example
24455 .endd
24456 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24457 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24458 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24459 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24460 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24461 .endlist
24462
24463
24464 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24465 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24466 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24467 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24468 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24469 .code
24470 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24471 .endd
24472 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24473 &'From:'& headers.
24474
24475 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24476 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24477 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24478 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24479 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24480 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24481 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24482 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24483 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24484 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24485 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24486 entry written to the panic log.
24487
24488
24489
24490 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24491 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24492
24493 .ilist
24494 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24495 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24496 .next
24497 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24498 .next
24499 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24500 .endlist
24501
24502 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24503 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24504
24505
24506
24507 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24508 "SECID154"
24509 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24510 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24511 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24512 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24513 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24514 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24515 .display
24516 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24517 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24518 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24519 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24520 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24521 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24522 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24523 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24524 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24525 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24526 .endd
24527 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24528 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24529 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24530
24531 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24532 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24533
24534
24535 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24536 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24537 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24538 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24539 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24540 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24541 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24542 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24543 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24544
24545 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24546 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24547 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24548 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24549 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24550 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24551 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24552 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24553
24554
24555 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24556 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24557 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24558 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24559
24560 .ilist
24561 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24562 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24563 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24564 .next
24565 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24566 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24567 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24568 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24569 .next
24570 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24571 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24572 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24573 .next
24574 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24575 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24576 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24577 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24578 .code
24579 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24580 .endd
24581 into
24582 .code
24583 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24584 .endd
24585 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24586 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24587 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24588 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24589 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24590 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24591 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24592 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24593 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24594
24595 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24596 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24597 .endlist
24598
24599
24600 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24601 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24602 .code
24603 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24604 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24605 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24606 .endd
24607 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24608 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24609 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24610 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24611 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24612 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24613 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24614 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24615
24616 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24617 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24618 .code
24619 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24620 .endd
24621 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24622 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24623
24624 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24625 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24626 messages that originate outside the local host:
24627 .code
24628 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24629 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24630 .endd
24631 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24632 space.
24633
24634 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24635 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24636 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24637 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24638 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24639 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24640 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24641 components. For example, the rule
24642 .code
24643 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24644 .endd
24645 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24646 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24647 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24648 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24649 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24650 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24651 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24652 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24653
24654
24655
24656
24657
24658 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24660
24661 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24662 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24663 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24664 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24665 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24666 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24667 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24668 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24669 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24670 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24671 address, domain and error.
24672
24673 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24674 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24675 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24676 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24677 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24678 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24679 log selector is set, the message
24680 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24681 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24682 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24683 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24684
24685 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24686 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24687 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24688 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24689 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24690 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24691 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24692 domain are maintained independently.
24693
24694 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24695 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24696 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24697 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24698 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24699 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24700 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24701 the local address is reached.
24702
24703 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24704 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24705 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24706 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24707 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24708
24709 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24710 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24711 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24712 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24713 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24714 messages that it should now be retaining.
24715
24716
24717
24718 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24719 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24720 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24721 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24722 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24723 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24724 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24725 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24726 message's sender, respectively.
24727
24728
24729 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24730 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24731 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24732 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24733 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24734 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24735 example,
24736 .code
24737 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24738 .endd
24739 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24740 whereas
24741 .code
24742 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24743 .endd
24744 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24745 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24746 part.
24747
24748 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24749 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24750 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24751 expressions work in address lists.
24752 .display
24753 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24754 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24755 .endd
24756
24757
24758 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24759 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24760 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24761 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24762 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24763 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24764 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24765 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24766 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24767
24768 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24769 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24770 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24771 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24772 local transports).
24773
24774 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24775 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24776 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24777 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24778 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24779 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24780 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24781 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24782 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24783 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24784 commands.
24785
24786
24787
24788 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24789 "SECID160"
24790 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24791 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24792 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24793 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24794 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24795 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24796 .code
24797 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24798 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24799 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24800 .endd
24801 and the retry rules are
24802 .code
24803 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24804 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24805 .endd
24806 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24807 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24808 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24809 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24810 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24811 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24812
24813 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24814 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24815 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24816 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24817
24818 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24819 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24820 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24821 .code
24822 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24823 .endd
24824 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24825 textual form of the IP address.
24826
24827 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24828 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24829 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24830 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24831
24832 .vlist
24833 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24834 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24835 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24836
24837 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24838 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24839 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24840
24841 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24842 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24843
24844 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24845 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24846 .endlist
24847
24848 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24849 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24850 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24851 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24852 retry rule of this form:
24853 .code
24854 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24855 .endd
24856 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24857 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24858
24859 .vlist
24860 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24861 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24862 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24863 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24864
24865 .vitem &%lookup%&
24866 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24867 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24868 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24869 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24870 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24871
24872 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24873 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24874
24875 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24876 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24877
24878 .vitem &%refused%&
24879 A connection was refused.
24880
24881 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24882 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24883
24884 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24885 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24886
24887 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24888 A connection attempt timed out.
24889
24890 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24891 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24892 obtained from an MX record.
24893
24894 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24895 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24896 obtained from an MX record.
24897
24898 .vitem &%timeout%&
24899 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24900
24901 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24902 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24903 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24904 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24905
24906 .vitem &%quota%&
24907 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24908 transport.
24909
24910 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24911 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24912 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24913 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24914 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24915 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24916 for four days.
24917 .endlist
24918
24919 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24920 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24921 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24922 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24923 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24924 heuristic rules:
24925
24926 .ilist
24927 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24928 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24929 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24930 .next
24931 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24932 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24933 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24934 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24935 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24936 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24937 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24938 .next
24939 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24940 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24941 .endlist
24942
24943 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24944 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24945 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24946 error).
24947
24948
24949
24950 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24951 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24952 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24953 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24954 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24955 form:
24956 .display
24957 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24958 .endd
24959 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24960 .code
24961 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24962 .endd
24963 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24964 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24965 For example:
24966 .code
24967 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24968 .endd
24969 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24970 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24971 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24972 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24973 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24974
24975 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24976 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24977 .code
24978 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24979 .endd
24980 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24981 list is never matched.
24982
24983
24984
24985
24986
24987 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24988 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24989 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24990 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24991 .display
24992 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24993 .endd
24994 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24995 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24996 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24997 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24998 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24999
25000 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25001 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25002 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25003 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25004 The available algorithms are:
25005
25006 .ilist
25007 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25008 the interval.
25009 .next
25010 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25011 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25012 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25013 .next
25014 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25015 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25016 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25017 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25018 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25019 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25020 queue processing times.
25021 .endlist
25022
25023 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25024 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25025 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25026 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25027 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25028 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25029 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25030 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25031 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25032 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25033 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25034 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25035
25036 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25037 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25038 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25039 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25040 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25041 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25042 time.
25043
25044 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25045 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25046 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25047 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25048 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25049 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25050 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25051 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25052 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25053 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25054 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25055 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25056
25057 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25058 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25059 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25060 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25061 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25062 deliveries that have been deferred.
25063
25064
25065 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25066 Here are some example retry rules:
25067 .code
25068 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25069 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25070 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25071 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25072 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25073 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25074 .endd
25075 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25076 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25077 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25078 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25079 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25080 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25081 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25082 days.
25083
25084 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25085 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25086 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25087 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25088 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25089
25090 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25091 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25092 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25093 were not obtained from an MX record.
25094
25095 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25096 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25097 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25098 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25099 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25100
25101
25102
25103 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25104 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25105 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25106 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25107 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25108 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25109 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25110 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25111 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25112 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25113 failing for the first time.
25114
25115 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25116 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25117 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25118 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25119
25120 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25121 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25122 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25123
25124
25125
25126
25127 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25128 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25129 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25130 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25131 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25132 default retry rule:
25133 .code
25134 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25135 .endd
25136 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25137 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25138 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25139
25140 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25141 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25142 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25143 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25144 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25145
25146 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25147 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25148 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25149
25150 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25151 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25152 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25153 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25154 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25155 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25156 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25157 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25158
25159 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25160 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25161 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25162 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25163 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25164 notice.
25165
25166 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25167 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25168 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25169 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25170 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25171 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25172 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25173 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25174 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25175 true.
25176
25177 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25178 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25179 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25180 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25181 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25182 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25183 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25184 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25185 reached.
25186
25187 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25188 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25189 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25190 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25191 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25192 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25193 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25194 time out the address.
25195
25196 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25197 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25198 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25199 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25200 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25201 considered immediately.
25202 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25203 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25204
25205
25206
25207
25208
25209
25210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25211 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25212
25213 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25214 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25215 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25216 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25217 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25218 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25219 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25220 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25221 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25222 other.
25223
25224 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25225 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25226
25227 .ilist
25228 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25229 the client's EHLO command.
25230 .next
25231 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25232 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25233 .next
25234 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25235 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25236 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25237 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25238 with the AUTH command.
25239 .next
25240 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25241 .next
25242 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25243 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25244 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25245 connection.
25246 .next
25247 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25248 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25249 unauthenticated connection.
25250 .endlist
25251
25252 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25253 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25254 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25255 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25256 .display
25257 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25258 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25259 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25260 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25261 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25262 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25263 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25264 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25265 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25266 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25267 &`250 HELP`&
25268 .endd
25269 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25270 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25271 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25272 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25273 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25274 included by setting
25275 .code
25276 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25277 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25278 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25279 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25280 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25281 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25282 AUTH_SPA=yes
25283 AUTH_TLS=yes
25284 .endd
25285 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25286 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25287 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25288 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25289 work via a socket interface.
25290 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25291 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25292 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25293 supporting setting a server keytab.
25294 The sixth can be configured to support
25295 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25296 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25297 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25298 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25299 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25300
25301 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25302 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25303 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25304 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25305 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25306 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25307 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25308
25309 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25310 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25311 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25312 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25313 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25314 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25315 .code
25316 cram:
25317 driver = cram_md5
25318 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25319 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25320 client_name = ph10
25321 client_secret = secret2
25322 .endd
25323 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25324 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25325
25326 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25327 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25328 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25329 in Exim.
25330
25331 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25332 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25333 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25334 authenticating data.
25335
25336 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25337 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25338 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25339 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25340 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25341 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25342 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25343 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25344 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25345 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25346 choose to honour.
25347
25348 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25349 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25350 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25351 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25352
25353
25354
25355 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25356 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25357 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25358
25359 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25360 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25361 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25362 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25363 encrypted by a setting such as:
25364 .code
25365 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25366 .endd
25367
25368
25369 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25370 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25371 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25372 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25373
25374
25375 .option driver authenticators string unset
25376 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25377 authenticators is to be used.
25378
25379
25380 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25381 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25382 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25383 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25384 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25385 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25386
25387
25388 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25389 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25390 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25391 mechanism is not advertised.
25392 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25393 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25394 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25395
25396
25397 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25398 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25399 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25400 for details.
25401
25402 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25403 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25404
25405 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25406 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25407 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25408 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25409 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25410 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25411 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25412 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25413 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25414 the error text.
25415
25416
25417 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25418 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25419 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25420 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25421 out the values of variables.
25422 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25423 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25424
25425
25426 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25427 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25428 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25429 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25430 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25431 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25432 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25433 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25434 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25435
25436
25437 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25438 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25439 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25440 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25441 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25442 remembered for later use.
25443 How it is used is described in the following section.
25444
25445
25446
25447
25448
25449 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25450 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25451 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25452 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25453 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25454 message:
25455
25456 .ilist
25457 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25458 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25459 .next
25460 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25461 .next
25462 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25463 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25464 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25465 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25466 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25467 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25468 given for the MAIL command.
25469 .next
25470 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25471 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25472 authenticated.
25473 .next
25474 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25475 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25476 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25477 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25478 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25479 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25480 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25481 message.
25482 .endlist
25483
25484
25485 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25486 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25487 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25488 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25489
25490 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25491 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25492 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25493 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25494 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25495 ACL is run.
25496
25497
25498
25499 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25500 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25501 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25502 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25503 conditions:
25504
25505 .ilist
25506 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25507 .next
25508 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25509 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25510 .endlist
25511
25512 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25513 the mechanisms are advertised.
25514
25515 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25516 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25517 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25518 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25519 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25520 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25521 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25522 .code
25523 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25524 .endd
25525 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25526
25527 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25528 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25529 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25530 such as:
25531 .code
25532 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25533 .endd
25534 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25535 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25536 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25537
25538 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25539 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25540 command. This is the case if
25541
25542 .ilist
25543 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25544 .next
25545 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25546 .next
25547 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25548 server authenticators.
25549 .endlist
25550
25551
25552 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25553 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25554 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25555
25556 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25557 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25558 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25559 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25560 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25561 rejected with a 504 error.
25562
25563 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25564 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25565 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25566 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25567 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25568 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25569 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25570 no successful authentication.
25571
25572
25573
25574
25575 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25576 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25577 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25578 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25579 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25580 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25581 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25582 script:
25583 .code
25584 use MIME::Base64;
25585 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25586 .endd
25587 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25588 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25589 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25590 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25591 command line to run this script on such data might be
25592 .code
25593 encode '\0user\0password'
25594 .endd
25595 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25596 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25597 whose code value is zero.
25598
25599 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25600 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25601 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25602 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25603
25604 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25605 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25606 example, a command such as
25607 .code
25608 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25609 .endd
25610 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25611
25612 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25613 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25614 .code
25615 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25616 .endd
25617 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25618 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25619 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25620 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25621
25622
25623
25624 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25625 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25626 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25627 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25628 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25629 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25630
25631 .ilist
25632 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25633 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25634 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25635 of the authenticator.
25636 .next
25637 .vindex "&$host$&"
25638 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25639 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25640 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25641 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25642 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25643 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25644 delivery to be deferred.
25645 .next
25646 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25647 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25648 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25649 usual way.
25650 .next
25651 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25652 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25653 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25654 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25655 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25656 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25657 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25658 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25659 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25660 .endlist
25661
25662 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25663 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25664 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25665 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25666 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25667 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25668 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25669 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25670 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25671 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25672 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25673 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25674 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25675
25676
25677
25678
25679
25680
25681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25683
25684 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25685 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25686 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25687 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25688 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25689 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25690 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25691 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25692 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25693 connections as you do for login accounts.
25694
25695 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25696 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25697 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25698
25699 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25700 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25701 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25702
25703 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25704 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25705 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25706 given.
25707
25708 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25709 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25710 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25711 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25712 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25713 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25714 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25715
25716 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25717 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25718 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25719 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25720 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25721 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25722 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25723
25724 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25725 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25726 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25727 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25728
25729 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25730 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25731 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25732
25733 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25734 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25735 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25736 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25737 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25738 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25739 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25740 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25741 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25742 string as the error text
25743
25744 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25745 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25746 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25747
25748
25749
25750 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25751 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25752 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25753 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25754 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25755 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25756 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25757 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25758
25759 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25760 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25761 configured as follows:
25762 .code
25763 fixed_plain:
25764 driver = plaintext
25765 public_name = PLAIN
25766 server_prompts = :
25767 server_condition = \
25768 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25769 server_set_id = $auth2
25770 .endd
25771 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25772 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25773 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25774 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25775
25776 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25777 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25778 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25779 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25780 .code
25781 250-AUTH PLAIN
25782 .endd
25783 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25784 .code
25785 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25786 .endd
25787 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25788 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25789 .code
25790 AUTH PLAIN
25791 .endd
25792 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25793 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25794
25795 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25796 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25797 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25798 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25799 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25800
25801 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25802 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25803 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25804
25805 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25806 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25807 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25808 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25809 This is an incorrect example:
25810 .code
25811 server_condition = \
25812 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25813 .endd
25814 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25815 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25816 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25817 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25818 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25819 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25820 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25821 .code
25822 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25823 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25824 .endd
25825 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25826 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25827 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25828 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25829 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25830
25831
25832 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25833 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25834 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25835 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25836 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25837 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25838 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25839 .code
25840 fixed_login:
25841 driver = plaintext
25842 public_name = LOGIN
25843 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25844 server_condition = \
25845 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25846 server_set_id = $auth1
25847 .endd
25848 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25849 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25850 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25851 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25852
25853 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25854 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25855 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25856 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25857 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25858 .code
25859 login:
25860 driver = plaintext
25861 public_name = LOGIN
25862 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25863 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25864 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25865 ldapauth{\
25866 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25867 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25868 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25869 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25870 .endd
25871 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25872 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25873 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25874 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25875 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25876 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25877 uninterpreted string.
25878
25879
25880 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25881 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25882 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25883 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25884 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25885 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25886
25887
25888
25889
25890 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25891 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25892 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25893
25894 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25895 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25896 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25897 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25898 usual.
25899
25900 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25901 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25902 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25903 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25904 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25905 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25906 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25907 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25908 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25909 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25910 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25911 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25912
25913 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25914 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25915
25916 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25917 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25918 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25919 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25920 the string.
25921
25922 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25923 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25924 .code
25925 fixed_plain:
25926 driver = plaintext
25927 public_name = PLAIN
25928 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25929 .endd
25930 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25931 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25932 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25933 .code
25934 fixed_login:
25935 driver = plaintext
25936 public_name = LOGIN
25937 client_send = : username : mysecret
25938 .endd
25939 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25940 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25941 prompts.
25942 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25943 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25944
25945
25946
25947
25948 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25949 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25950
25951 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25952 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25953 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25954 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25955 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25956 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25957 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25958 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25959 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25960 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25961 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25962 available in plain text at either end.
25963
25964
25965 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25966 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25967 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25968 authenticator as a server:
25969
25970 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25971 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25972 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25973 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25974 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25975 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25976 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25977 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25978 returned to the client.
25979
25980 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25981 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25982 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25983 numeric variables for other things.
25984
25985 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25986 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25987 user name, authentication fails.
25988 .code
25989 fixed_cram:
25990 driver = cram_md5
25991 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25992 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25993 server_set_id = $auth1
25994 .endd
25995 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25996 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25997 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25998 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25999 .code
26000 lookup_cram:
26001 driver = cram_md5
26002 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26003 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26004 {$value}fail}
26005 server_set_id = $auth1
26006 .endd
26007 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26008 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26009
26010 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26011 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26012 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26013 realm, with:
26014 .code
26015 cyrusless_crammd5:
26016 driver = cram_md5
26017 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26018 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26019 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26020 server_set_id = $auth1
26021 .endd
26022
26023 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26024 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26025 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26026
26027
26028
26029 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26030 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26031 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26032
26033
26034 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26035 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26036 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26037
26038
26039 .vindex "&$host$&"
26040 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26041 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26042 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26043 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26044 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26045 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26046 send the message to the current server.
26047
26048 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26049 strings, is:
26050 .code
26051 fixed_cram:
26052 driver = cram_md5
26053 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26054 client_name = ph10
26055 client_secret = secret
26056 .endd
26057 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26058 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26059
26060
26061
26062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26064
26065 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26066 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26067 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26068 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26069 .cindex "Kerberos"
26070 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26071 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26072
26073 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26074 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26075 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26076 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26077 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26078
26079 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26080 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26081 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26082 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26083
26084 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26085 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26086 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26087 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26088 depending on the driver you are using.
26089
26090 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26091 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26092 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26093 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26094 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26095 implementation.
26096
26097 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26098 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26099 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26100 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26101 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26102 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26103 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26104 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26105
26106
26107 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26108 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26109 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26110 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26111 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26112 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26113 things.
26114
26115
26116 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26117 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26118 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26119 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26120
26121
26122 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26123 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26124 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26125 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26126 example:
26127 .code
26128 sasl:
26129 driver = cyrus_sasl
26130 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26131 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26132 server_set_id = $auth1
26133 .endd
26134
26135 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26136 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26137
26138
26139 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26140 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26141
26142
26143 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26144 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26145 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26146 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26147 .code
26148 sasl_cram_md5:
26149 driver = cyrus_sasl
26150 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26151 server_set_id = $auth1
26152
26153 sasl_plain:
26154 driver = cyrus_sasl
26155 public_name = PLAIN
26156 server_set_id = $auth2
26157 .endd
26158 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26159 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26160 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26161 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26162 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26163
26164
26165
26166
26167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26169 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26170 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26171 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26172 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26173 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26174 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26175 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26176 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26177 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26178
26179 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26180
26181 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26182 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26183 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26184 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26185 .code
26186 dovecot_plain:
26187 driver = dovecot
26188 public_name = PLAIN
26189 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26190 server_set_id = $auth1
26191
26192 dovecot_ntlm:
26193 driver = dovecot
26194 public_name = NTLM
26195 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26196 server_set_id = $auth1
26197 .endd
26198 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26199 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26200 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26201 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26202 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26203 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26204 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26205 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26206
26207
26208 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26210 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26211 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26212 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26213 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26214 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26215 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26216 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26217 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26218 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26219 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26220 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26221 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26222 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26223 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26224 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26225 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26226 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26227 without code changes in Exim.
26228
26229
26230 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26231 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26232 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26233 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26234 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26235 context.
26236
26237 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26238 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26239 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26240
26241 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26242 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26243 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26244
26245 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26246 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26247 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26248
26249
26250 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26251 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26252 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26253 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26254
26255
26256 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26257 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26258 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26259 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26260 example:
26261 .code
26262 sasl:
26263 driver = gsasl
26264 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26265 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26266 server_set_id = $auth1
26267 .endd
26268
26269
26270 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26271 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26272 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26273 the password itself.
26274
26275 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26276 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26277 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26278 if available, else the empty string.
26279 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26280 else the empty string.
26281
26282 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26283
26284 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26285 option to be simply "true".
26286
26287
26288 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26289 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26290 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26291
26292
26293 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26294 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26295 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26296 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26297
26298
26299 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26300 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26301 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26302 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26303
26304
26305 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26306 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26307 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26308
26309
26310 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26311 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26312 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26313 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26314
26315 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26316 meanings for these variables:
26317
26318 .ilist
26319 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26320 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26321 .next
26322 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26323 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26324 .next
26325 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26326 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26327 .endlist
26328
26329 On a per-mechanism basis:
26330
26331 .ilist
26332 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26333 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26334 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26335 .next
26336 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26337 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26338 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26339 .next
26340 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26341 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26342 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26343 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26344 .endlist
26345
26346 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26347 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26348 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26349
26350
26351 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26352 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26353 .code
26354 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26355 driver = gsasl
26356 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26357 server_realm = imap.example.org
26358 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26359 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26360 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26361 server_condition = yes
26362 .endd
26363
26364
26365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26367
26368 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26369 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26370 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26371 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26372 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26373 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26374 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26375 reliably.
26376
26377 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26378 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26379 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26380 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26381
26382 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26383 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26384 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26385 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26386
26387 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26388 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26389 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26390 from the keytab.
26391
26392
26393 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26394 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26395 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26396 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26397
26398 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26399 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26400 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26401 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26402
26403 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26404 .ilist
26405 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26406 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26407 .next
26408 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26409 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26410 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26411 GSS Display Name.
26412 .endlist
26413
26414
26415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26417
26418 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26419 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26420 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26421 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26422 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26423 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26424 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26425 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26426 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26427 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26428 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26429 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26430 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26431 follows:
26432
26433 .ilist
26434 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26435 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26436 .next
26437 The server sends back a challenge.
26438 .next
26439 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26440 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26441 .endlist
26442
26443 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26444
26445
26446
26447 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26448 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26449 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26450
26451 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26452 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26453 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26454 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26455 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26456 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26457 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26458 for other things. For example:
26459 .code
26460 spa:
26461 driver = spa
26462 public_name = NTLM
26463 server_password = \
26464 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26465 .endd
26466 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26467 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26468
26469
26470
26471
26472
26473 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26474 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26475 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26476
26477
26478
26479 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26480 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26481
26482
26483 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26484 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26485
26486
26487 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26488 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26489 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26490 &'msn.com'&:
26491 .code
26492 msn:
26493 driver = spa
26494 public_name = MSN
26495 client_username = msn/msn_username
26496 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26497 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26498 .endd
26499 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26500 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26501
26502
26503
26504
26505
26506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26508
26509 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26510 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26511 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26512 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26513 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26514 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26515 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26516 authentication based on client certificates.
26517
26518 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26519 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26520 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26521 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26522 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26523 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26524
26525 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26526 for which it must have been requested via the
26527 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26528 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26529
26530 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26531 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26532 and can authenticate the connection.
26533 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26534
26535 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26536
26537
26538 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26539 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26540
26541 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26542 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26543 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26544 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26545 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26546 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26547
26548 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26549 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26550 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26551
26552 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26553
26554
26555 Example:
26556 .code
26557 tls:
26558 driver = tls
26559 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26560 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26561 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26562 {!= {0} \
26563 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26564 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26565 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26566 } } } }
26567 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26568 .endd
26569 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26570 of your configured trust-anchors
26571 which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26572 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26573 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26574 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26575
26576 . An alternative might use
26577 . .code
26578 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26579 . .endd
26580 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26581 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26582 . This would help for per-device use.
26583 .
26584 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26585 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26586
26587 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26588 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26589
26590
26591 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26592 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26593 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26594
26595
26596
26597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26599
26600 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26601 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26602 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26603 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26604 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26605 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26606 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26607 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26608 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26609 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26610 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26611 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26612 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26613 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26614 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26615 certificates are used.
26616
26617 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26618 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26619 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26620 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26621 between them is encrypted.
26622
26623 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26624 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26625 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26626 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26627 encryption state.
26628
26629 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26630 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26631 in order to get TLS to work.
26632
26633
26634
26635 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26636 "SECID284"
26637 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26638 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26639 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26640 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26641 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26642 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26643 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26644 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26645 allocated for this purpose.
26646
26647 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26648 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26649 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26650 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26651 .code
26652 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26653 .endd
26654 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26655 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26656 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26657 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26658 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26659 defined elsewhere.
26660
26661 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26662 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26663
26664
26665
26666
26667
26668
26669 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26670 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26671 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26672 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26673 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26674 .code
26675 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26676 .endd
26677 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26678 .code
26679 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26680 .endd
26681 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26682 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26683
26684 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26685
26686 .ilist
26687 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26688 cannot be the path of a directory
26689 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26690 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26691 .next
26692 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26693 .next
26694 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26695 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26696 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26697 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26698 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26699 .next
26700 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26701 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26702 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26703 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26704 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26705 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26706 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26707 option).
26708 .next
26709 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26710 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26711 .next
26712 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26713 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26714 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26715 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26716 .next
26717 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26718 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26719 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26720 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26721 .endlist
26722
26723
26724 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26725 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26726 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26727 but not the chosen filename.
26728 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26729 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26730
26731 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26732 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26733 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26734 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26735 of bits requested.
26736 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26737 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26738 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26739 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26740 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26741 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26742 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26743
26744 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26745 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26746 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26747 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26748 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26749
26750 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26751 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26752 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26753 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26754 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26755 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26756
26757 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26758 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26759 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26760
26761 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26762 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26763 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26764 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26765 .code
26766 # ls
26767 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26768 # rm -f new-params
26769 # touch new-params
26770 # chown exim:exim new-params
26771 # chmod 0600 new-params
26772 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26773 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26774 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26775 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26776 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26777 # chmod 0400 new-params
26778 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26779 .endd
26780 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26781 stalling is removed.
26782
26783 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26784 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26785 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26786 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26787 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26788 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26789 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26790 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26791 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26792 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26793 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26794
26795 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26796 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26797 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26798 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26799
26800 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26801 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26802 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26803 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26804 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26805
26806
26807 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26808 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26809 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26810 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26811 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26812 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26813 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26814 directly to this function call.
26815 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26816 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26817 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26818 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26819
26820 .ilist
26821 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26822 .next
26823 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26824 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26825 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26826 SSL v3 algorithms.
26827 .next
26828 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26829 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26830 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26831 algorithms.
26832 .endlist
26833
26834 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26835 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26836 .ilist
26837 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26838 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26839 stated.
26840 .next
26841 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26842 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26843 .next
26844 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26845 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26846 .endlist
26847
26848 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26849 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26850 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26851 not be moved to the end of the list.
26852 .endlist
26853
26854 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26855 string:
26856 .code
26857 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26858 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26859 .endd
26860
26861 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26862 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26863 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26864 choice of clients used:
26865 .code
26866 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26867 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26868 {DEFAULT}\
26869 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26870 .endd
26871
26872
26873
26874 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26875 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26877 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26878 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26879 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26880 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26881 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26882 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26883 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26884 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26885 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26886
26887 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26888 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26889
26890 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26891 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26892 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26893 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26894 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26895 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26896
26897 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26898 "Priority strings". This is online as
26899 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26900 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26901 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26902 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26903 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26904
26905 For example:
26906 .code
26907 # Disable older versions of protocols
26908 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26909 .endd
26910
26911 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26912 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26913 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26914
26915 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26916 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26917 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26918 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26919 used:
26920 .code
26921 # GnuTLS variant
26922 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26923 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26924 {SECURE128}}
26925 .endd
26926
26927
26928 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26929 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26930 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26931 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26932 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26933 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26934 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26935 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26936
26937 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26938 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26939 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26940 with the error
26941 .code
26942 554 Security failure
26943 .endd
26944 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26945 rejected with a 554 error code.
26946
26947 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26948 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26949 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26950 without some further configuration at the server end.
26951
26952 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26953 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26954 .code
26955 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26956 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26957 .endd
26958 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26959 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26960 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26961 that goes with it. These files need to be
26962 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26963 always be given as full path names.
26964 The key must not be password-protected.
26965 They can be the same file if both the
26966 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26967 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26968 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26969 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26970 the server's certificate.
26971
26972 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26973 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26974 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26975
26976 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26977 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26978 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26979 transport.
26980
26981 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26982 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26983 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26984 .code
26985 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26986 .endd
26987 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26988 with the parameters contained in the file.
26989 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26990 available:
26991 .code
26992 tls_dhparam = none
26993 .endd
26994 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26995 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26996 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26997 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26998
26999 See the command
27000 .code
27001 openssl dhparam
27002 .endd
27003 for a way of generating file data.
27004
27005 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27006 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27007 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27008 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27009 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27010
27011 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27012 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27013 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27014 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27015 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27016 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27017 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27018 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27019 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27020
27021 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27022 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27023 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27024 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27025 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27026 documentation for more details.
27027
27028 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27029 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27030
27031
27032 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27033 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27034 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27035 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27036 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27037 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27038 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27039 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27040 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27041 expected certificates.
27042 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27043 an explicit file or,
27044 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27045 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27046
27047 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27048 directory is used
27049 (OpenSSL only),
27050 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27051 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27052 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27053 .code
27054 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27055 .endd
27056 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27057
27058 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27059 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27060 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27061 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27062 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27063 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27064 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27065 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27066 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27067 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27068
27069 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27070 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27071 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27072 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27073
27074 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27075 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27076 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27077 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27078 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27079 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27080
27081
27082 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27083 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27084 .cindex "revocation list"
27085 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27086 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27087 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27088 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27089 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27090 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27091 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27092 CRL in PEM format.
27093 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27094 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27095
27096 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27097 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27098 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27099 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27100 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27101 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27102
27103 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27104 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27105 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27106 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27107
27108 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27109 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27110 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27111 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27112 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27113 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27114 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27115 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27116
27117 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27118 .new
27119 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27120 .wen
27121 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27122
27123 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27124 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27125 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27126 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27127 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27128
27129 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27130 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27131 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27132 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27133 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27134 next connection.
27135
27136 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27137 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27138 ignored.
27139
27140 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27141 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27142 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27143 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27144 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27145 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27146
27147 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27148 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27149
27150 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27151
27152 .code
27153 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27154 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27155 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27156
27157 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27158 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27159 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27160 .endd
27161
27162
27163
27164
27165 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27166 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27167 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27168 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27169 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27170 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27171 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27172 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27173 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27174
27175 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27176 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27177 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27178 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27179 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27180
27181 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27182 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27183 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27184 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27185 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27186 usual way.
27187
27188 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27189 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27190 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27191 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27192 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27193 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27194 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27195 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27196 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27197 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27198 unencrypted.
27199
27200 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27201 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27202 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27203 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27204
27205 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27206 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27207 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27208 a file or,
27209 depending on library version, a directory,
27210 must name a file or,
27211 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
27212 The client verifies the server's certificate
27213 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27214 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27215 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27216 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27217
27218 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27219 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27220 or need not succeed respectively.
27221
27222 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27223 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27224 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27225 value is empty.
27226 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27227 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27228 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27229 otherwise.
27230
27231 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27232 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27233 for OCSP to be relevant.
27234
27235 If
27236 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27237 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27238 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27239 alternative hosts, if any.
27240
27241 &*Note*&:
27242 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27243 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27244 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27245 client.
27246
27247 .vindex "&$host$&"
27248 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27249 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27250 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27251 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27252 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27253
27254 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27255 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27256 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27257 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27258 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27259 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27260 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27261 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27262 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27263 outgoing connection.
27264
27265
27266
27267 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27268 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27269 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27270 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27271 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27272 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27273 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27274 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27275 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27276 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27277 for this session.
27278
27279 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27280 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27281 address.
27282
27283 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27284 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27285 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27286 be of limited use in that environment.
27287
27288 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27289 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27290 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27291 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27292 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27293
27294 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27295 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27296 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27297 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27298 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27299
27300 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27301 received from a client.
27302 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27303
27304 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27305 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27306 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27307
27308 .ilist
27309 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27310 &%tls_certificate%&
27311 .next
27312 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27313 &%tls_crl%&
27314 .next
27315 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27316 &%tls_privatekey%&
27317 .next
27318 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27319 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27320 .next
27321 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27322 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27323 .endlist
27324
27325 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27326 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27327 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27328 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27329
27330 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27331 are re-expanded.
27332
27333 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27334 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27335 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27336 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27337
27338 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27339 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27340 built, then you have SNI support).
27341
27342
27343
27344 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27345 "SECTmulmessam"
27346 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27347 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27348 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27349 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27350 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27351 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27352 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27353 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27354 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27355 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27356 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27357
27358 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27359 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27360 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27361 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27362 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27363 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27364 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27365 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27366 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27367
27368 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27369 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27370 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27371 information is recorded.
27372
27373 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27374 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27375 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27376
27377
27378
27379
27380 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27381 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27382 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27383 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27384 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27385 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27386 to Apache, currently at
27387 .display
27388 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27389 .endd
27390 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27391 links to further files.
27392 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27393 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27394 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27395 .display
27396 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27397 .endd
27398
27399
27400 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27401 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27402 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27403 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27404 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27405 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27406 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27407 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27408 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27409 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27410 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27411 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27412 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27413
27414 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27415 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27416 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27417 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27418
27419
27420
27421 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27422 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27423 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27424 with OpenSSL, like this:
27425 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27426 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27427 .code
27428 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27429 -days 9999 -nodes
27430 .endd
27431 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27432 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27433 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27434 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27435 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27436 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27437 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27438
27439 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27440 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27441 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27442 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27443 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27444 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27445 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27446 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27447 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27448 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27449 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27450 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27451 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27452 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27453 be a sensible resolution).
27454
27455 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27456 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27457 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27458
27459 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27460 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27461 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27462 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27463 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27464 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27465
27466 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27467 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27468 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27469 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27470 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27471 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27472
27473
27474
27475 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27476 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27477
27478 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27479 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27480 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27481 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27482 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27483 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27484 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27485 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27486 one very small ACL:
27487 .code
27488 begin acl
27489 small_acl:
27490 accept hosts = one.host.only
27491 .endd
27492 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27493 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27494
27495 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27496 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27497 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27498 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27499 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27500 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27501 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27502 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27503
27504
27505 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27506 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27507 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27508 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27509 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27510
27511
27512
27513 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27514 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27515 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27516 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27517 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27518 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27519 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27520 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27521 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27522 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27523 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27524 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27525 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27526 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27527 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27528 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27529 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27530 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27531 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27532 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27533
27534 .table2 140pt
27535 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27536 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27537 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27538 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27539 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27540 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27541 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27542 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27543 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27544 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27545 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27546 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27547 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27548 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27549 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27550 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27551 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27552 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27553 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27554 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27555 .endtable
27556
27557 For example, if you set
27558 .code
27559 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27560 .endd
27561 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27562 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27563 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27564 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27565 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27566 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27567 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27568
27569
27570 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27571 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27572 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27573 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27574 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27575 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27576 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27577 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27578 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27579 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27580 in any of these ACLs.
27581
27582 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27583 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27584 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27585 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27586 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27587 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27588 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27589 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27590 .code
27591 control = suppress_local_fixups
27592 .endd
27593 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27594 run, it is too late.
27595
27596 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27597 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27598
27599 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27600 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27601 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27602
27603
27604 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27605 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27606 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27607 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27608 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27609 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27610 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27611 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27612 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27613
27614
27615 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27616 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27617 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27618 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27619 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27620 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27621 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27622 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27623 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27624
27625 .new
27626 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
27627 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
27628 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
27629 .wen
27630
27631 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27632 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27633 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27634 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27635 an EHLO response.
27636
27637
27638 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27639 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27640 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27641 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27642 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27643 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27644 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27645 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27646 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27647 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27648
27649 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27650 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27651 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27652 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27653 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27654 associated with the DATA command.
27655
27656 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27657 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27658 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27659 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27660 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27661 your resources.
27662
27663 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27664 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27665 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27666 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27667
27668 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27669 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27670 enabled (which is the default).
27671
27672 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27673 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27674 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27675
27676 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27677
27678 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27679
27680
27681 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27682 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27683 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27684
27685 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27686
27687
27688 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27689 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27690 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27691 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27692 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27693 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27694 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27695 has been accepted.
27696
27697 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27698 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27699 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27700 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27701 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27702 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27703 for some or all recipients.
27704
27705 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27706 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27707 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27708 .new
27709 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27710 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27711 is &"yes"&.
27712 .wen
27713 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27714 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27715 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27716
27717 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27718 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27719
27720 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27721 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27722 the feature was not requested by the client.
27723
27724 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27725 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27726 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27727 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27728 does not in fact control any access.
27729 For this reason, it may only accept
27730 or warn as its final result.
27731
27732 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27733 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27734 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27735 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27736
27737 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27738 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27739
27740 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27741 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27742 response to QUIT.
27743
27744 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27745 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27746 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27747 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27748 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27749
27750
27751 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27752 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27753 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27754 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27755 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27756 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27757 situation even worse.
27758
27759 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27760 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27761 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27762 and &%warn%&.
27763
27764 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27765 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27766 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27767 connection. The possible values are:
27768 .table2
27769 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27770 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27771 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27772 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27773 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27774 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27775 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27776 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27777 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27778 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27779 .endtable
27780 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27781 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27782 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27783 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27784 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27785 used.
27786
27787
27788 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27789 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27790 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27791 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27792 .code
27793 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27794 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27795 .endd
27796 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27797 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27798 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27799 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27800 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27801
27802 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27803 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27804 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27805
27806 .ilist
27807 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27808 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27809 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27810 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27811 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27812 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27813 .code
27814 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27815 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27816 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27817 .endd
27818 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27819 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27820 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27821 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27822 .next
27823 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27824 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27825 matches the string.
27826 .next
27827 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27828 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27829 want to have something like
27830 .code
27831 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27832 .endd
27833 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27834 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27835 .endlist
27836
27837
27838
27839
27840 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27841 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27842 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27843 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27844 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27845 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27846 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27847 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27848 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27849
27850 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27851 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27852 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27853
27854
27855 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27856 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27857 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27858 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27859
27860 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27861 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27862 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27863 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27864 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27865 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27866 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27867
27868
27869 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27870 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27871 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27872
27873
27874
27875 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27876 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27877 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27878 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27879 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27880 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27881
27882 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27883 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27884 used to accept or reject anything.
27885
27886 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27887 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27888 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27889 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27890
27891 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27892 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27893 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27894 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27895 configuration file.
27896
27897
27898
27899
27900 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27901 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27902 .vindex &$domain$&
27903 .vindex &$local_part$&
27904 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27905 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27906 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27907 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27908 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27909 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27910 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27911 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27912 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27913
27914 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27915 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27916 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27917 how it is used.
27918
27919 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27920 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27921 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27922 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27923 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27924 received).
27925
27926 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27927 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27928 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27929 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27930 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27931 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27932 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27933 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27934
27935
27936
27937
27938
27939 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27940 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27941 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27942 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27943 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27944 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27945 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27946 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27947 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27948 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27949 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27950 unencrypted connections.
27951 .code
27952 acl_check_auth:
27953 accept encrypted = *
27954 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27955 {CRAM-MD5}}
27956 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27957 .endd
27958 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27959 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27960 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27961 option to do this.)
27962
27963
27964
27965 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27966 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27967 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27968 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27969 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27970 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27971 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27972
27973 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27974 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27975 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27976 example:
27977 .code
27978 deny dnslists = list1.example
27979 dnslists = list2.example
27980 .endd
27981 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27982 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27983 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27984 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27985 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27986
27987
27988 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27989 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27990
27991 .ilist
27992 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27993 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27994 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27995 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27996 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27997 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27998 check a RCPT command:
27999 .code
28000 accept domains = +local_domains
28001 endpass
28002 verify = recipient
28003 .endd
28004 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28005 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28006 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28007 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28008 &%endpass%&.
28009
28010 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28011 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28012 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28013 configuration.
28014
28015 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28016 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28017 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28018 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28019 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28020 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28021 .display
28022 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28023 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28024 .endd
28025 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28026 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28027 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28028
28029 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28030 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28031 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28032 of &%endpass%&.
28033
28034
28035 .next
28036 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28037 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28038 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28039 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28040 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28041 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28042 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28043
28044
28045 .next
28046 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28047 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28048 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28049 example,
28050 .code
28051 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28052 .endd
28053 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28054
28055
28056 .next
28057 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28058 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28059 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28060 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28061 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28062 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28063 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28064 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28065 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28066
28067 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28068 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28069 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28070
28071
28072 .next
28073 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28074 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28075 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28076 .code
28077 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28078 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28079 .endd
28080 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28081 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28082
28083 .next
28084 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28085 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28086 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28087 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28088 .code
28089 require message = Sender did not verify
28090 verify = sender
28091 .endd
28092 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28093 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28094 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28095 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28096
28097 .next
28098 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28099 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28100 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28101 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28102 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28103 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28104 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28105
28106 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28107 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28108 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28109 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28110 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28111
28112 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28113 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28114 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28115 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28116 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28117 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28118 onwards.
28119
28120
28121 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28122 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28123 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28124 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28125 .code
28126 warn !verify = sender
28127 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28128 .endd
28129 .endlist
28130
28131 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28132
28133 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28134 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28135 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28136 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28137 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28138
28139
28140
28141 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28142 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28143 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28144 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28145 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28146 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28147 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28148 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28149 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28150 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28151 .ilist
28152 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28153 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28154 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28155 on the same SMTP connection.
28156 .next
28157 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28158 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28159 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28160 .endlist
28161
28162 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28163 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28164 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28165 .code
28166 accept hosts = whatever
28167 set acl_m4 = some value
28168 accept authenticated = *
28169 set acl_c_auth = yes
28170 .endd
28171 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28172 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28173 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28174
28175 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28176 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28177 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28178 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28179 error is generated.
28180
28181 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28182 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28183
28184
28185 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28186 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28187 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28188 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28189 .code
28190 deny domains = *.dom.example
28191 !verify = recipient
28192 .endd
28193 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28194 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28195 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28196 two statements are equivalent:
28197 .code
28198 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28199 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28200 .endd
28201 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28202 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28203
28204 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28205 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28206 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28207 .code
28208 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28209 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28210 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28211 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28212 .endd
28213 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28214 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28215 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28216 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28217 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28218 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28219 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28220
28221 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28222 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28223 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28224 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28225 message is handled.
28226
28227 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28228 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28229 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28230 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28231 .code
28232 require message = Can't verify sender
28233 verify = sender
28234 message = Can't verify recipient
28235 verify = recipient
28236 message = This message cannot be used
28237 .endd
28238 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28239 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28240 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28241 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28242 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28243 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28244
28245 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28246 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28247 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28248 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28249 .code
28250 deny hosts = ...
28251 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28252 message = Invalid sender from client host
28253 .endd
28254 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28255 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28256
28257
28258
28259 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28260 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28261 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28262
28263 .vlist
28264 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28265 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28266 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28267 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28268
28269 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28270 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28271 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28272 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28273 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28274 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28275 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28276 write rather ugly lines like this:
28277 .display
28278 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28279 .endd
28280 Instead, all you need is
28281 .display
28282 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28283 .endd
28284
28285 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28286 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28287 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28288 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28289 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28290 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28291 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28292 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28293
28294 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28295 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28296 in several different ways. For example:
28297
28298 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28299 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28300 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28301 . ==== way.
28302
28303 .ilist
28304 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28305 .code
28306 accept ...some conditions
28307 control = queue_only
28308 .endd
28309 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28310 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28311
28312 .next
28313 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28314 .code
28315 accept ...some conditions...
28316 control = queue_only
28317 ...some more conditions...
28318 .endd
28319 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28320 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28321 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28322 to be relevant.
28323
28324 .next
28325 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28326 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28327 example:
28328 .code
28329 warn ...some conditions...
28330 control = freeze
28331 accept ...
28332 .endd
28333 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28334 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28335 log entry.
28336
28337 .next
28338 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28339 &%require%& verb. For example:
28340 .code
28341 require control = no_multiline_responses
28342 .endd
28343 .endlist
28344
28345 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28346 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28347 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28348 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28349 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28350 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28351 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28352 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28353 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28354
28355 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28356 example:
28357 .code
28358 deny ...some conditions...
28359 delay = 30s
28360 .endd
28361 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28362 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28363 .code
28364 deny delay = 30s
28365 ...some conditions...
28366 .endd
28367 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28368 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28369 .code
28370 warn ...some conditions...
28371 delay = 2m
28372 control = freeze
28373 accept ...
28374 .endd
28375
28376 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28377 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28378 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28379 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28380 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28381 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28382 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28383
28384
28385 .vitem &*endpass*&
28386 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28387 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28388 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28389 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28390 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28391 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28392 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28393
28394
28395 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28396 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28397 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28398 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28399 .code
28400 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28401 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28402 .endd
28403 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28404 example:
28405 .display
28406 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28407 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28408 .endd
28409 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28410 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28411 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28412 message.
28413
28414 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28415 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28416 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28417 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28418 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28419 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28420 ignored.
28421
28422 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28423 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28424 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28425 error message.
28426
28427 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28428 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28429 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28430 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28431 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28432 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28433
28434 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28435 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28436 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28437 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28438 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28439 logging rejections.
28440
28441
28442 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28443 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28444 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28445 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28446 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28447 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28448 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28449 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28450 .display
28451 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28452 &` log_reject_target =`&
28453 .endd
28454 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28455 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28456 current ACL.
28457
28458
28459 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28460 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28461 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28462 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28463 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28464 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28465 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28466 ACLs. For example:
28467 .display
28468 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28469 &` control = freeze`&
28470 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28471 .endd
28472 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28473 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28474 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28475 example:
28476 .code
28477 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28478 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28479 .endd
28480
28481
28482 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28483 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28484 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28485 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28486 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28487 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28488 &%accept%& for details.)
28489
28490 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28491 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28492 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28493 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28494 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28495 .code
28496 require message = Host not recognized
28497 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28498 .endd
28499 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28500 processed.)
28501
28502 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28503 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28504 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28505 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28506 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28507 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28508 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28509 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28510 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28511 EHLO options.
28512
28513 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28514 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28515 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28516 .code
28517 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28518 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28519 .endd
28520 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28521 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28522 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28523 2&'xx'&.
28524
28525 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28526 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28527
28528 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28529 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28530 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28531 response.
28532
28533 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28534 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28535 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28536
28537 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28538 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28539 However, the original message is available in the variable
28540 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28541 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28542 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28543 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28544
28545 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28546 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28547 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28548 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28549 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28550 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28551 effect.
28552
28553
28554 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28555 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28556 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28557 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28558
28559
28560 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28561 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28562 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28563 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28564
28565
28566 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28567 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28568 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28569 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28570 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28571 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28572 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28573 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28574 when:
28575 .code
28576 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28577 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28578 .endd
28579 .endlist
28580
28581
28582
28583
28584 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28585 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28586 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28587
28588 .vlist
28589 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28590 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28591 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28592 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28593 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28594 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28595 not work without it. For example:
28596 .code
28597 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28598 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28599 .endd
28600 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28601 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28602 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28603 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28604 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28605
28606
28607 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28608 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28609 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28610 .cindex "case of local parts"
28611 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28612 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28613 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28614 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28615 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28616 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28617 is encountered.
28618
28619 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28620 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28621 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28622 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28623 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28624
28625 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28626 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28627 spam score:
28628 .code
28629 warn control = caseful_local_part
28630 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28631 $acl_m4 + \
28632 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28633 }
28634 control = caselower_local_part
28635 .endd
28636 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28637 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28638
28639
28640 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28641 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28642 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28643 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28644
28645 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28646 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28647 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28648 is used for all recipients of the message,
28649 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28650 and data is copied from one to the other.
28651
28652 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28653 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28654 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28655 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28656 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28657 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28658
28659 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28660 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28661 Note also that headers cannot be
28662 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28663 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28664
28665 .new
28666 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
28667 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
28668 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
28669 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
28670 message body.
28671 .wen
28672
28673 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28674 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28675 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28676 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28677
28678 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28679 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28680 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28681 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28682 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28683 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28684
28685 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28686 (possibly faked)
28687 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28688
28689
28690 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28691 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28692 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28693 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28694 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28695 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28696 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28697 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28698 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28699 contexts):
28700 .code
28701 control = debug
28702 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28703 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28704 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28705 .endd
28706
28707
28708 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28709 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28710 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28711 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28712 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28713
28714
28715 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28716 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28717 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28718 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28719 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28720 strings or to numeric value.
28721 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28722 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28723 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28724
28725 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28726 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28727 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28728 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28729 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28730
28731
28732 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28733 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28734 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28735 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28736 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28737 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28738 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28739 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28740
28741 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28742 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28743 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28744 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28745 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28746 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28747 work with.
28748
28749
28750 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28751 .cindex "fake defer"
28752 .cindex "defer, fake"
28753 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28754 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28755 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28756 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28757 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28758
28759 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28760 .cindex "fake rejection"
28761 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28762 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28763 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28764 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28765 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28766 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28767 the same SMTP connection.
28768
28769 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28770 message is supplied, the following is used:
28771 .code
28772 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28773 550-kept for evaluation.
28774 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28775 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28776 .endd
28777 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28778
28779 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28780 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28781 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28782 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28783 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28784 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28785 SMTP connection.
28786
28787 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28788 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28789 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28790 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28791
28792 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28793 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28794 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28795 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28796 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28797 disables such output flushing.
28798
28799 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28800 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28801 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28802 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28803 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28804 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28805
28806 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28807 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28808 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28809 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28810 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28811 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28812 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28813 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28814 to be useful in production.
28815
28816 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28817 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28818 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28819 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28820 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28821
28822 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28823 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28824 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28825 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28826 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28827 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28828
28829 .ilist
28830 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28831 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28832 verification failed"&) is sent.
28833 .next
28834 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28835 line is output.
28836 .endlist
28837
28838 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28839 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28840
28841 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28842 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28843 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28844 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28845 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28846 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28847 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28848
28849 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28850 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28851 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28852 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28853 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28854 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28855 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28856 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28857 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28858 same SMTP connection.
28859
28860 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28861 .cindex "message" "submission"
28862 .cindex "submission mode"
28863 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28864 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28865 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28866 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28867 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28868 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28869 late (the message has already been created).
28870
28871 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28872 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28873 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28874 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28875 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28876
28877 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28878 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28879 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28880 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28881 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28882
28883 .ilist
28884 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28885 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28886 .next
28887 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28888 .next
28889 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28890 .endlist ilist
28891
28892 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28893 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28894 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28895 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28896 data is read.
28897
28898 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28899 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28900
28901 .new
28902 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
28903 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
28904 to a-label form.
28905 For details see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
28906 .wen
28907 .endlist vlist
28908
28909
28910 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28911 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28912
28913 .ilist
28914 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28915 .next
28916 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28917 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28918 .next
28919 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28920 .next
28921 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28922 .endlist
28923
28924
28925
28926 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28927 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28928 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28929 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28930 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28931 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28932 .code
28933 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28934 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28935 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28936 .endd
28937 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28938 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28939 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28940 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28941 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28942 RCPT ACL).
28943
28944 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28945 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28946
28947 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28948 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28949 contains one or more newlines that
28950 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28951 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28952 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28953
28954 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28955 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28956 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28957 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28958 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28959 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28960 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28961 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28962 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28963 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28964 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28965
28966 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28967 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28968 of message headers
28969 until they are added to the
28970 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28971 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28972 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28973 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28974 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28975 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28976 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28977
28978 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28979
28980 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28981 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28982 .display
28983 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28984 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28985
28986 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28987 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28988 .endd
28989 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28990 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28991 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28992 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28993 honoured.
28994
28995 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28996 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28997 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28998 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28999 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29000 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29001 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29002 specifications.
29003
29004 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29005 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29006 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29007 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29008 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29009
29010 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29011 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29012 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29013 to be a header name first.) For example:
29014 .code
29015 warn add_header = \
29016 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29017 .endd
29018 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29019 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29020 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29021 up in reverse order.
29022
29023 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29024 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29025 system filter or in a router or transport.
29026
29027
29028
29029 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29030 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29031 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29032 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29033 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29034 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29035 .code
29036 warn message = Remove internal headers
29037 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29038 .endd
29039 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29040 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29041 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29042 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29043 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29044 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29045
29046 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
29047 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
29048
29049 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29050 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29051 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29052 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29053 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29054 .code
29055 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29056 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29057 warn message = Remove internal headers
29058 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29059 .endd
29060 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29061 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29062 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29063 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29064 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29065 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29066 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29067 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29068 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29069 would have been removed.
29070
29071 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29072 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29073 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29074 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29075 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29076 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29077 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29078 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29079 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29080
29081 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29082 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29083 .display
29084 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29085 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29086
29087 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29088 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29089 .endd
29090 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29091 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29092 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29093 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29094 are honoured.
29095
29096 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29097 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29098 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29099
29100
29101
29102
29103 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29104 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29105 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29106 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29107 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29108 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29109
29110 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29111 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29112 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29113 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29114 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29115 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29116 The conditions are as follows:
29117
29118
29119 .vlist
29120 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29121 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29122 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29123 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29124 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29125 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29126 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29127 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29128 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29129 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29130 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29131 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29132
29133 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29134 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29135 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29136 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29137 The name and values are expanded separately.
29138 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29139 will act as argument separators.
29140
29141 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29142 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29143 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29144 conditions are tested.
29145
29146 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29147 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29148 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29149 for different local users or different local domains.
29150
29151 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29152 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29153 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29154 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29155 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29156 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29157 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29158 .code
29159 authenticated = *
29160 .endd
29161
29162 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29163 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29164 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29165 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29166 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29167 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29168 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29169 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29170 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29171 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29172 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29173 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29174 negative.
29175
29176 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29177 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29178 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29179 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29180 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29181 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29182 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29183 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29184
29185 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
29186 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
29187 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29188 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
29189 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
29190
29191 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29192 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29193 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29194 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29195 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29196 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29197 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29198 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29199 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29200 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29201
29202 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29203 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29204 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29205 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29206 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29207 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29208 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29209 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29210 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29211 &%domains%& test.
29212
29213 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29214 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29215
29216
29217 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29218 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29219 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29220 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29221 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29222 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29223 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29224 .code
29225 encrypted = *
29226 .endd
29227
29228
29229 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29230 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29231 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29232 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29233 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29234 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29235 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29236 .code
29237 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29238 .endd
29239 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29240 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29241 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29242
29243 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29244 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29245 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29246 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29247 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29248 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29249
29250 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29251 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29252 .code
29253 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29254 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29255 .endd
29256 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29257 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29258 statement can then check the IP address.
29259
29260 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29261 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29262 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29263 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29264 .code
29265 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29266 message = $host_data
29267 .endd
29268 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29269
29270 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29271 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29272 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29273 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29274 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29275 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29276 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29277 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29278 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29279 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29280
29281 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29282 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29283 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29284 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29285 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29286 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29287 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29288
29289 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29290 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29291 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29292 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29293 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29294 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29295 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29296 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29297
29298 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29299 .cindex "rate limiting"
29300 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29301 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29302
29303 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29304 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29305 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29306 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29307 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29308 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29309
29310 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29311 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29312 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29313 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29314 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29315 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29316 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29317
29318 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29319 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29320 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29321 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29322 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29323 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29324 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29325 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29326 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29327 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29328 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29329 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29330 influence the sender checking.
29331
29332 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29333 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29334
29335 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29336 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29337 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29338 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29339 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29340 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29341 .code
29342 senders = :
29343 .endd
29344 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29345 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29346
29347 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29348 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29349 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29350 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29351 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29352 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29353
29354 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29355 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29356 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29357 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29358 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29359 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29360 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29361 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29362 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29363 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29364
29365 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29366 .cindex "CSA verification"
29367 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29368 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29369 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29370
29371 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29372 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29373 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29374 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29375 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29376 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29377 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29378 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29379 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29380 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29381
29382 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29383 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29384 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29385
29386 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29387 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29388 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29389 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29390 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29391 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29392 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29393 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29394 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29395 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29396 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29397 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29398 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29399 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29400 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29401
29402 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29403 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29404 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29405 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29406 .code
29407 deny senders = :
29408 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29409 !verify = header_sender
29410 .endd
29411
29412 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29413 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29414 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29415 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29416 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29417 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29418 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29419 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29420 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29421 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29422 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29423 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29424 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29425 appropriate.
29426
29427 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29428 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29429 .code
29430 To: @
29431 .endd
29432 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29433 common as they used to be.
29434
29435 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29436 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29437 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29438 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29439 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29440 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29441 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29442 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29443 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29444 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29445 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29446 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29447 independently of this condition.
29448
29449 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29450 option), this condition is always true.
29451
29452
29453 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29454 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29455 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29456 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29457 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29458 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29459 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29460 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29461 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29462
29463 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29464 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29465
29466
29467 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29468 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29469 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29470 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29471 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29472 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29473 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29474 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29475 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29476 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29477 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29478 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29479 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29480 value for the child address.
29481
29482 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29483 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29484 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29485 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29486 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29487 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29488 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29489 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29490 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29491 original IP address.
29492
29493 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29494 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29495
29496 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29497 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29498
29499 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29500 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29501 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29502 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29503 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29504 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29505 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29506 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29507 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29508
29509 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29510 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29511 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29512 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29513 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29514 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29515 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29516
29517 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29518 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29519 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29520
29521 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29522 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29523 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29524 verified as a sender.
29525 .endlist
29526
29527
29528
29529 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29530 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29531 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29532 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29533 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29534 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29535 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29536 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29537 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29538 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29539 .code
29540 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29541 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29542 .endd
29543 the following records are looked up:
29544 .code
29545 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29546 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29547 .endd
29548 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29549 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29550 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29551 use two separate conditions:
29552 .code
29553 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29554 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29555 .endd
29556 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29557 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29558 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29559 processed.
29560
29561 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29562 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29563 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29564 following special items in the list:
29565 .display
29566 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29567 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29568 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29569 .endd
29570 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29571 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29572 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29573 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29574 .code
29575 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29576 .endd
29577 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29578 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29579 .code
29580 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29581 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29582 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29583 .endd
29584 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29585 .cindex DNS TTL
29586 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29587 .new
29588 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29589 .wen
29590 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29591 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29592 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29593 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29594
29595
29596
29597 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29598 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29599 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29600 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29601 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29602 .code
29603 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29604 .endd
29605 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29606 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29607 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29608 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29609
29610
29611
29612
29613 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29614 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29615 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29616 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29617 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29618 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29619 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29620 .code
29621 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29622 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29623 .endd
29624 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29625 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29626 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29627 up by this example is
29628 .code
29629 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29630 .endd
29631 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29632 addresses. For example:
29633 .code
29634 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29635 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29636 .endd
29637 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29638 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29639
29640
29641
29642
29643 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29644 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29645 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29646 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29647 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29648 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29649 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29650 either to double the separators like this:
29651 .code
29652 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29653 .endd
29654 or to change the separator character, like this:
29655 .code
29656 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29657 .endd
29658 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29659 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29660 occurs. Consider this condition:
29661 .code
29662 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29663 .endd
29664 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29665 .code
29666 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29667 a.domain.black.list.tld
29668 .endd
29669 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29670 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29671 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29672 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29673 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29674 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29675 error for a previous item.
29676
29677 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29678 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29679 .code
29680 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29681 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29682 .endd
29683 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29684 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29685 .code
29686 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29687 $sender_address_domain \
29688 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29689 see $dnslist_text.
29690 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29691 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29692 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29693 .endd
29694 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29695 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29696 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29697 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29698 .code
29699 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29700 .endd
29701 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29702 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29703
29704 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29705 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29706
29707
29708
29709
29710 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29711 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29712 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29713 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29714 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29715 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29716 .display
29717 127.1.0.1 RBL
29718 127.1.0.2 DUL
29719 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29720 127.1.0.4 RSS
29721 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29722 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29723 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29724 .endd
29725 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29726 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29727 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29728
29729
29730 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29731 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29732 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29733 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29734 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29735 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29736 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29737 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29738 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29739 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29740 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29741 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29742 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29743 cases, for example:
29744 .code
29745 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29746 .endd
29747 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29748 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29749 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29750 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29751 .code
29752 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29753 .endd
29754 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29755 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29756
29757 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29758 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29759 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29760 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29761 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29762 information.
29763
29764 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29765 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29766 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29767 .code
29768 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29769 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29770 at $dnslist_domain
29771 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29772 .endd
29773
29774
29775
29776 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29777 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29778 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29779 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29780 For example,
29781 .code
29782 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29783 .endd
29784 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29785 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29786 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29787 describes how multiple records are handled.
29788
29789 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29790 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29791 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29792 .code
29793 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29794 .endd
29795 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29796 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29797 first. For example:
29798 .code
29799 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29800 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29801 .endd
29802
29803 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29804 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29805 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29806 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29807 tested. For example:
29808 .code
29809 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29810 .endd
29811 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29812 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29813 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29814 .code
29815 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29816 .endd
29817 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29818 an odd number.
29819
29820
29821
29822 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29823 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29824 condition. Whereas
29825 .code
29826 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29827 .endd
29828 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29829 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29830 .code
29831 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29832 .endd
29833 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29834 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29835 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29836 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29837
29838 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29839 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29840
29841 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29842 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29843 .code
29844 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29845 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29846 .endd
29847 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29848 Consider this example:
29849 .code
29850 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29851 list.dsbl.org : \
29852 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29853 relays.ordb.org
29854 .endd
29855 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29856 .code
29857 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29858 list.dsbl.org
29859 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29860 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29861 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29862 .endd
29863 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29864
29865
29866
29867
29868 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29869 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29870 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29871 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29872 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29873 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29874 .code
29875 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29876 .endd
29877 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29878 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29879 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29880 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29881 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29882 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29883
29884 .ilist
29885 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29886 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29887 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29888 .next
29889 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29890 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29891 changed to:
29892 .code
29893 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29894 .endd
29895 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29896 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29897 .code
29898 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29899 .endd
29900 for the condition to be true.
29901 .endlist
29902
29903 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29904 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29905 .ilist
29906 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29907 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29908 .code
29909 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29910 .endd
29911 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29912 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29913 .next
29914 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29915 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29916 .code
29917 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29918 .endd
29919 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29920 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29921 .code
29922 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29923 .endd
29924 for the condition to be false.
29925 .endlist
29926 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29927 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29928
29929
29930
29931
29932 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29933 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29934 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29935 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29936 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29937 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29938 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29939 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29940 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29941 lists.
29942
29943 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29944 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29945 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29946 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29947 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29948 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29949 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29950 .code
29951 reject message = \
29952 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29953 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29954 dnslists = \
29955 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29956 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29957 .endd
29958 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29959 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29960 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29961 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29962 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29963 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29964
29965 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29966 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29967 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29968 .code
29969 reject dnslists = \
29970 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29971 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29972 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29973 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29974 .endd
29975 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29976 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29977 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29978
29979
29980
29981 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29982 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29983 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29984 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29985 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29986 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29987 .code
29988 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29989 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29990 .endd
29991 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29992 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29993 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29994 .code
29995 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29996 .endd
29997 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29998 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29999
30000 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30001 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30002 .code
30003 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30004 dnslists = some.list.example
30005 .endd
30006
30007 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30008 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30009 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30010 .code
30011 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30012 .endd
30013
30014 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30015 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30016 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30017 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30018 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30019 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30020 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30021 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30022 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30023 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30024 .display
30025 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30026 .endd
30027 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30028 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30029
30030 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30031 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30032 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30033 of &'p'&.
30034
30035 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30036 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30037 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30038 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30039 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30040 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30041 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30042 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30043 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30044
30045 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30046 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30047 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30048 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30049
30050 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30051 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30052 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30053 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30054 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30055 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30056 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30057 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30058 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30059 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30060
30061 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30062 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30063 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30064 ACL.
30065
30066 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30067 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30068 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30069 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30070 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30071 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30072
30073 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30074 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30075 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30076 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30077 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30078 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30079 the &%count=%& option.
30080
30081
30082 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30083 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30084 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30085 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30086 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30087
30088 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30089 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30090 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30091 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30092
30093 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30094 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30095 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30096 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30097 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30098 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30099 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30100
30101 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30102 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30103 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30104 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30105 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30106 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30107 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30108
30109 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30110 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30111 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30112 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30113 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30114
30115 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30116 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30117 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30118 multiple different commands.
30119
30120 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30121 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30122 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30123 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30124 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30125
30126 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30127
30128
30129 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30130 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30131 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30132 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30133 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30134
30135 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30136 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30137
30138 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30139 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30140 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30141 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30142 new rate.
30143 .code
30144 acl_check_connect:
30145 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30146 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30147 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30148 # ...
30149 acl_check_mail:
30150 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30151 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30152 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30153 .endd
30154
30155 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30156 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30157 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30158 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30159 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30160 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30161 checks.
30162
30163 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30164 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30165 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30166 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30167 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30168
30169
30170 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30171 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30172 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30173 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30174 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30175 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30176 rest of the ACL.
30177
30178 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30179 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30180 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30181 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30182 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30183 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30184 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30185 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30186 from getting any email through.
30187
30188 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30189 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30190 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30191 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30192 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30193 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30194 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30195 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30196 .code
30197 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30198 .endd
30199
30200
30201 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30202 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30203 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30204 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30205 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30206 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30207 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30208 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30209 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30210
30211 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30212 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30213 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30214 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30215 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30216 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30217
30218 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30219 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30220 rate.
30221
30222 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30223 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30224 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30225 required increases with larger limits.
30226
30227 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30228 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30229 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30230 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30231 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30232 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30233 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30234 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30235 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30236 as intended.
30237
30238
30239 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30240 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30241 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30242 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30243 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30244 message. For example:
30245 .code
30246 # Log all senders' rates
30247 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30248 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30249
30250 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30251 # at the decimal point.
30252 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30253 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30254 $sender_rate_limit }s
30255
30256 # Keep authenticated users under control
30257 deny authenticated = *
30258 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30259
30260 # System-wide rate limit
30261 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30262 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30263
30264 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30265 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30266 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30267 messages per $sender_rate_period
30268 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30269 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30270 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30271 .endd
30272 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30273 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30274 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30275 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30276 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30277 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30278 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30279
30280
30281
30282 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30283 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30284 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30285 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30286 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30287 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30288 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30289 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30290 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30291 .code
30292 verify = sender/callout
30293 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30294 .endd
30295 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30296 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30297 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30298 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30299 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30300 The available options are as follows:
30301
30302 .ilist
30303 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30304 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30305 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30306 .next
30307 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30308 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30309 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30310 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30311 .next
30312 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30313 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30314 .next
30315 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30316 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30317 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30318 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30319 .endlist
30320
30321 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30322 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30323 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30324 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30325 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30326 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30327 coding like this:
30328 .code
30329 warn !verify = sender
30330 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30331 .endd
30332 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30333 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30334 verification failure.
30335
30336 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30337 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30338
30339 .ilist
30340 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30341 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30342 .next
30343 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30344 .next
30345 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30346 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30347 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30348 .next
30349 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30350 .next
30351 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30352 .endlist
30353
30354 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30355 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30356
30357
30358
30359
30360 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30361 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30362 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30363 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30364 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30365 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30366 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30367 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30368 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30369 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30370 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30371 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30372 sender's domain.
30373
30374 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30375 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30376 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30377 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30378 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30379 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30380
30381 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30382 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30383 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30384 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30385 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30386
30387 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30388 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30389 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30390 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30391 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30392 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30393 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30394 supplies a host list.
30395 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30396
30397 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30398 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30399 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30400 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30401 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30402 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30403 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30404
30405 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30406 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30407 following SMTP commands are sent:
30408 .display
30409 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30410 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30411 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30412 &`QUIT`&
30413 .endd
30414 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30415 set to &"lmtp"&.
30416
30417 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30418 settings.
30419
30420 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30421 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30422 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30423 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30424 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30425 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30426
30427 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30428 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30429 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30430 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30431 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30432
30433 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30434 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30435 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30436 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30437 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30438
30439
30440
30441
30442 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30443 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30444 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30445 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30446 .code
30447 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30448 .endd
30449 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30450 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30451 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30452
30453
30454 .vlist
30455 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30456 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30457 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30458 For example:
30459 .code
30460 verify = sender/callout=5s
30461 .endd
30462 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30463 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30464 the &%connect%& parameter.
30465
30466
30467 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30468 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30469 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30470 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30471 .code
30472 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30473 .endd
30474 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30475
30476 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30477 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30478 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30479 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30480 updated in this circumstance.
30481
30482 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30483 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30484 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30485 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30486 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30487 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30488
30489
30490 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30491 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30492 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30493 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30494 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30495 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30496 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30497 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30498 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30499 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30500 .code
30501 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30502 .endd
30503 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30504
30505
30506 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30507 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30508 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30509 For example:
30510 .code
30511 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30512 .endd
30513 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30514 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30515 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30516 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30517 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30518
30519
30520 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30521 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30522 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30523 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30524
30525 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30526 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30527 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30528 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30529 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30530 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30531 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30532 made, until the cache record expires.
30533
30534 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30535 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30536 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30537 For example:
30538 .code
30539 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30540 .endd
30541 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30542 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30543 .code
30544 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30545 .endd
30546 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30547 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30548 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30549 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30550
30551
30552 .vitem &*random*&
30553 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30554 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30555 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30556 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30557 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30558 .code
30559 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30560 .endd
30561 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30562 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30563 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30564 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30565 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30566
30567 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30568 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30569 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30570 .code
30571 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30572 .endd
30573 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30574 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30575 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30576 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30577 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30578
30579 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30580 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30581 .code
30582 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30583 .endd
30584 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30585 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30586 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30587 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30588 usefulness of callout caching.
30589 .endlist
30590
30591 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30592 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30593 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30594 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30595 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30596 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30597 these circumstances.
30598
30599 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30600 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30601 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30602 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30603 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30604 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30605 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30606
30607 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30608 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30609 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30610 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30611
30612
30613
30614
30615 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30616 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30617 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30618 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30619 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30620 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30621 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30622 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30623 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30624 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30625
30626 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30627 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30628 is not available.
30629
30630 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30631 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30632 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30633
30634 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30635 commands up to and including
30636 .code
30637 MAIL FROM:<>
30638 .endd
30639 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30640 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30641 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30642 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30643 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30644 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30645 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30646
30647 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30648 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30649 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30650 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30651 will eventually be noticed.
30652
30653 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30654 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30655 behaviour will be the same.
30656
30657
30658
30659 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30660 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30661 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30662 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30663 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30664 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30665 you might see:
30666 .code
30667 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30668 250 OK
30669 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30670 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30671 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30672 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30673 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30674 550 Sender verification failed
30675 .endd
30676 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30677 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30678 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30679 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30680 example:
30681 .code
30682 verify = sender/no_details
30683 .endd
30684
30685 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30686 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30687 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30688 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30689 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30690 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30691 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30692
30693 .ilist
30694 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30695 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30696 verification also fails.
30697 .next
30698 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30699 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30700 .endlist
30701
30702 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30703 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30704 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30705 .code
30706 A.Wol: aw123
30707 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30708 .endd
30709 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30710 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30711 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30712 verification to succeed.
30713
30714 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30715 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30716 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30717 option. For example:
30718 .code
30719 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30720 .endd
30721 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30722 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30723
30724 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30725 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30726 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30727 address and a report is output for each of them.
30728
30729
30730
30731 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30732 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30733 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30734 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30735 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30736 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30737 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30738 .code
30739 verify = csa
30740 .endd
30741 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30742 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30743 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30744 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30745 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30746 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30747
30748 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30749 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30750 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30751 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30752
30753 .ilist
30754 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30755 .next
30756 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30757 .next
30758 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30759 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30760 .next
30761 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30762 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30763 .endlist
30764
30765 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30766 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30767 .code
30768 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30769 .endd
30770 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30771 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30772 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30773 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30774 meaningful to say:
30775 .code
30776 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30777 .endd
30778 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30779 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30780 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30781
30782 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30783 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30784 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30785 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30786 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30787 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30788 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30789 of legitimate HELO domains.
30790
30791 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30792 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30793 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30794 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30795 lookup such as:
30796 .code
30797 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30798 .endd
30799 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30800 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30801 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30802
30803
30804
30805
30806 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30807 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30808 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30809 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30810 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30811 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30812 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30813 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30814
30815 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30816 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30817 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30818 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30819 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30820 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30821 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30822
30823 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30824 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30825 like this:
30826 .code
30827 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30828 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30829 }{$value}}
30830 .endd
30831 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30832 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30833 use this:
30834 .code
30835 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30836 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30837 senders = :
30838 recipients = +batv_senders
30839
30840 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30841 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30842 senders = :
30843 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30844 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30845 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30846 .endd
30847 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30848 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30849 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30850 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30851 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30852
30853 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30854 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30855 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30856 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30857 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30858 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30859 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30860
30861 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30862 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30863 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30864 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30865 .code
30866 batv_redirect:
30867 driver = redirect
30868 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30869 .endd
30870 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30871 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30872 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30873 local addresses.
30874
30875 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30876 can be used:
30877 .code
30878 external_smtp_batv:
30879 driver = smtp
30880 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30881 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30882 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30883 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30884 {$value}fail}}}
30885 .endd
30886 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30887
30888
30889
30890 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30891 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30892 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30893 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30894 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30895 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30896 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30897 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30898 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30899 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30900
30901 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30902 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30903 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30904 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30905 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30906 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30907 . ///
30908 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30909 . ///
30910 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30911 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30912 system to arbitrary domains.
30913
30914
30915 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30916 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30917 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30918 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30919
30920 .ilist
30921 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30922 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30923 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30924 .next
30925 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30926 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30927 .next
30928 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30929 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30930 .endlist
30931
30932
30933 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30934 .code
30935 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30936 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30937 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30938 .endd
30939 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30940 command:
30941 .code
30942 acl_check_rcpt:
30943 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30944 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30945 .endd
30946 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30947 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30948 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30949 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30950 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30951 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30952 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30953
30954
30955
30956 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30957 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30958 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30959 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30960 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30961
30962 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30963 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30964 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30965 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30966 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30967 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30968 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30969 .ecindex IIDacl
30970
30971
30972
30973 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30974 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30975
30976 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30977 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30978 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30979 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30980 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30981 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30982 specification.
30983
30984 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30985 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30986 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30987 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30988 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30989
30990 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30991 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30992 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30993
30994 .ilist
30995 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30996 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30997 .next
30998 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30999 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31000 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31001 .next
31002 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31003 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31004 .next
31005 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31006 conditions.
31007 .next
31008 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31009 .endlist
31010
31011 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
31012 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
31013 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
31014
31015 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31016 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31017 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31018 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31019 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31020 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31021
31022 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31023 temporarily created in a file called:
31024 .display
31025 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31026 .endd
31027 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31028 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31029 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31030 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31031 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31032 .code
31033 control = no_mbox_unspool
31034 .endd
31035 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31036 same directory by default.
31037
31038
31039
31040 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31041 .cindex "virus scanning"
31042 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31043 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31044 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31045 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31046 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31047 in memory and thus are much faster.
31048
31049 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31050 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31051
31052 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31053 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31054 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31055 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31056 .display
31057 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31058 .endd
31059 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31060 .code
31061 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31062 .endd
31063 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31064 before use.
31065 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31066 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
31067
31068 .vlist
31069 .vitem &%avast%&
31070 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31071 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31072 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31073 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31074 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31075 This scanner type takes one option,
31076 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31077 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31078 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31079 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31080 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31081 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31082 For example:
31083 .code
31084 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31085 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31086 .endd
31087 If you omit the argument, the default path
31088 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31089 is used.
31090 If you use a remote host,
31091 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31092 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31093 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31094 .code
31095 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31096 FLAGS
31097 SENSITIVITY
31098 PACK
31099 .endd
31100
31101
31102 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31103 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31104 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31105 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31106 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31107 example:
31108 .code
31109 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31110 .endd
31111
31112
31113 .vitem &%clamd%&
31114 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31115 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31116 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31117 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31118 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31119
31120 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31121 a UNIX socket specification,
31122 a TCP socket specification,
31123 or a (global) option.
31124
31125 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31126 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31127 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31128 and the second a port number,
31129 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31130 These per-server options are supported:
31131 .code
31132 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31133 .endd
31134
31135 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31136 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31137
31138 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31139
31140 Examples:
31141 .code
31142 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31143 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31144 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31145 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31146 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31147 .endd
31148 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31149 &`local`&
31150 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31151 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31152 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31153 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31154 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31155 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31156
31157 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31158 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31159 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31160 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31161 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31162 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31163 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31164 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31165 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31166 .code
31167 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31168 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31169 (Connection refused)
31170 .endd
31171
31172 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31173 contributing the code for this scanner.
31174
31175 .vitem &%cmdline%&
31176 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31177 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31178 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31179 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31180
31181 .olist
31182 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31183 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31184
31185 .next
31186 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31187 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31188 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31189 the &"trigger"& expression.
31190
31191 .next
31192 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31193 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31194 &"name"& expression.
31195 .endlist olist
31196
31197 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31198 .code
31199 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31200 .endd
31201 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31202 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31203 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31204 configuration setting:
31205 .code
31206 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31207 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31208 found in file:'(.+)'
31209 .endd
31210 .vitem &%drweb%&
31211 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31212 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31213 takes one option,
31214 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31215 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31216 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31217 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31218 For example:
31219 .code
31220 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31221 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31222 .endd
31223 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31224 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31225
31226 .vitem &%f-protd%&
31227 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31228 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31229 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31230 (or port-range).
31231 For example:
31232 .code
31233 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31234 .endd
31235 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31236
31237 .vitem &%fsecure%&
31238 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31239 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31240 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31241 .code
31242 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31243 .endd
31244 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31245 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31246
31247 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31248 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31249 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31250 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31251 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31252 For example:
31253 .code
31254 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31255 .endd
31256 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31257
31258 .vitem &%mksd%&
31259 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31260 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31261 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31262 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31263 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31264 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
31265 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31266 .code
31267 av_scanner = mksd:2
31268 .endd
31269 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31270
31271 .vitem &%sock%&
31272 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31273 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31274 running on the local machine.
31275 There are four options:
31276 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31277 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31278 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31279 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31280 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31281 For example:
31282 .code
31283 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31284 .endd
31285 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31286 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31287 Both regular-expressions are required.
31288
31289 .vitem &%sophie%&
31290 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31291 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31292 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31293 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31294 client communication. For example:
31295 .code
31296 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31297 .endd
31298 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31299 the option.
31300 .endlist
31301
31302 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31303 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31304 ACL.
31305
31306 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31307 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31308 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31309 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31310 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31311 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31312 message.
31313
31314 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31315 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31316 The first element can then be one of
31317
31318 .ilist
31319 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31320 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31321 recommended usage.
31322 .next
31323 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31324 the condition fails immediately.
31325 .next
31326 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31327 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31328 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31329 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31330 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31331 .endlist
31332
31333 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31334 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31335 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31336
31337 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31338 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31339 For example:
31340 .code
31341 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31342 .endd
31343 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31344
31345 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31346 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31347 is set to record the actual address used.
31348
31349 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31350 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31351 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31352 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31353 logging data.
31354
31355 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31356 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31357 &%malware%& condition.
31358
31359 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31360 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31361
31362 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31363 .code
31364 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31365 demime = *
31366 malware = *
31367 .endd
31368 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31369 .code
31370 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31371 demime = *
31372 malware = */defer_ok
31373 .endd
31374 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31375 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31376 .code
31377 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31378 .endd
31379 in the main Exim configuration.
31380 .code
31381 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31382 set acl_m0 = sophie
31383 malware = *
31384
31385 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31386 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31387 malware = *
31388 .endd
31389
31390
31391 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31392 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31393 .cindex "spam scanning"
31394 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31395 .cindex "Rspamd"
31396 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31397 score and a report for the message.
31398 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31399
31400 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31401 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31402 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31403
31404 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31405 .code
31406 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31407 .endd
31408 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31409 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31410 nicely, however.
31411
31412 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31413 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31414 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31415 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31416 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31417 configuration as follows (example):
31418 .code
31419 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31420 .endd
31421
31422 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31423 on TCP port 11333)
31424 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31425 .code
31426 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31427 .endd
31428
31429 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31430 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31431 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31432 .code
31433 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31434 .endd
31435 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31436 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31437 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31438 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31439 .code
31440 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31441 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31442 192.168.2.12 783
31443 .endd
31444 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31445 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31446 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31447 condition defers.
31448
31449 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31450 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31451 and changeable in the usual way.
31452
31453 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31454 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31455 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31456 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31457
31458 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31459 are options.
31460 The supported options are:
31461 .code
31462 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31463 weight=<value> Selection bias
31464 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31465 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31466 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31467 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31468 .endd
31469
31470 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31471 higher values being tried first.
31472 The default priority is 1.
31473
31474 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31475 Within a priority set
31476 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31477 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31478
31479 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31480 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31481 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31482 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31483
31484 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31485 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31486
31487 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31488 The default value is two minutes.
31489
31490 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31491 a failed connect is made.
31492 The default is to not retry.
31493
31494 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31495 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31496 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31497 expansion.
31498
31499 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31500 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31501 is set to record the actual address used.
31502
31503 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31504 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31505 .code
31506 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31507 spam = joe
31508 .endd
31509 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31510 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31511 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31512 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31513 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31514 right-hand side.
31515
31516 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31517 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31518 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31519 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31520 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31521 are not set.
31522 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31523 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31524 after the first),
31525 or the use of PRDR,
31526 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31527 are needed to use this feature.
31528
31529 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31530 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31531 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31532
31533
31534 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31535 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31536 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31537 example:
31538 .code
31539 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31540 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31541 spam = nobody
31542 .endd
31543
31544 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31545 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31546 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31547 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31548
31549 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31550 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31551 variables.
31552 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31553 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31554 available for use at delivery time.
31555
31556 .vlist
31557 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31558 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31559 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31560
31561 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31562 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31563 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31564 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31565 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31566
31567 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31568 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31569 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31570 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31571 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31572 spam bar is 50 characters.
31573
31574 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31575 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31576 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31577 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31578
31579 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31580 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31581 spam score versus threshold.
31582 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31583
31584 .endlist
31585
31586 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31587 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31588 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31589
31590 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31591 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31592 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31593 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31594 spam condition, like this:
31595 .code
31596 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31597 spam = joe/defer_ok
31598 .endd
31599 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31600
31601 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31602 condition:
31603 .code
31604 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31605 warn spam = nobody:true
31606 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31607 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31608
31609 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31610 # is over threshold
31611 warn spam = nobody
31612 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31613
31614 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31615 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31616 spam = nobody:true
31617 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31618 .endd
31619
31620
31621
31622 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31623 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31624 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31625 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31626 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31627 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31628 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31629 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31630 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31631 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31632 cases.
31633
31634 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31635 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31636 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31637 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31638 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31639 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31640 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31641
31642 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31643 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31644 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31645 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31646 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31647
31648 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31649 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31650 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31651 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31652 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31653 syntax is:
31654 .display
31655 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31656 .endd
31657 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31658 the value can be:
31659
31660 .olist
31661 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31662 .next
31663 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31664 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31665 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31666 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31667 .next
31668 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31669 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31670 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31671 the full path and file name.
31672 .next
31673 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31674 filename, and the default path is then used.
31675 .endlist
31676 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31677 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31678 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31679 .code
31680 decode = $mime_filename
31681 .endd
31682 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31683 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31684 automatically unlinked.
31685
31686 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31687 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31688 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31689 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31690 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31691
31692 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31693 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31694 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31695
31696 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31697 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31698 available in the MIME ACL:
31699
31700 .vlist
31701 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31702 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31703 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31704 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31705 contains the empty string.
31706
31707 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31708 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31709 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31710 .code
31711 us-ascii
31712 gb2312 (Chinese)
31713 iso-8859-1
31714 .endd
31715 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31716 case-insensitively.
31717
31718 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31719 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31720 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31721 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31722 only used for display purposes.
31723
31724 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31725 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31726 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31727
31728 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31729 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31730 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31731
31732 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31733 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31734 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31735 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31736 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31737
31738 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31739 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31740 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31741 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31742
31743 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31744 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31745 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31746 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31747 .code
31748 text/plain
31749 text/html
31750 application/octet-stream
31751 image/jpeg
31752 audio/midi
31753 .endd
31754 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31755 empty string.
31756
31757 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31758 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31759 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31760 containing the decoded data.
31761 .endlist
31762
31763 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31764 .vlist
31765 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31766 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31767 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31768 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31769 RFC2047
31770 or RFC2231
31771 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31772 If no filename was
31773 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31774
31775 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31776 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31777 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31778 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31779
31780 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31781 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31782 follows:
31783
31784 .olist
31785 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31786
31787 .next
31788 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31789 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31790
31791 .next
31792 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31793 and the rest are attachments.
31794
31795 .next
31796 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31797 .endlist olist
31798
31799 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31800 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31801 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31802 .code
31803 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31804 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31805 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31806 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31807 .endd
31808 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31809 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31810 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31811 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31812 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31813
31814 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31815 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31816 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31817 decoding is fully recursive.
31818
31819 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31820 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31821 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31822 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31823 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31824 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31825 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31826 .endlist
31827
31828
31829
31830 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31831 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31832 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31833 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31834 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31835
31836 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31837 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31838 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31839 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31840 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31841
31842 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31843 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31844 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31845 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31846 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31847 32K characters are checked.
31848
31849 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31850 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31851 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31852 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31853 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31854 .code
31855 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31856 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31857 .endd
31858 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31859 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31860 matching regular expression.
31861 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31862 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31863
31864 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31865 CPU-intensive.
31866
31867
31868
31869
31870 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31871 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31872 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31873 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31874 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31875 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31876 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31877 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31878 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31879 use the &%demime%& condition.
31880
31881 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31882 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31883 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31884 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31885 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31886 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31887
31888 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31889 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31890 example:
31891 .code
31892 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31893 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31894 .endd
31895 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31896 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31897 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31898 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31899
31900 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31901 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31902 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31903
31904 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31905
31906 .vlist
31907 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31908 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31909 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31910 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31911 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31912 zero, no error occurred.
31913
31914 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31915 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31916 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31917 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31918 .endlist
31919
31920 .vlist
31921 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31922 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31923 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31924 extension it found.
31925 .endlist
31926
31927 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31928 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31929
31930 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31931 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31932 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31933 facility:
31934 .code
31935 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31936 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31937 demime = *
31938 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31939
31940 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31941 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31942 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31943 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31944
31945 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31946 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31947 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31948 demime = exe:doc
31949 control = freeze
31950 .endd
31951 .ecindex IIDcosca
31952
31953
31954
31955
31956 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31958
31959 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31960 "Local scan function"
31961 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31962 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31963 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31964 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31965 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31966
31967 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31968 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31969 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31970 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31971 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31972
31973 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31974 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31975 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31976 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31977
31978 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31979 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31980 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31981 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31982
31983 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31984 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31985 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31986 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31987 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31988 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31989 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31990 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31991 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31992
31993
31994
31995 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31996 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31997 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31998 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31999 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32000 directory, so you might set
32001 .code
32002 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32003 .endd
32004 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32005 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32006 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32007 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32008 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32009 _src/local_scan.c_.
32010
32011 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32012 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32013 .code
32014 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32015 .endd
32016 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32017
32018
32019
32020
32021 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32022 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32023 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32024 .code
32025 #include "local_scan.h"
32026 .endd
32027 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32028 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32029 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32030 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32031 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32032 strings and pointers to character strings:
32033 .code
32034 #define CS (char *)
32035 #define CCS (const char *)
32036 #define CSS (char **)
32037 #define US (unsigned char *)
32038 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32039 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32040 .endd
32041 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32042 .code
32043 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32044 .endd
32045 The arguments are as follows:
32046
32047 .ilist
32048 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32049 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32050 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32051
32052 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32053 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32054 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32055 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32056 case this changes in some future version.
32057 .next
32058 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32059 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32060 .endlist
32061
32062 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32063
32064 .vlist
32065 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32066 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32067 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32068 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32069 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32070 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32071
32072 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32073 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32074 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32075
32076 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32077 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32078 queued without immediate delivery.
32079
32080 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32081 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32082 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32083 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32084 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32085 used.
32086
32087 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32088 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32089 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32090 problem"& is used.
32091
32092 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32093 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32094 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32095 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32096 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32097 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32098 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32099
32100 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32101 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32102 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32103 .endlist
32104
32105 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32106 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32107 &%-oe%& command line options.
32108
32109
32110
32111 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32112 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32113 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32114 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32115 want to do this, you must have the line
32116 .code
32117 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32118 .endd
32119 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32120 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32121 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32122 to define them.
32123
32124 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32125 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32126 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32127 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32128 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32129 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32130 .code
32131 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32132 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32133
32134 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32135 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32136 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32137 };
32138
32139 int local_scan_options_count =
32140 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32141 .endd
32142 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32143 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32144 .code
32145 begin local_scan
32146 my_integer = 99
32147 my_string = some string of text...
32148 .endd
32149 The available types of option data are as follows:
32150
32151 .vlist
32152 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32153 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32154 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32155 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32156 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32157 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32158 values.)
32159
32160 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32161 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32162 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32163 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32164
32165 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32166 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32167 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32168 Exim.
32169
32170 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32171 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32172 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32173 printed with the suffix K or M.
32174
32175 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32176 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32177 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32178 always output in octal.
32179
32180 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32181 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32182 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32183
32184 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32185 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32186 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32187 .endlist
32188
32189 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32190 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32191
32192
32193
32194 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32195 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32196 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32197 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32198 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32199 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32200 C variables are as follows:
32201
32202 .vlist
32203 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32204 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32205
32206 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32207 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32208
32209 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32210 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32211 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32212 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32213
32214 .ilist
32215 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32216 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32217 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32218
32219 .next
32220 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32221 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32222 of debugging bits.
32223 .endlist ilist
32224
32225 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32226 selected, you should use code like this:
32227 .code
32228 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32229 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32230 .endd
32231 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32232 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32233 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32234
32235 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32236 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32237 discussed below.
32238
32239 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32240 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32241
32242 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32243 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32244
32245 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32246 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32247 &%-bh%& command line option.
32248
32249 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32250 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32251 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32252
32253 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32254 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32255 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32256 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32257
32258 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32259 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32260 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32261
32262 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32263 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32264
32265 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32266 The number of accepted recipients.
32267
32268 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32269 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32270 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32271 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32272 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32273 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32274 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32275 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32276 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32277 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32278 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32279 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32280
32281 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32282 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32283
32284 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32285 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32286 locally-submitted messages.
32287
32288 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32289 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32290 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32291
32292 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32293 The name of the sending host, if known.
32294
32295 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32296 The port on the sending host.
32297
32298 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32299 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32300
32301 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32302 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32303
32304 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32305 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32306 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32307 .endlist
32308
32309
32310 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32311 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32312 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32313 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32314 their type to *.
32315
32316
32317 .vlist
32318 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32319 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32320
32321 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32322 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32323 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32324 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32325 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32326 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32327 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32328
32329 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32330 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32331 internal newlines.
32332
32333 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32334 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32335 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32336 .endlist
32337
32338
32339
32340 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32341 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32342
32343 .vlist
32344 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32345 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32346
32347 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32348 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32349 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32350 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32351
32352 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32353 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32354 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32355 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32356 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32357 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32358 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32359 is NULL for all recipients.
32360 .endlist
32361
32362
32363
32364 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32365 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32366 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32367 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32368 release:
32369
32370 .vlist
32371 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32372 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32373
32374 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32375 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32376 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32377 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32378
32379 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32380 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32381 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32382 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32383 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32384
32385 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32386
32387 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32388 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32389 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32390 return value is as follows:
32391
32392 .ilist
32393 >= 0
32394
32395 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32396 ending status.
32397
32398 .next
32399 < 0 and > &--256
32400
32401 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32402 signal number.
32403
32404 .next
32405 &--256
32406
32407 The process timed out.
32408 .next
32409 &--257
32410
32411 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32412 .endlist
32413
32414 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32415 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32416 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32417 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32418 forks a subprocess that is running
32419 .code
32420 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32421 .endd
32422 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32423 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32424 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32425 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32426
32427 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32428 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32429 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32430 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32431
32432
32433 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32434 *sender_authentication)*&
32435 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32436 that it runs is:
32437 .display
32438 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32439 .endd
32440 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32441
32442
32443 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32444 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32445 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32446 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32447 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32448 .code
32449 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32450 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32451 .endd
32452
32453 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32454 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32455 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32456 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32457 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32458 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32459 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32460 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32461
32462 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32463 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32464 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32465 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32466 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32467 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32468
32469 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32470 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32471 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32472 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32473
32474 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32475 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32476 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32477 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32478 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32479 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32480 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32481 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32482 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32483 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32484 .code
32485 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32486 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32487 .endd
32488 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32489 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32490
32491
32492 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32493 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32494 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32495 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32496 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32497
32498
32499 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32500 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32501 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32502 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32503 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32504 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32505 .code
32506 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32507 .endd
32508 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32509 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32510 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32511 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32512 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32513 zero-terminated.
32514
32515 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32516 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32517 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32518 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32519 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32520 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32521 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32522 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32523
32524 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32525 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32526 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32527 .display
32528 &`OK `& match succeeded
32529 &`FAIL `& match failed
32530 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32531 .endd
32532 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32533 inability to contact a database.
32534
32535 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32536 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32537 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32538 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32539 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32540
32541 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32542 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32543 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32544 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32545 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32546
32547 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32548 uschar&~*list)*&"
32549 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32550 expected to be
32551 .code
32552 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32553 .endd
32554 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32555 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32556 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32557 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32558 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32559 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32560 failed.
32561
32562 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32563 *format,&~...)*&"
32564 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32565 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32566 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32567 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32568 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32569 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32570
32571
32572 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32573 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32574 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32575 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32576
32577 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32578 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32579 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32580 value afterwards. For example:
32581 .code
32582 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32583 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32584 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32585 .endd
32586
32587 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32588 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32589 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32590 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32591 address.
32592 .endlist
32593
32594
32595 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32596 .vlist
32597 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32598 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32599 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32600 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32601 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32602 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32603 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32604 binary string is returned with an error message.
32605
32606 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32607 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32608 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32609
32610 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32611 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32612 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32613 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32614 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32615
32616 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32617 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32618 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32619
32620 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32621 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32622 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32623 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32624 with translation.
32625
32626
32627 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32628 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32629 below.
32630
32631 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32632 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32633 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32634 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32635 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32636 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32637 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32638 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32639 is involved.
32640
32641 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32642 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32643
32644 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32645 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32646 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32647 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32648 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32649 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32650 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32651 .code
32652 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32653 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32654 .endd
32655 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32656 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32657 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32658 multiple output lines.
32659
32660 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32661 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32662 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32663 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32664 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32665 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32666 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32667 is an error.
32668
32669 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32670 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32671 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32672 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32673
32674 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32675 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32676 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32677
32678 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32679 See below.
32680
32681 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32682 See below.
32683
32684 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32685 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32686 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32687 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32688 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32689 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32690 more discussion.
32691 .endlist
32692
32693
32694
32695 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32696 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32697 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32698 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32699 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32700 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32701 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32702 terminates.
32703
32704 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32705 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32706 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32707 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32708
32709 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32710 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32711 .code
32712 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32713 .endd
32714 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32715 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32716 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32717 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32718
32719 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32720 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32721 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32722 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32723 &%store_pool%&.
32724 .ecindex IIDlosca
32725
32726
32727
32728
32729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32731
32732 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32733 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32734 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32735 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32736 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32737 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32738 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32739 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32740
32741 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32742 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32743 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32744 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32745 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32746
32747 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32748 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32749 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32750 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32751 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32752 prevent it happening on retries.
32753
32754 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32755 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32756 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32757 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32758 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32759 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32760 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32761 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32762
32763
32764 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32765 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32766 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32767 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32768 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32769 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32770 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32771 .code
32772 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32773 system_filter_user = exim
32774 .endd
32775 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32776 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32777 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32778 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32779 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32780 by the &%reply%& command.
32781
32782
32783 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32784 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32785 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32786 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32787
32788 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32789 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32790
32791
32792
32793 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32794 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32795 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32796 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32797 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32798 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32799 they cause errors.
32800
32801 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32802 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32803 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32804 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32805 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32806 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32807 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32808
32809 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32810 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32811 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32812 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32813 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32814
32815 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32816 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32817 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32818 to which users' filter files can refer.
32819
32820
32821
32822 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32823 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32824 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32825 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32826 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32827
32828
32829
32830 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32831 .cindex "freezing messages"
32832 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32833 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32834 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32835 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32836 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32837 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32838 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32839 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32840 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32841 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32842 .code
32843 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32844 .endd
32845 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32846
32847 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32848 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32849 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32850 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32851 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32852 run.
32853
32854 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32855 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32856 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32857 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32858
32859 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32860 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32861 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32862 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32863 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32864 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32865 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32866 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32867 message. For example:
32868 .code
32869 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32870 because it contains attachments that we are \
32871 not prepared to receive."
32872 .endd
32873
32874 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32875 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32876 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32877 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32878 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32879 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32880 use, for example
32881 .code
32882 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32883 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32884 .endd
32885 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32886 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32887 generated by the filter.
32888
32889 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32890 &%defer%&,
32891 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32892 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32893 as
32894 .code
32895 mail ...
32896 freeze
32897 .endd
32898 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32899 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32900 take place.
32901
32902
32903
32904 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32905 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32906 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32907 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32908 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32909 .code
32910 headers add <string>
32911 headers remove <string>
32912 .endd
32913 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32914 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32915 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32916 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32917 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32918
32919 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32920 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32921 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32922 example:
32923 .code
32924 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32925 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32926 X-header-2: ...."
32927 .endd
32928 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32929 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32930 space after input continuations is ignored.
32931
32932 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32933 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32934 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32935 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32936 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32937
32938 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32939 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32940 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32941 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32942 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32943 used for all recipients of the message.
32944
32945 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32946 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32947 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32948 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32949 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32950 until the message is actually being written (see section
32951 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32952
32953 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32954 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32955 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32956 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32957 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32958 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32959 modified more than once.
32960
32961 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32962 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32963 For example:
32964 .code
32965 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32966 headers remove "Subject"
32967 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32968 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32969 .endd
32970
32971
32972
32973 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32974 .cindex "envelope sender"
32975 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32976 .code
32977 errors_to <some address>
32978 .endd
32979 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32980 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32981 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32982 might use
32983 .code
32984 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32985 .endd
32986 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32987 address if its delivery failed.
32988
32989
32990
32991 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32992 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32993 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32994 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32995 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32996 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32997 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32998 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32999 which implements such a filter:
33000 .code
33001 central_filter:
33002 check_local_user
33003 driver = redirect
33004 domains = +local_domains
33005 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33006 no_verify
33007 allow_filter
33008 allow_freeze
33009 .endd
33010 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33011 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33012 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33013 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33014
33015 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33016 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33017 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33018 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33019 normal way.
33020 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33021 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33022 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33023
33024
33025
33026
33027
33028
33029 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33030 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33031
33032 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33033 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33034 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33035 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33036 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33037 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33038 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33039 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33040
33041 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33042 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33043 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33044 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33045 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33046
33047 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33048 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33049 loopback interface specially in any way.
33050
33051 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33052 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33053
33054
33055
33056
33057 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33058 .cindex "message" "submission"
33059 .cindex "submission mode"
33060 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33061 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33062 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33063 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33064 .code
33065 control = submission
33066 .endd
33067 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33068 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33069 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33070 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33071 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33072 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33073 .code
33074 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33075 control = submission
33076 .endd
33077 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33078 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33079 is used to separate options. For example:
33080 .code
33081 control = submission/sender_retain
33082 .endd
33083 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33084 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33085 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33086 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33087 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33088 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33089 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33090
33091 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33092 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33093 example:
33094 .code
33095 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33096 .endd
33097 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33098 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33099 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33100 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33101 .code
33102 accept authenticated = *
33103 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33104 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33105 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33106 .endd
33107 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33108 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33109 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33110 .code
33111 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33112 .endd
33113 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33114 line would be:
33115 .code
33116 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33117 .endd
33118 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33119 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33120 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33121 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33122
33123 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33124 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33125 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33126 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33127 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33128 spoof another's address.
33129
33130 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33131 .cindex "line endings"
33132 .cindex "carriage return"
33133 .cindex "linefeed"
33134 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33135 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33136 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33137 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33138 use CRLF or just CR.
33139
33140 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33141 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33142 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33143 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33144 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33145 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33146 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33147 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33148 follows:
33149
33150 .ilist
33151 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33152 .next
33153 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33154 is ignored.
33155 .next
33156 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33157 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33158 terminator.
33159 .next
33160 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33161 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33162 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33163 people trying to play silly games.
33164 .next
33165 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33166 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33167 line.
33168 .endlist
33169
33170
33171
33172
33173
33174 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33175 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33176 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33177 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33178 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33179 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33180 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33181 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33182
33183 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33184 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33185 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33186 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33187 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33188
33189 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33190 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33191 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33192 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33193 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33194 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33195 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33196 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33197
33198
33199
33200
33201 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33202 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33203 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33204 .cindex "sender" "address"
33205 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33206 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33207 .cindex "envelope sender"
33208 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33209 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33210 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33211 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33212 .code
33213 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33214 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33215 .endd
33216 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33217 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33218 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33219 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33220 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33221 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33222 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33223 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33224 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33225
33226 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33227 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33228 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33229 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33230 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33231 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33232 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33233
33234 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33235 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33236 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33237
33238 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33239 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33240 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33241 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33242
33243
33244
33245 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33246 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33247 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33248 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33249 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33250 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33251 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33252
33253 .blockquote
33254 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33255 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33256 .endblockquote
33257
33258 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33259 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33260 follows:
33261
33262 .ilist
33263 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33264 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33265 .next
33266 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33267 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33268 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33269 .next
33270 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33271 also removed.
33272 .next
33273 For a locally-submitted message,
33274 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33275 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33276 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33277 included in log lines in this case.
33278 .next
33279 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33280 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33281 .endlist
33282
33283
33284
33285
33286 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33287 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33288 includes the header line:
33289 .code
33290 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33291 .endd
33292
33293 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33294 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33295 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33296 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33297 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33298 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33299
33300
33301 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33302 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33303 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33304 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33305 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33306
33307 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33308 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33309 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33310 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33311 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33312 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33313 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33314 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33315 messages.
33316
33317
33318 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33319 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33320 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33321 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33322 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33323 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33324 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33325 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33326 messages.
33327
33328
33329 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33330 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33331 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33332 .cindex "message" "submission"
33333 .cindex "submission mode"
33334 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33335 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33336
33337 .ilist
33338 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33339 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33340 .next
33341 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33342 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33343 .olist
33344 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33345 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33346 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33347 .next
33348 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33349 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33350 .next
33351 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33352 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33353 .endlist
33354 .endlist
33355
33356 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33357
33358 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33359 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33360 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33361 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33362 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33363 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33364 &%qualify_domain%&.
33365
33366 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33367 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33368 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33369 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33370
33371
33372 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33373 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33374 .cindex "message" "submission"
33375 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33376 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33377 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33378 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33379 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33380 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33381 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33382 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33383 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33384 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33385
33386
33387 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33388 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33389 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33390 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33391 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33392
33393 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33394 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33395 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33396 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33397
33398 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33399 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33400 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33401
33402
33403 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33404 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33405 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33406 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33407 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33408 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33409 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33410 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33411 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33412 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33413 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33414
33415
33416
33417 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33418 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33419 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33420 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33421 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33422 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33423 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33424 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33425
33426
33427
33428 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33429 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33430 .cindex "message" "submission"
33431 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33432 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33433 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33434 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33435 control setting.
33436
33437 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33438 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33439 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33440 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33441 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33442 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33443 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33444 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33445 line is added to the message.
33446
33447 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33448 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33449 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33450 options true at the same time.
33451
33452 .cindex "submission mode"
33453 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33454 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33455 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33456 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33457
33458 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33459 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33460 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33461 created as follows:
33462
33463 .ilist
33464 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33465 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33466 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33467 .next
33468 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33469 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33470 .next
33471 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33472 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33473 .endlist
33474
33475 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33476 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33477 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33478 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33479
33480 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33481 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33482 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33483 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33484
33485
33486
33487 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33488 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33489 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33490 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33491 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33492 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33493 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33494 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33495 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33496
33497 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33498 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33499 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33500 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33501 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33502 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33503
33504 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33505 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33506 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33507
33508 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33509 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33510 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33511 .code
33512 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33513 X-added-second: another added header line
33514 .endd
33515 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33516
33517 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33518 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33519 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33520
33521 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33522 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33523 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33524 not part of the names. For example:
33525 .code
33526 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33527 .endd
33528
33529 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33530 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33531 Each item is separately expanded.
33532 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33533 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33534 will act as list separators.
33535
33536 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33537 items are expanded at routing time,
33538 and then associated with all addresses that are
33539 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33540 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33541 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33542
33543 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33544 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33545 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33546 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33547
33548 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33549 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33550 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33551 requirements.
33552
33553 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33554 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33555 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33556 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33557 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33558 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33559 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33560
33561 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33562 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33563 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33564 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33565
33566 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33567 the following consequences:
33568
33569 .ilist
33570 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33571 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33572 to it, at all times.
33573 .next
33574 Header lines that are added by a router's
33575 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33576 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33577 .next
33578 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33579 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33580 .next
33581 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33582 a later router or by a transport.
33583 .next
33584 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33585 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33586 .code
33587 headers_remove = subject
33588 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33589 .endd
33590 .endlist
33591
33592 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33593 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33594
33595
33596
33597
33598
33599 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33600 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33601 .cindex "constructed address"
33602 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33603 the form
33604 .display
33605 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33606 .endd
33607 For example:
33608 .code
33609 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33610 .endd
33611 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33612 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33613 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33614 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33615 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33616 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33617 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33618 there is no password file entry.
33619
33620 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33621 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33622 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33623 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33624 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33625 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33626 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33627 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33628 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33629
33630
33631
33632 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33633 .cindex "case of local parts"
33634 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33635 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33636 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33637 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33638 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33639 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33640 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33641 router option.
33642
33643 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33644 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33645 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33646 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33647 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33648 .code
33649 correct_case:
33650 driver = redirect
33651 domains = +local_domains
33652 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33653 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33654 @$domain
33655 .endd
33656 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33657 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33658 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33659 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33660 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33661
33662
33663
33664 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33665 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33666 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33667 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33668 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33669 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33670 empty components for compatibility.
33671
33672
33673
33674 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33675 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33676 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33677 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33678 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33679 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33680
33681 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33682 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33683 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33684 example, a header such as
33685 .code
33686 To: hare@teaparty
33687 .endd
33688 might get rewritten as
33689 .code
33690 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33691 .endd
33692 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33693 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33694 been routed.
33695
33696 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33697 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33698 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33699 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33700 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33701 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33702 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33703
33704
33705
33706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33707 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33708
33709 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33710 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33711 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33712 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33713 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33714 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33715 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33716
33717 .ilist
33718 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33719 .next
33720 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33721 .next
33722 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33723 .endlist
33724
33725 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33726
33727 .ilist
33728 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33729 .next
33730 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33731 &"lmtp"&);
33732 .next
33733 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33734 transport);
33735 .next
33736 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33737 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33738 .endlist
33739
33740 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33741 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33742 used to contain the envelope information.
33743
33744
33745
33746 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33747 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33748 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33749 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33750 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33751 .cindex "EHLO"
33752 .cindex "HELO"
33753 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33754 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33755 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33756 processing is the same in both cases.
33757
33758 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33759 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33760 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33761 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33762 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33763 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33764 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33765 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33766 suppressed.
33767
33768 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33769 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33770 required for the transaction.
33771
33772 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33773 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33774 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33775 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33776 is called for verification.
33777
33778 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33779 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33780 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33781
33782 .cindex "carriage return"
33783 .cindex "linefeed"
33784 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33785 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33786 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33787 line terminator.
33788
33789 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33790 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33791 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33792 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33793 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33794 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33795 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33796 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33797 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33798
33799 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33800 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33801 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33802 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33803
33804 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33805 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33806 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33807 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33808
33809 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33810 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33811 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33812 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33813 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33814 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33815 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33816 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33817 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33818 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33819
33820 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33821 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33822
33823 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33824 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33825 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33826 square bracket of the IP address.
33827
33828
33829
33830
33831 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33832 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33833 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33834 .cindex "host" "error"
33835 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33836 message errors, and recipient errors.
33837
33838 .vlist
33839 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33840 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33841 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33842
33843 .ilist
33844 Connection refused or timed out,
33845 .next
33846 Any error response code on connection,
33847 .next
33848 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33849 .next
33850 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33851 .next
33852 I/O errors at any time,
33853 .next
33854 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33855 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33856 .endlist ilist
33857
33858 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33859 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33860 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33861 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33862 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33863 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33864 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33865 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33866
33867 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33868 .cindex "message" "error"
33869 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33870 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33871 message errors are:
33872
33873 .ilist
33874 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33875 the data,
33876 .next
33877 Timeout after MAIL,
33878 .next
33879 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33880 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33881 connection at any other time.
33882 .endlist ilist
33883
33884 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33885 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33886 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33887 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33888 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33889 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33890 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33891 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33892 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33893 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33894
33895 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33896 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33897 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33898 response to MAIL.
33899
33900 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33901 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33902 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33903 recipient errors are:
33904
33905 .ilist
33906 Any error response to RCPT,
33907 .next
33908 Timeout after RCPT.
33909 .endlist
33910
33911 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33912 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33913 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33914 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33915 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33916 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33917 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33918 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33919 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33920 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33921 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33922 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33923 the retry clock is reset.
33924
33925 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33926 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33927 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33928 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33929 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33930 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33931 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33932 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33933 recipient's retry time.
33934 .endlist
33935
33936 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33937 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33938 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33939 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33940 until the next delivery attempt.
33941
33942 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33943 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33944 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33945 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33946 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33947 is created.
33948
33949 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33950 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33951 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33952 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33953 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33954 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33955 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33956
33957 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33958 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33959 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33960 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33961 then to be treated as a host error.
33962
33963 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33964 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33965 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33966 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33967 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33968
33969
33970
33971
33972 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33973 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33974 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33975 .cindex "inetd"
33976 .cindex "daemon"
33977 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33978 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33979 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33980 .code
33981 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33982 .endd
33983 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33984 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33985 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33986 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33987 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33988 stream and exits with an error code.
33989
33990 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33991 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33992 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33993 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33994
33995 .cindex "carriage return"
33996 .cindex "linefeed"
33997 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33998 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33999 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34000 line terminator.
34001 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34002 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34003 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34004
34005 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34006 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34007 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34008 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34009 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34010 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34011 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34012 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34013
34014 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34015 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34016 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34017 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34018 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34019 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34020 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34021 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34022 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34023
34024 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34025 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34026 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34027
34028 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34029 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34030 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34031 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34032 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34033
34034 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34035 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34036 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34037 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34038 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34039 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34040 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34041
34042 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34043 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34044 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34045 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34046 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34047
34048 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34049 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34050 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34051 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34052 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34053 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34054 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34055 a delivery process.
34056
34057 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34058 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34059 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34060 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34061 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34062
34063 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34064 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34065 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34066 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34067
34068 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34069 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34070 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34071
34072
34073
34074 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34075 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34076 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34077 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34078 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34079 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34080 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34081 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34082
34083
34084 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34085 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34086 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34087 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34088 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34089 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34090 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34091 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34092 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34093 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34094 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34095
34096
34097
34098 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34099 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34100 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34101 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34102 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34103 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34104 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34105 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34106
34107 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34108 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34109 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34110 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34111 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34112 counted.
34113
34114 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34115 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34116 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34117
34118 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34119 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34120 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34121 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34122 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34123
34124
34125
34126
34127 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34128 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34129 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34130 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34131
34132 .new
34133 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34134 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34135 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34136 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34137 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34138 .wen
34139 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34140 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34141 SMTP response codes.
34142
34143 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34144 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34145 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34146 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34147 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34148 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34149 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34150 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34151 RCPT failures.
34152
34153
34154
34155 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34156 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34157 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34158 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34159 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34160 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34161 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34162
34163 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34164 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34165 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34166 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34167 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34168 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34169 argument. For example,
34170 .code
34171 ETRN #brigadoon
34172 .endd
34173 runs the command
34174 .code
34175 exim -R brigadoon
34176 .endd
34177 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34178 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34179 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34180 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34181 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34182
34183 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34184 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34185 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34186 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34187 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34188 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34189 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34190 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34191
34192 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34193 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34194 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34195 whatever the form of its argument. For
34196 example:
34197 .code
34198 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34199 $sender_host_address
34200 .endd
34201 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34202 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34203 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34204 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34205 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34206 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34207 for it to change them before running the command.
34208
34209
34210
34211 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34212 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34213 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34214 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34215 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34216 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34217 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34218 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34219 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34220 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34221 runs for RCPT commands:
34222 .code
34223 accept hosts = :
34224 .endd
34225 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34226
34227
34228
34229 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34230 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34231 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34232 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34233 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34234 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34235 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34236 envelope along with the message.
34237
34238 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34239 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34240 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34241 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34242 can be used to specify it.
34243
34244 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34245 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34246 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34247 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34248 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34249
34250 .vindex "&$host$&"
34251 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34252 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34253 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34254 router:
34255 .code
34256 begin routers
34257 route_append:
34258 driver = manualroute
34259 transport = smtp_appendfile
34260 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34261
34262 begin transports
34263 smtp_appendfile:
34264 driver = appendfile
34265 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34266 batch_max = 1000
34267 use_bsmtp
34268 user = exim
34269 .endd
34270 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34271 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34272 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34273
34274
34275
34276 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34277 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34278 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34279 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34280 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34281 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34282 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34283 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34284 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34285 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34286
34287 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34288 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34289
34290 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34291 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34292 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34293 make some use of automatically, for example:
34294 .code
34295 554 Unexpected end of file
34296 Transaction started in line 10
34297 Error detected in line 14
34298 .endd
34299 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34300 file, for example:
34301 .code
34302 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34303 The error message was:
34304
34305 501 '>' missing at end of address
34306
34307 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34308 The error was detected in line 12.
34309 The SMTP command at fault was:
34310
34311 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34312
34313 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34314 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34315 .endd
34316 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34317 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34318 accepted.
34319 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34320 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34321
34322
34323
34324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34326
34327 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34328 "Customizing messages"
34329 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34330 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34331 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34332 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34333 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34334
34335 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34336 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34337 option. Exim also adds the line
34338 .code
34339 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34340 .endd
34341 to all warning and bounce messages,
34342
34343
34344 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34345 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34346 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34347 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34348 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34349 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34350 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34351
34352 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34353 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34354 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34355 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34356 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34357 item.
34358
34359 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34360 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34361 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34362 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34363 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34364 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34365 option, rounded to a whole number.
34366
34367 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34368
34369 .ilist
34370 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34371 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34372 .next
34373 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34374 failing addresses with their error messages.
34375 .next
34376 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34377 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34378 .next
34379 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34380 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34381 .endlist
34382
34383 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34384 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34385 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34386 .code
34387 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34388 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34389 {: returning message to sender}}
34390 ****
34391 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34392
34393 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34394 {that you sent }{sent by
34395
34396 <$sender_address>
34397
34398 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34399 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34400 ****
34401 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34402 ****
34403 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34404 ------
34405 ****
34406 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34407 only the first
34408 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34409 ****
34410 .endd
34411 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34412 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34413 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34414 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34415 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34416 text sections:
34417
34418 .ilist
34419 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34420 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34421 .next
34422 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34423 the delayed addresses.
34424 .next
34425 The third item then ends the message.
34426 .endlist
34427
34428 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34429 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34430 .code
34431 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34432 $warn_message_delay
34433 ****
34434 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34435
34436 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34437 {that you sent }{sent by
34438
34439 <$sender_address>
34440
34441 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34442 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34443
34444 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34445 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34446 The date of the message is: $h_date
34447
34448 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34449 ****
34450 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34451 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34452 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34453 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34454 the message will be returned to you.
34455 .endd
34456 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34457 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34458 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34459 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34460 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34461 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34462 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34463 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34464 handled them.
34465
34466
34467
34468
34469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34471
34472 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34473 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34474 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34475
34476
34477
34478 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34479 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34480 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34481 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34482 routing explicitly:
34483 .code
34484 send_to_smart_host:
34485 driver = manualroute
34486 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34487 transport = remote_smtp
34488 .endd
34489 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34490 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34491 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34492 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34493 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34494
34495
34496
34497
34498 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34499 .cindex "mailing lists"
34500 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34501 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34502 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34503
34504 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34505 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34506 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34507 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34508 .code
34509 lists:
34510 driver = redirect
34511 domains = lists.example
34512 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34513 forbid_pipe
34514 forbid_file
34515 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34516 no_more
34517 .endd
34518 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34519 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34520 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34521 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34522
34523 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34524 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34525 a mailing list.
34526
34527 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34528 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34529 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34530 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34531 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34532
34533 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34534 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34535 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34536 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34537 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34538 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34539 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34540 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34541 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34542
34543
34544
34545 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34546 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34547 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34548 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34549 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34550 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34551 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34552
34553 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34554 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34555 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34556 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34557 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34558
34559
34560
34561 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34562 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34563 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34564 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34565 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34566 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34567 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34568 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34569 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34570 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34571
34572 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34573 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34574 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34575 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34576 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34577 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34578 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34579 pre-existing messages.
34580
34581 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34582 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34583 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34584 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34585 one level of expansion anyway.
34586
34587
34588
34589 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34590 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34591 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34592 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34593 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34594 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34595
34596 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34597 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34598 .code
34599 lists_request:
34600 driver = redirect
34601 domains = lists.example
34602 local_part_suffix = -request
34603 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34604 no_more
34605
34606 lists_post:
34607 driver = redirect
34608 domains = lists.example
34609 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34610 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34611 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34612 forbid_pipe
34613 forbid_file
34614 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34615 no_more
34616
34617 lists_closed:
34618 driver = redirect
34619 domains = lists.example
34620 allow_fail
34621 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34622 .endd
34623 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34624 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34625 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34626 mailing list.
34627
34628 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34629 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34630 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34631 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34632 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34633 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34634 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34635 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34636 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34637
34638 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34639 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34640 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34641
34642
34643
34644
34645 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34646 .cindex "VERP"
34647 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34648 .cindex "envelope sender"
34649 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34650 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34651 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34652 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34653 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34654 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34655
34656 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34657 .oindex &%return_path%&
34658 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34659 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34660 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34661 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34662 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34663 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34664 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34665 .code
34666 verp_smtp:
34667 driver = smtp
34668 max_rcpt = 1
34669 return_path = \
34670 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34671 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34672 .endd
34673 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34674 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34675 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34676 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34677 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34678 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34679 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34680 rewritten as
34681 .code
34682 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34683 .endd
34684 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34685 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34686 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34687 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34688 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34689 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34690
34691 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34692 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34693 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34694 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34695 .code
34696 dnslookup:
34697 driver = dnslookup
34698 domains = ! +local_domains
34699 transport = \
34700 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34701 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34702 no_more
34703 .endd
34704 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34705 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34706 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34707 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34708 address.
34709
34710 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34711 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34712 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34713 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34714 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34715 .code
34716 verp_dnslookup:
34717 driver = dnslookup
34718 domains = ! +local_domains
34719 transport = remote_smtp
34720 errors_to = \
34721 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34722 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34723 no_more
34724 .endd
34725 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34726 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34727 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34728 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34729 them.
34730
34731 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34732 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34733 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34734 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34735 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34736 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34737 used).
34738
34739
34740
34741
34742
34743
34744 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34745 .cindex "virtual domains"
34746 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34747 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34748 meanings:
34749
34750 .ilist
34751 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34752 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34753 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34754 .next
34755 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34756 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34757 have login accounts on that host.
34758 .endlist
34759
34760 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34761 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34762 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34763 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34764 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34765 to a router of this form:
34766 .code
34767 virtual:
34768 driver = redirect
34769 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34770 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34771 no_more
34772 .endd
34773 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34774 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34775 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34776 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34777 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34778 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34779
34780 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34781 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34782 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34783 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34784
34785 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34786 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34787 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34788 .code
34789 my_domains:
34790 driver = accept
34791 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34792 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34793 transport = my_mailboxes
34794 .endd
34795 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34796 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34797 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34798 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34799 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34800 follows:
34801 .code
34802 my_mailboxes:
34803 driver = appendfile
34804 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34805 user = mail
34806 .endd
34807 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34808 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34809
34810 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34811 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34812 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34813 information about the domains.
34814
34815
34816
34817 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34818 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34819 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34820 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34821 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34822 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34823 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34824 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34825 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34826 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34827 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34828 example, consider this router:
34829 .code
34830 userforward:
34831 driver = redirect
34832 check_local_user
34833 file = $home/.forward
34834 local_part_suffix = -*
34835 local_part_suffix_optional
34836 allow_filter
34837 .endd
34838 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34839 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34840 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34841 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34842 .code
34843 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34844 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34845 endif
34846 .endd
34847 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34848 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34849 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34850 control over which suffixes are valid.
34851
34852 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34853 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34854 another MTA:
34855 .code
34856 userforward:
34857 driver = redirect
34858 check_local_user
34859 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34860 local_part_suffix = -*
34861 local_part_suffix_optional
34862 allow_filter
34863 .endd
34864 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34865 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34866 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34867 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34868 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34869
34870
34871
34872 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34873 .cindex "vacation processing"
34874 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34875 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34876 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34877 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34878 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34879
34880 .ilist
34881 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34882 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34883 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34884 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34885 .code
34886 spqr, vacation-spqr
34887 .endd
34888 .next
34889 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34890 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34891 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34892 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34893 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34894 message.
34895 .endlist
34896
34897 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34898 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34899
34900
34901
34902 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34903 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34904 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34905 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34906 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34907 each day's messages.
34908
34909 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34910 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34911 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34912 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34913
34914
34915
34916 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34917 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34918 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34919 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34920 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34921 permanently connected.
34922
34923 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34924 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34925 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34926
34927
34928 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34929 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34930 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34931 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34932 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34933 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34934 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34935 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34936
34937 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34938 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34939 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34940 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34941 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34942 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34943 if required.
34944
34945 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34946 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34947 intermittent host. For example:
34948 .code
34949 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34950 .endd
34951 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34952 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34953 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34954 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34955 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34956 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34957 immediately.
34958
34959 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34960 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34961 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34962 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34963 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34964 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34965 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34966
34967
34968
34969 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34970 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34971 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34972 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34973 delivered immediately.
34974
34975 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34976 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34977 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34978 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34979 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34980 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34981 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34982 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34983 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34984 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34985 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34986 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34987 single SMTP connection.
34988
34989
34990
34991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34992 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34993
34994 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34995 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34996 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34997 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34998 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34999 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35000 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35001 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35002 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35003 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35004 messages this way.
35005
35006 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35007 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35008 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35009 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35010 email is not desirable.
35011
35012 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35013 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35014 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35015 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35016 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35017 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35018 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35019
35020 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35021 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35022 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35023 before sending a message to the smart host.
35024
35025 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35026 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35027 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35028
35029 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35030 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35031 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35032 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35033 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35034 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35035 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35036
35037 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35038 following ways:
35039
35040 .ilist
35041 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35042 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35043 .next
35044 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35045 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35046 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35047 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35048 successful, a zero return code is given.
35049 .next
35050 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35051 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35052 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35053 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35054 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35055 are.
35056 .next
35057 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35058 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35059 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35060 .next
35061 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35062 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35063 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35064 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35065 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35066 .next
35067 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35068 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35069 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35070 .next
35071 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35072 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35073 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35074 are ever generated.
35075 .next
35076 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35077 .next
35078 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35079 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35080 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35081 .endlist
35082
35083 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35084 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35085 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35086 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35087 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35088 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35089
35090
35091
35092
35093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35095
35096 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35097 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35098 .cindex "log" "types of"
35099 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35100 and the panic log:
35101
35102 .ilist
35103 .cindex "main log"
35104 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35105 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35106 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35107 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35108 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35109 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35110 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35111 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35112 .next
35113 .cindex "reject log"
35114 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35115 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35116 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35117 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35118 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35119 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35120 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35121 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35122 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35123 false.
35124 .next
35125 .cindex "panic log"
35126 .cindex "system log"
35127 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35128 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35129 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35130 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35131 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35132 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35133 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35134 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35135 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35136 .endlist
35137
35138 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35139 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35140 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35141 .code
35142 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35143 by QUIT
35144 .endd
35145 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35146 ways of changing this:
35147
35148 .ilist
35149 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35150 you set
35151 .code
35152 timezone = UTC
35153 .endd
35154 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35155 .next
35156 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35157 example:
35158 .code
35159 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35160 .endd
35161 .endlist
35162
35163 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35164 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35165 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35166 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35167 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35168 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35169
35170
35171
35172
35173 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35174 .cindex "log" "destination"
35175 .cindex "log" "to file"
35176 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35177 .cindex "syslog"
35178 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35179 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35180 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35181 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35182 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35183 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35184 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35185
35186 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35187 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35188 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35189 references to the host name:
35190 .code
35191 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35192 .endd
35193 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35194 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35195 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35196 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35197 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35198 log at all.
35199
35200 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35201 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35202 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35203 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35204 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35205 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35206 implying the use of a default path.
35207
35208 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35209 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35210 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35211 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35212 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35213 equivalent to the setting:
35214 .code
35215 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35216 .endd
35217 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35218 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35219 that is where the logs are written.
35220
35221 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35222 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35223
35224 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35225 .display
35226 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35227 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35228 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35229 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35230 .endd
35231 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35232 error is logged.
35233
35234
35235
35236 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35237 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35238 .cindex "cycling logs"
35239 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35240 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35241 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35242 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35243 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35244 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35245 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35246
35247 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35248 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35249 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35250 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35251 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35252 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35253 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35254 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35255 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35256 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35257 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35258 renamed.
35259
35260
35261
35262 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35263 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35264 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35265 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35266 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35267 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35268 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35269 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35270 .code
35271 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35272 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35273 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35274 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35275 .endd
35276 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35277 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35278 .code
35279 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35280 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35281 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35282 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35283 .endd
35284 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35285 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35286 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35287 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35288
35289 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35290 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35291 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35292 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35293 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35294 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35295 log names:
35296 .code
35297 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35298 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35299 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35300 /var/log/exim/panic
35301 .endd
35302
35303
35304 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35305 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35306 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35307 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35308 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35309 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35310 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35311 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35312 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35313 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35314 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35315 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35316 the time and host name to each line.
35317 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35318
35319 .ilist
35320 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35321 .next
35322 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35323 .next
35324 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35325 .endlist
35326
35327 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35328 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35329 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35330 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35331
35332 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35333 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35334 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35335 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35336 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35337 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35338 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35339 RFC 3164, you should set
35340 .code
35341 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35342 .endd
35343 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35344 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35345
35346 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35347 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35348 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35349 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35350 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35351 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35352 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35353 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35354 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35355 .code
35356 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35357 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35358 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35359 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35360 [5/5] mple>)
35361 .endd
35362 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35363 (LOG_NOTICE):
35364 .code
35365 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35366 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35367 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35368 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35369 [5\18] .example>)
35370 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35371 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35372 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35373 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35374 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35375 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35376 [12\18] F From: <>
35377 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35378 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35379 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35380 [16\18] le>
35381 [17\18] B Bcc:
35382 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35383 .endd
35384 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35385 without modification.
35386
35387 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35388 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35389 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35390 where it is.
35391
35392
35393
35394 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35395 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35396 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35397 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35398 timestamp. The flags are:
35399 .display
35400 &`<=`& message arrival
35401 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35402 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35403 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35404 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35405 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35406 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35407 .endd
35408
35409
35410 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35411 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35412 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35413 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35414 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35415 .code
35416 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35417 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35418 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35419 .endd
35420 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35421 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35422 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35423 .code
35424 R=<message id>
35425 .endd
35426 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35427
35428 .cindex "HELO"
35429 .cindex "EHLO"
35430 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35431 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35432 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35433 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35434 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35435 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35436 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35437 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35438 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35439 name in parentheses.
35440
35441 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35442 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35443 the log containing text like these examples:
35444 .code
35445 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35446 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35447 .endd
35448 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35449 on.
35450
35451 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35452 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35453 of Exim.
35454
35455 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35456 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35457 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35458 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35459 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35460 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35461 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35462 suite that was used.
35463
35464 .cindex log protocol
35465 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35466 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35467 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35468 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35469 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35470 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35471 authenticator name.
35472
35473 .cindex "size" "of message"
35474 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35475 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35476 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35477 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35478 other).
35479
35480 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35481 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35482
35483
35484
35485 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35486 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35487 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35488 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35489 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35490 to fit it on the page:
35491 .code
35492 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35493 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35494 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35495 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35496 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35497 .endd
35498 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35499 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35500 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35501 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35502 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35503
35504 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35505 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35506 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35507 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35508
35509 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35510 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35511 .display
35512 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35513 .endd
35514 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35515 parentheses afterwards.
35516
35517 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35518 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35519 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35520 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35521 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35522 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35523
35524 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35525 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35526 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35527 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35528 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35529
35530 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35531 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35532
35533 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35534 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35535
35536
35537 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35538 .cindex "discarded messages"
35539 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35540 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35541 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35542 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35543 .code
35544 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35545 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35546 .endd
35547 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35548 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35549 .code
35550 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35551 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35552 .endd
35553
35554
35555 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35556 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35557 .code
35558 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35559 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35560 .endd
35561 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35562 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35563 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35564 .code
35565 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35566 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35567 .endd
35568 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35569 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35570 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35571
35572
35573
35574 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35575 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35576 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35577 following form is logged:
35578 .code
35579 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35580 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35581 .endd
35582 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35583 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35584 .code
35585 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35586 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35587 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35588 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35589 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35590 .endd
35591 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35592 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35593 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35594 flagged with &`**`&.
35595
35596
35597
35598 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35599 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35600 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35601 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35602 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35603
35604
35605
35606 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35607 A line of the form
35608 .code
35609 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35610 .endd
35611 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35612 at the end of its processing.
35613
35614
35615
35616
35617 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35618 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35619 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35620 the following table:
35621 .display
35622 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35623 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35624 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35625 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35626 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35627 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35628 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35629 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35630 &`H `& host name and IP address
35631 &`I `& local interface used
35632 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35633 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35634 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35635 &`PRX `& on &'<='& and&`=>`& lines: proxy address
35636 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35637 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35638 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35639 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35640 &`S `& size of message in bytes
35641 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35642 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35643 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35644 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35645 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35646 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35647 .endd
35648
35649
35650 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35651 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35652 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35653
35654 .ilist
35655 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35656 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35657 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35658 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35659 during the first delivery attempt.
35660 .next
35661 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35662 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35663 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35664 .next
35665 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35666 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35667 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35668 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35669 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35670 doing.
35671 .next
35672 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35673 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35674 message:
35675 .olist
35676 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35677 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35678 .next
35679 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35680 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35681 .next
35682 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35683 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35684 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35685 .code
35686 errors_to = <>
35687 .endd
35688 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35689 .endlist olist
35690 .endlist ilist
35691
35692
35693
35694
35695
35696 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35697 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35698 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35699 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35700 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35701 example:
35702 .code
35703 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35704 .endd
35705 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35706 selection marked by asterisks:
35707 .display
35708 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35709 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35710 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35711 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35712 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35713 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35714 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35715 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35716 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35717 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35718 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35719 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35720 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35721 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35722 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35723 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35724 .new
35725 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35726 .wen
35727 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35728 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35729 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35730 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35731 &` pid `& Exim process id
35732 .new
35733 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
35734 .wen
35735 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35736 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35737 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35738 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35739 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35740 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35741 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35742 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35743 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35744 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35745 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35746 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35747 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35748 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35749 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35750 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35751 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35752 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35753 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35754 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35755 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35756 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35757
35758 &` all `& all of the above
35759 .endd
35760 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35761 section &<<SECID99>>&
35762
35763 More details on each of these items follows:
35764
35765 .ilist
35766 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35767 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35768 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35769 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35770 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35771 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35772 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35773 .next
35774 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35775 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35776 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35777 this log selector is set.
35778 .next
35779 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35780 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35781 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35782 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35783 such users cannot access the log).
35784 .next
35785 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35786 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35787 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35788 parentheses between them.
35789 .next
35790 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35791 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35792 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35793 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35794 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35795 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35796 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35797 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35798 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35799 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35800 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35801 between the caller and Exim.
35802 .next
35803 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35804 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35805 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35806 .next
35807 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35808 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35809 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35810 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35811 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35812 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35813 .next
35814 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35815 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35816 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35817 .next
35818 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35819 .cindex "size" "of message"
35820 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35821 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35822 .next
35823 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35824 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35825 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35826 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35827 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35828 .next
35829 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35830 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35831 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35832 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35833 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35834 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35835 .next
35836 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35837 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35838 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35839 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35840 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35841 .next
35842 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35843 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35844 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35845 client's ident port times out.
35846 .next
35847 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35848 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35849 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35850 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35851 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35852 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35853 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35854 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35855 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35856 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35857 .new
35858 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35859 .wen
35860 .next
35861 .new
35862 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
35863 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
35864 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
35865 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
35866 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
35867 on a proxied connection
35868 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection..
35869 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
35870 .wen
35871 .next
35872 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35873 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35874 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35875 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35876 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35877 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35878 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35879 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35880 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35881 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35882 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35883 .next
35884 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35885 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35886 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35887 .next
35888 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35889 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35890 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35891 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35892 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35893 .new
35894 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35895 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35896 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35897 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35898 .wen
35899 .next
35900 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35901 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35902 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35903 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35904 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35905 .new
35906 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35907 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35908 .wen
35909 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35910 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35911 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35912 .next
35913 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35914 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35915 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35916 immediately after the time and date.
35917 .next
35918 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35919 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35920 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35921 .next
35922 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35923 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35924 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35925 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35926 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35927 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35928 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35929 message has been successfully received.
35930 .next
35931 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35932 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35933 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35934 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35935 .next
35936 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35937 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35938 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35939 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35940 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35941 has taken place.
35942 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35943 in the list.
35944 .next
35945 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35946 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35947 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35948 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35949 .next
35950 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35951 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35952 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35953 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35954 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35955 .next
35956 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35957 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35958 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35959 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35960 attempt.
35961 .next
35962 .cindex "log" "return path"
35963 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35964 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35965 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35966 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35967 .next
35968 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35969 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35970 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35971 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35972 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35973 .next
35974 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35975 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35976 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35977 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35978 detail is lost.
35979 .next
35980 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35981 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35982 it is too big.
35983 .next
35984 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35985 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35986 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35987 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35988 it.
35989 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35990 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35991 .next
35992 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35993 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35994 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35995 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35996 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35997 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35998 response.
35999 .next
36000 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36001 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36002 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36003 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36004 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36005 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36006 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36007 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36008 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36009 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36010
36011 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36012 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36013 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36014 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36015 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36016 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36017 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36018 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36019 .next
36020 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36021 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36022 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36023 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36024 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36025 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36026 .next
36027 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36028 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36029 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36030 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36031 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36032 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36033 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36034 already have their own log lines.
36035
36036 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36037 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36038 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36039 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36040 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36041 the same logging options.
36042
36043 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36044 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36045 .code
36046 C=EHLO,QUIT
36047 .endd
36048 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36049 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36050 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36051 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36052 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36053 .next
36054 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36055 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36056 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36057 was accepted or used.
36058 .next
36059 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36060 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36061 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36062 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36063 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36064 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36065 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36066 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36067 .next
36068 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36069 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36070 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36071 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36072 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36073 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36074 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36075 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36076 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36077 .next
36078 .cindex "log" "subject"
36079 .cindex "subject, logging"
36080 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36081 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36082 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36083 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36084 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36085 .next
36086 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36087 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36088 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36089 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36090 .next
36091 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36092 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36093 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36094 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36095 .next
36096 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36097 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36098 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36099 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36100 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36101 .next
36102 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36103 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36104 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36105 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36106 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36107 .next
36108 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36109 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36110 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36111 .endlist
36112
36113
36114 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36115 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36116 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36117 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36118 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36119 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36120 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36121 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36122 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36123 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36124 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36125 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36126 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36127
36128 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36129 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36130 &%message_logs%& option false.
36131 .ecindex IIDloggen
36132
36133
36134
36135
36136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36138
36139 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36140 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36141 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36142 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36143 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36144
36145 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36146 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36147 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36148 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36149 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36150 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36151 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36152 various criteria"
36153 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36154 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36155 "extract statistics from the log"
36156 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36157 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36158 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36159 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36160 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36161 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36162 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36163 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36164 .endtable
36165
36166 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36167 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36168 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36169
36170
36171
36172
36173 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36174 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36175 .cindex "process, querying"
36176 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
36177 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36178 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36179 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36180 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36181 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36182 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36183 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36184 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36185
36186 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36187 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36188 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36189
36190
36191 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36192 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36193 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36194 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36195 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36196 options:
36197 .display
36198 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36199 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36200 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36201 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36202 .endd
36203 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36204 .code
36205 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36206 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36207 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36208 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36209 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36210 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36211 .endd
36212 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36213 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36214
36215
36216
36217 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36218 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36219 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36220 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36221 .code
36222 exim -bpu
36223 .endd
36224 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36225 .code
36226 exim -bp
36227 .endd
36228 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36229 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36230
36231 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36232 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36233
36234 .vlist
36235 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36236 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36237 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36238 .code
36239 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
36240 .endd
36241 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36242 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36243 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36244
36245 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36246 Match against the size field.
36247
36248 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36249 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36250
36251 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36252 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36253
36254 .vitem &*-z*&
36255 Match only frozen messages.
36256
36257 .vitem &*-x*&
36258 Match only non-frozen messages.
36259 .endlist
36260
36261 The following options control the format of the output:
36262
36263 .vlist
36264 .vitem &*-c*&
36265 Display only the count of matching messages.
36266
36267 .vitem &*-l*&
36268 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36269 the default.
36270
36271 .vitem &*-i*&
36272 Display message ids only.
36273
36274 .vitem &*-b*&
36275 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36276
36277 .vitem &*-R*&
36278 Display messages in reverse order.
36279
36280 .vitem &*-a*&
36281 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36282 .endlist
36283
36284 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36285
36286
36287
36288 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36289 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36290 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36291 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36292 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36293 running a command such as
36294 .code
36295 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36296 .endd
36297 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36298 it, as in the following example:
36299 .code
36300 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36301 .endd
36302 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36303 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36304 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36305 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36306
36307 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36308 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36309 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36310 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36311 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36312 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36313 sender.
36314
36315 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36316 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36317 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36318 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36319 level"& addresses).
36320
36321
36322
36323
36324 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36325 "SECTextspeinf"
36326 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36327 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36328 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36329 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36330 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36331 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36332 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36333 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36334 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36335 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36336 .display
36337 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36338 .endd
36339 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36340
36341 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36342 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36343 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36344
36345 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36346 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36347 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36348 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36349 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36350
36351 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36352 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36353 regular expression.
36354
36355 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36356 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36357
36358 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36359 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36360 normally.
36361
36362 Example of &%-M%&:
36363 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36364 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36365 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36366 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36367 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36368 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36369 search term.
36370
36371 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36372 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36373 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36374 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36375 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36376
36377
36378 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36379 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36380 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36381 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36382 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36383 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36384 the &%--help%& option.
36385
36386
36387 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36388 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36389 .cindex "cycling logs"
36390 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36391 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36392 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36393 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36394 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36395 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36396 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36397 .ilist
36398 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36399 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36400 .next
36401 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36402 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36403 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36404 configuration.
36405 .endlist
36406
36407 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36408 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36409 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36410 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36411 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36412 logs are handled similarly.
36413
36414 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36415 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36416 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36417 any existing log files.
36418
36419 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36420 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36421 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36422 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36423 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36424 .code
36425 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36426 .endd
36427 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36428 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36429
36430
36431
36432 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36433 .cindex "statistics"
36434 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36435 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36436 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36437 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36438 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36439
36440 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36441 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36442 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36443 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36444 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36445 .code
36446 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36447 .endd
36448 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36449 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36450 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36451 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36452 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36453 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36454 also produced per user.
36455
36456 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36457 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36458 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36459 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36460 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36461
36462 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36463 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36464 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36465 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36466 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36467 an entirely separate message.
36468
36469 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36470 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36471 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36472 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36473 least one address that failed.
36474
36475 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36476 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36477 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36478 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36479 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36480 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36481 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36482
36483 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36484 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36485 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36486
36487 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36488 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36489 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36490 .code
36491 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36492 .endd
36493
36494 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36495 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36496 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36497 .cindex "checking access"
36498 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36499 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36500 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36501 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36502 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36503 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36504
36505 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36506 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36507 .code
36508 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36509 .endd
36510 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36511 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36512 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36513 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36514 .code
36515 Rejected:
36516 550 Relay not permitted
36517 .endd
36518 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36519 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36520 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36521 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36522 you can use:
36523 .code
36524 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36525 -f himself@there.example
36526 .endd
36527 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36528 mandatory arguments.
36529
36530 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36531 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36532 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36533
36534
36535
36536 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36537 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36538 .cindex "building DBM files"
36539 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36540 .cindex "lower casing"
36541 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36542 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36543 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36544 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36545 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36546 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36547
36548 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36549 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36550 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36551 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36552 files.
36553
36554 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36555 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36556 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36557 well.
36558
36559 .cindex "USE_DB"
36560 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36561 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36562 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36563 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36564 .code
36565 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36566 .endd
36567 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36568 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36569
36570 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36571 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36572 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36573 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36574 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36575 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36576
36577 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36578 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36579 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36580 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36581 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36582 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36583 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36584 return code is 2.
36585
36586
36587
36588
36589 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36590 .cindex "retry" "times"
36591 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36592 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36593 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36594 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36595 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36596 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36597 output. For example:
36598 .code
36599 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36600 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36601 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36602 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36603 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36604 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36605 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36606 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36607 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36608 past final cutoff time
36609 .endd
36610 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36611 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36612 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36613 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36614 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36615 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36616 run very often.
36617
36618 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36619 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36620 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36621 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36622 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36623 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36624
36625
36626
36627 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36628 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36629 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36630 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36631 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36632 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36633 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36634
36635 .ilist
36636 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36637 .next
36638 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36639 for remote hosts
36640 .next
36641 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36642 .next
36643 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36644 .next
36645 &'misc'&: other hints data
36646 .endlist
36647
36648 The &'misc'& database is used for
36649
36650 .ilist
36651 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36652 .next
36653 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36654 &(smtp)& transport)
36655 .next
36656 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36657 in a transport)
36658 .endlist
36659
36660
36661
36662 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36663 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36664 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36665 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36666 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36667 .code
36668 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36669 .endd
36670 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36671 .code
36672 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36673 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36674 .endd
36675 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36676 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36677 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36678 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36679 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36680 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36681 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36682 and a textual description of the error.
36683
36684 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36685 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36686 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36687 exceeded.
36688
36689 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36690 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36691 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36692 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36693 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36694 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36695 cross-references.
36696
36697
36698
36699 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36700 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36701 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36702 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36703 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36704 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36705 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36706 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36707 updated sufficiently often.
36708
36709 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36710 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36711 the retry database:
36712 .code
36713 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36714 .endd
36715 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36716 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36717 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36718 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36719 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36720 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36721 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36722 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36723 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36724 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36725 whenever it removes information from the database.
36726
36727 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36728 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36729 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36730 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36731 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36732
36733 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36734 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36735 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36736 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36737 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36738 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36739 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36740 tidied.
36741
36742 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36743 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36744
36745
36746
36747
36748 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36749 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36750 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36751 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36752 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36753 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36754 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36755 displayed.
36756
36757 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36758 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36759 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36760 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36761 by new data, for example:
36762 .code
36763 > 4 951102:1000
36764 .endd
36765 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36766 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36767 used as optional separators.
36768
36769
36770
36771
36772 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36773 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36774 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36775 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36776 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36777 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36778 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36779 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36780 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36781 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36782 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36783 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36784 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36785
36786 .vlist
36787 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36788 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36789
36790 .vitem &%-flock%&
36791 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36792 supports it.
36793
36794 .vitem &%-interval%&
36795 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36796 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36797
36798 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36799 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36800
36801 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36802 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36803
36804 .vitem &%-q%&
36805 Suppress verification output.
36806
36807 .vitem &%-retries%&
36808 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36809 the lock (default 10).
36810
36811 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36812 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36813 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36814 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36815 subsequently sees.
36816
36817 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36818 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36819 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36820 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36821
36822 .vitem &%-v%&
36823 Generate verbose output.
36824 .endlist
36825
36826 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36827 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36828 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36829 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36830 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36831 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36832 more than 30 minutes old.
36833
36834 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36835 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36836 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36837 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36838 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36839 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36840
36841 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36842 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36843 suppresses all output except error messages.
36844
36845 A command such as
36846 .code
36847 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36848 .endd
36849 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36850 .display
36851 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36852 <&'some commands'&>
36853 &`End`&
36854 .endd
36855 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36856 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36857 such as
36858 .code
36859 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36860 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36861 .endd
36862 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36863 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36864 .ecindex IIDutils
36865
36866
36867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36868 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36869
36870 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36871 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36872 .cindex "X-windows"
36873 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36874 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36875 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36876 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36877 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36878 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36879 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36880 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36881
36882
36883
36884 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36885 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36886 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36887 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36888 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36889 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36890 parameters are for.
36891
36892 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36893 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36894 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36895 .code
36896 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36897 .endd
36898 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36899 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36900 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36901 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36902 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36903
36904 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36905 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36906 .code
36907 Eximon*background: gray94
36908 .endd
36909 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36910 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36911 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36912 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36913 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36914 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36915 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36916 .code
36917 xrdb -merge <<End
36918 Eximon*highlight: gray
36919 End
36920 .endd
36921 .cindex "admin user"
36922 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36923 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36924
36925 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36926 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36927 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36928 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36929 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36930
36931 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36932 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36933 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36934 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36935 different parts of the display.
36936
36937
36938
36939
36940 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36941 .cindex "stripchart"
36942 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36943 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36944 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36945 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36946 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36947 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36948 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36949 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36950 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36951
36952 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36953 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36954 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36955 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36956
36957 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36958 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36959 to a single partition.
36960
36961 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36962 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36963 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36964 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36965 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36966 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36967 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36968
36969
36970
36971
36972 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36973 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36974 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36975 .cindex "window size"
36976 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36977 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36978 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36979 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36980 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36981 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36982
36983 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36984 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36985 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36986 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36987
36988 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36989 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36990 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36991 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36992 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36993 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36994
36995 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36996 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36997 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36998
36999
37000
37001 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37002 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37003 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37004 the main log is maintained.
37005 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37006 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37007 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37008 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37009 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37010
37011 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37012 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37013 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37014 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37015 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37016 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37017 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37018 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37019 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37020 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37021 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37022
37023 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37024 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37025 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37026 It cannot go further back up the log.
37027
37028 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37029 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37030 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37031 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37032 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37033 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37034
37035 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37036 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37037 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37038 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37039 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37040 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37041
37042 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37043 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37044 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37045 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37046 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37047 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37048 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37049 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37050 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37051 window.
37052
37053
37054
37055 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37056 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37057 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37058 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37059 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37060 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37061 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37062 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37063 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37064 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37065
37066 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37067 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37068 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37069 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37070 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37071 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37072 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37073
37074 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37075 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37076 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37077 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37078 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37079 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37080 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37081
37082 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37083 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37084 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37085 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37086
37087 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37088 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37089 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37090 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37091 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37092 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37093 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37094 not shown.
37095
37096 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37097 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37098
37099 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37100 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37101 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37102 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37103 display is updated.
37104
37105
37106
37107 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37108 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37109 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37110 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37111 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37112 any selected text.
37113
37114 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37115 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37116 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37117 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37118 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37119 .code
37120 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37121 .endd
37122 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37123 follows:
37124
37125 .ilist
37126 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37127 in a new text window.
37128 .next
37129 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37130 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37131 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37132 .next
37133 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37134 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37135 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37136 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37137 .next
37138 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37139 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37140 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37141 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37142 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37143 .next
37144 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37145 that the message be frozen.
37146 .next
37147 .cindex "thawing messages"
37148 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37149 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37150 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37151 that the message be thawed.
37152 .next
37153 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37154 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37155 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37156 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37157 .next
37158 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37159 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37160 message.
37161 .next
37162 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37163 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37164 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37165 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37166 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37167 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37168 which case no action is taken.
37169 .next
37170 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37171 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37172 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37173 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37174 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37175 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37176 case no action is taken.
37177 .next
37178 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37179 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37180 .next
37181 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37182 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37183 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37184 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37185 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37186 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37187 the address is qualified with that domain.
37188 .endlist
37189
37190 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37191 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37192 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37193 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37194 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37195 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37196 if no output is generated.
37197
37198 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37199 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37200 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37201 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37202
37203 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37204 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37205 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37206 .ecindex IIDeximon
37207
37208
37209
37210
37211
37212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37214
37215 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37216 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37217 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37218 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37219
37220 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37221 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37222 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37223 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37224 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37225 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37226
37227 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37228 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37229 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37230 as soon as possible.
37231
37232
37233 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37234 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37235 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37236 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37237 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37238 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37239
37240 .ilist
37241 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37242 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37243 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37244 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37245 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37246 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37247
37248 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37249 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37250 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37251 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37252 .next
37253
37254 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37255 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37256 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37257 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37258 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37259 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37260 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37261 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37262 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37263 separate commands.
37264
37265 .next
37266 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37267 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37268 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37269 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37270 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37271 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37272 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37273 .next
37274 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37275 is disabled.
37276 .next
37277 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37278 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37279 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37280 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37281 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37282 .endlist
37283
37284
37285
37286 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37287 .cindex "setuid"
37288 .cindex "root privilege"
37289 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37290 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37291 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37292 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37293 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37294 is required for two things:
37295
37296 .ilist
37297 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37298 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37299 not required.
37300 .next
37301 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37302 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37303 configuration.
37304 .endlist
37305
37306 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37307 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37308 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37309 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37310 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37311 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37312 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37313 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37314
37315 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37316 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37317 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37318
37319 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37320 uid and gid in the following cases:
37321
37322 .ilist
37323 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37324 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37325 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37326 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37327 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37328 the calling process.
37329 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37330 option may not be used at all.
37331 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37332 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37333 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37334 .next
37335 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37336 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37337 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37338 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37339 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37340 calling process.
37341 .next
37342 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37343 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37344 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37345 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37346 testing address verification
37347 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37348 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37349 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37350 option).
37351 .next
37352 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37353 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37354 .endlist
37355
37356 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37357
37358 .ilist
37359 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37360 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37361 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37362 will be used during message reception.
37363 .next
37364 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37365 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37366 .next
37367 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37368 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37369 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37370 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37371 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37372 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37373 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37374 generating bounce and warning messages.
37375
37376 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37377 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37378 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37379 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37380 .next
37381 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37382 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37383 .endlist
37384
37385
37386
37387
37388 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37389 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37390 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37391 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37392 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37393 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37394 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37395 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37396 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37397 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37398 to any other uid.
37399
37400 .cindex SIGHUP
37401 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37402 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37403 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37404 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37405
37406 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37407 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37408 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37409 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37410 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37411
37412 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37413 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37414 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37415 effect.
37416
37417 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37418 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37419 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37420
37421 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37422 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37423 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37424 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37425 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37426 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37427 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37428 address this problem at this time.
37429
37430 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37431 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37432 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37433 be used in the most straightforward way.
37434
37435 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37436 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37437
37438 .ilist
37439 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37440 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37441 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37442 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37443 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37444 .next
37445 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37446 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37447 .next
37448 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37449 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37450 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37451 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37452 .next
37453 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37454 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37455
37456 .olist
37457 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37458 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37459 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37460 .next
37461 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37462 owned by the Exim user.
37463 .next
37464 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37465 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37466 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37467 .endlist olist
37468 .endlist ilist
37469
37470
37471 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37472 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37473 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37474 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37475
37476 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37477 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37478
37479
37480
37481
37482 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37483 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37484 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37485
37486
37487
37488 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37489 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37490 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37491 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37492 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37493 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37494 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37495
37496 .ilist
37497 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37498 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37499 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37500 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37501 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37502 .next
37503 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37504 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37505 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37506 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37507 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37508 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37509 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37510 .next
37511 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37512 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37513 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37514 .next
37515 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37516 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37517 .next
37518 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37519 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37520 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37521 .next
37522 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37523 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37524 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37525 of opaque strings.
37526 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37527 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37528 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37529 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37530 .endlist
37531
37532
37533
37534
37535 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37536 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37537 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37538 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37539 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37540 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37541 are some issues to be aware of:
37542
37543 .ilist
37544 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37545 .next
37546 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37547 .next
37548 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37549 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37550 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37551 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37552 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37553 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37554 data.
37555 .next
37556 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37557 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37558 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37559 .next
37560 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37561 expected to yield one result.
37562 .endlist
37563
37564
37565
37566
37567 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37568 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37569 .cindex "IP source routing"
37570 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37571 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37572 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37573 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37574
37575
37576
37577 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37578 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37579 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37580
37581
37582
37583
37584 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37585 .cindex "trusted users"
37586 .cindex "admin user"
37587 .cindex "privileged user"
37588 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37589 .cindex "user" "admin"
37590 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37591 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37592 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37593 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37594 permit a remote host to be specified.
37595
37596 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37597 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37598 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37599 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37600 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37601 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37602 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37603
37604 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37605 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37606 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37607 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37608 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37609
37610 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37611 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37612 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37613 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37614 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37615
37616 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37617 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37618 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37619 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37620 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37621 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37622 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37623 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37624
37625 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37626 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37627 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37628 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37629 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37630 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37631 files.
37632
37633
37634
37635 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37636 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37637 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37638 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37639 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37640 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37641
37642
37643
37644 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37645 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37646 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37647 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37648 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37649 this.
37650
37651
37652
37653 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37654 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37655 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37656 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37657 converted output.
37658
37659
37660
37661 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37662 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37663 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37664 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37665 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37666
37667
37668
37669 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37670 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37671 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37672 loading it.
37673
37674
37675 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37676 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37677 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37678 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37679 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37680 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37681 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37682
37683 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37684 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37685 string.
37686
37687
37688
37689 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37690 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37691 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37692 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37693
37694
37695
37696 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37697 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37698 enough to hold the result.
37699 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37700
37701
37702
37703
37704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37705 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37706
37707 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37708 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37709 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37710 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37711 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37712 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37713 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37714 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37715 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37716 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37717 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37718 themselves are recoverable.
37719
37720 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37721 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37722 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37723
37724 .ilist
37725 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37726 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37727 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37728 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37729 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37730 .next
37731 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37732 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37733 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37734 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37735 will always be the case.
37736 .next
37737 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37738 .next
37739 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37740 signature.
37741 .endlist
37742 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37743
37744 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37745 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37746 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37747 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37748 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37749 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37750 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37751 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37752 attempt.
37753
37754 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37755 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37756 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37757 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37758 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37759 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37760 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37761 normally the Exim user.
37762
37763 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37764 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37765 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37766 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37767 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37768 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37769 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37770 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37771
37772 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37773 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37774 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37775 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37776
37777 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37778 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37779
37780 .vlist
37781 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37782 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37783 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37784 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37785 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37786 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37787 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37788 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37789 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37790 newlines.
37791
37792 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37793 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37794 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37795 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37796 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37797 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37798
37799 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37800 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37801 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37802 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37803 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37804 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37805
37806 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37807 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37808 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37809
37810 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37811 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37812 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37813 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37814 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37815
37816 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37817 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37818 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37819 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37820 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37821
37822 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37823 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37824 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37825
37826 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37827 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37828 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37829
37830 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37831 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37832 present.
37833
37834 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37835 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37836 present if the number is greater than zero.
37837
37838 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37839 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37840 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37841
37842 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37843 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37844 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37845
37846 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37847 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37848 command.
37849
37850 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37851 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37852 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37853 messages.
37854
37855 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37856 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37857 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37858 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37859
37860 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37861 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37862 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37863
37864 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37865 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37866 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37867 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37868 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37869 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37870
37871 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37872 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37873 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37874 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37875 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37876
37877 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37878 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37879 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37880 generated messages.
37881
37882 .vitem &%-local%&
37883 The message is from a local sender.
37884
37885 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37886 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37887
37888 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37889 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37890 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37891 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37892
37893 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37894 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37895 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37896
37897 .vitem &%-N%&
37898 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37899 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37900 &%-N%& is assumed.
37901
37902 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37903 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37904 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37905
37906 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37907 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37908 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37909
37910 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37911 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37912 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37913
37914 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37915 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37916 certificate was verified by the server.
37917
37918 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37919 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37920 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37921
37922 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37923 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37924 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37925 certificate.
37926 .endlist
37927
37928 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37929 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37930 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37931 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37932 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37933 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37934 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37935 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37936 addresses are complete.
37937
37938 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37939 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37940 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37941 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37942 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37943 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37944 .code
37945 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37946 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37947 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37948 .endd
37949 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37950 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37951 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37952 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37953 example:
37954 .code
37955 4
37956 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37957 darcy@austen.fict.example
37958 rdo@foundation
37959 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37960 .endd
37961 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37962 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37963 line is of the following form:
37964 .display
37965 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37966 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37967 .endd
37968 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37969 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37970 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37971 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37972 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37973 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37974 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37975 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37976
37977
37978 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37979 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37980 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37981 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37982 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37983 following:
37984
37985 .table2 50pt
37986 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37987 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37988 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37989 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37990 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37991 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37992 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37993 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37994 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37995 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37996 .endtable
37997
37998 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37999 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38000 typical set of headers:
38001 .code
38002 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38003 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38004 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38005 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38006 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38007 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38008 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38009 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38010 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38011 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38012 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38013 .endd
38014 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38015 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38016 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38017 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38018 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38019 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38020
38021 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38022 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38023
38024 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38025 "DKIM Support"
38026 .cindex "DKIM"
38027
38028 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38029 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38030 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38031 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38032
38033 .new
38034 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38035 .wen
38036 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38037
38038 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
38039 .olist
38040 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38041 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38042 (including transport filters)
38043 except cutthrough delivery.
38044 .next
38045 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38046 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38047 different signature contexts.
38048 .endlist
38049
38050 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38051 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38052 Exim's standard controls.
38053
38054 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38055 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
38056 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38057 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38058 .code
38059 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38060 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38061 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38062 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38063 .endd
38064 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38065 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38066 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38067 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38068 senders).
38069
38070
38071 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38072 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38073
38074 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38075 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38076
38077 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
38078 MANDATORY:
38079 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
38080 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
38081
38082 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
38083 MANDATORY:
38084 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
38085 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
38086 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38087 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38088
38089 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38090 MANDATORY:
38091 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38092 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38093 The result can either
38094 .ilist
38095 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38096 .next
38097 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38098 the private key.
38099 .next
38100 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38101 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38102 is set.
38103 .endlist
38104
38105 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38106 OPTIONAL:
38107 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38108 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38109 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38110 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38111
38112 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38113 OPTIONAL:
38114 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38115 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38116 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38117 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38118 variables here.
38119
38120 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
38121 OPTIONAL:
38122 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
38123 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
38124 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
38125 used.
38126
38127
38128 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38129 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38130
38131 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
38132 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38133 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38134 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38135 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38136 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
38137 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38138
38139 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38140 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38141 runtime of the ACL.
38142
38143 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38144 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38145 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38146 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38147
38148 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38149 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38150 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38151 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38152 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38153 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38154 it defaults as:
38155 .code
38156 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38157 .endd
38158 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38159 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38160 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38161 .code
38162 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38163 .endd
38164 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38165 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38166 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38167 .code
38168 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38169 .endd
38170
38171 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38172 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38173
38174
38175 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38176 available (from most to least important):
38177
38178
38179 .vlist
38180 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38181 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38182 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38183 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38184 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38185 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38186 .ilist
38187 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38188 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38189 .next
38190 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38191 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38192 .next
38193 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38194 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38195 .next
38196 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38197 .endlist
38198 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38199 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38200 "fail" or "invalid". One of
38201 .ilist
38202 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38203 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38204 .next
38205 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38206 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38207 .next
38208 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38209 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38210 means that the message body was modified in transit.
38211 .next
38212 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38213 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38214 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38215 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38216 .endlist
38217 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38218 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38219 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38220 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38221 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38222 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38223 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38224 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38225 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38226 The key record selector string.
38227 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38228 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38229 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38230 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38231 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
38232 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38233 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38234 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38235 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38236 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38237 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38238 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38239 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38240 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38241 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38242 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38243 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38244 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38245 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38246 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38247 integer size comparisons against this value.
38248 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38249 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38250 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38251 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38252 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38253 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38254 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38255 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38256 in the key record.
38257 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38258 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38259 in the key record.
38260 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38261 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38262 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38263 Number of bits in the key.
38264 .endlist
38265
38266 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38267
38268 .vlist
38269 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38270 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38271 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38272 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38273 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38274
38275 .code
38276 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
38277 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
38278 sender_domains = gmail.com
38279 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38280 dkim_status = none
38281 .endd
38282
38283 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38284 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38285 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38286 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38287
38288 .code
38289 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38290 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38291 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38292 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38293 .endd
38294
38295 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38296 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38297 for more information of what they mean.
38298 .endlist
38299
38300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38302
38303 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38304 "Proxy support"
38305 .cindex "proxy support"
38306 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
38307
38308 .new
38309 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38310 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38311
38312
38313 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38314 .cindex proxy inbound
38315 .cindex proxy "server side"
38316 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38317 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38318
38319 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38320 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38321 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38322 in Local/Makefile.
38323
38324 It was built on specifications from:
38325 http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt
38326 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38327 http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e
38328
38329 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38330 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38331 to distribute load.
38332 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38333 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38334 There is no logging if a host passes or
38335 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38336 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38337
38338 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38339 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38340 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38341
38342 The following expansion variables are usable
38343 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38344 of the proxy):
38345 .display
38346 &'proxy_host_address '& internal IP address of the proxy
38347 &'proxy_host_port '& internal TCP port of the proxy
38348 &'proxy_target_address '& external IP address of the proxy
38349 &'proxy_target_port '& external TCP port of the proxy
38350 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38351 .endd
38352 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_host_address$& is empty
38353 there was a protocol error.
38354
38355 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38356 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38357 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38358 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38359 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38360 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38361 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38362 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38363 A possible solution is:
38364 .display
38365 # Set max number of connections per host
38366 LIMIT = 5
38367 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38368 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38369
38370 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38371 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38372 .endd
38373
38374
38375
38376 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38377 .cindex proxy outbound
38378 .cindex proxy "client side"
38379 .cindex proxy SOCKS
38380 .cindex SOCKS proxy
38381 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38382 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38383 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38384 Local/Makefile.
38385
38386 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38387 on an smtp transport.
38388 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38389 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38390 Each proxy specifier is a list
38391 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
38392 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38393
38394 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38395 The list of options is in the following table:
38396 .display
38397 &'auth '& authentication method
38398 &'name '& authentication username
38399 &'pass '& authentication password
38400 &'port '& tcp port
38401 &'tmo '& connection timeout
38402 &'pri '& priority
38403 &'weight '& selection bias
38404 .endd
38405
38406 More details on each of these options follows:
38407
38408 .ilist
38409 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
38410 .cindex proxy authentication
38411 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38412 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38413 for access to the proxy.
38414 Default is &"none"&.
38415 .next
38416 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38417 Default is empty.
38418 .next
38419 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38420 Default is empty.
38421 .next
38422 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38423 Default is 1080.
38424 .next
38425 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38426 Default is 5.
38427 .next
38428 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38429 higher values being tried first.
38430 The default priority is 1.
38431 .next
38432 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38433 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38434 weighted by this value.
38435 The default value for selection bias is 1.
38436 .endlist
38437
38438 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38439 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38440 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38441
38442 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
38443 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38444 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38445 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38446 .wen
38447
38448 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38450
38451 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38452 "Internationalisation""
38453 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
38454 .cindex EAI
38455 .cindex i18n
38456 .cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38457
38458 .new
38459 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38460 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38461 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38462
38463 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38464 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38465 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38466 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38467 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38468 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38469
38470 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
38471 international handling for the message is enabled and
38472 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
38473
38474 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
38475 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
38476 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
38477 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
38478
38479 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
38480 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
38481 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
38482 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
38483
38484 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
38485 components expanded to a-label form,
38486 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
38487 form of the name.
38488
38489 .cindex log protocol
38490 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
38491 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
38492 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
38493
38494 The following expansion operator can be used:
38495 .code
38496 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
38497 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
38498 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
38499 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
38500 .endd
38501
38502 ACLs may use the following modifier:
38503 .display
38504 control = utf8_downconvert
38505 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
38506 .endd
38507 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
38508 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
38509 Message Submission Agent context.
38510 If a value is appended it may be:
38511 .display
38512 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
38513 &`0 `& no downconversion
38514 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
38515 .endd
38516
38517 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
38518 is initially set to -1.
38519
38520
38521 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
38522 Configurations supporting these should inspect
38523 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
38524
38525 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
38526 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
38527 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
38528
38529 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
38530 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
38531
38532
38533
38534 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
38535 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
38536 the following expansion operator can be used:
38537 .code
38538 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
38539 .endd
38540
38541 The string is converted from the charset specified by
38542 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
38543 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
38544 to the
38545 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
38546 with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
38547 (which has to be a single character)
38548 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
38549 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
38550
38551 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
38552 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
38553
38554 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
38555 by many other IMAP servers.
38556
38557 Examples:
38558 .display
38559 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
38560 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
38561 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
38562 .endd
38563
38564 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
38565 must be representable in UTF-16.
38566
38567 .wen
38568
38569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38570 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38571
38572 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
38573 "Events"
38574 .cindex events
38575
38576 .new
38577 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
38578 of points. It was originally invented to giave a way to do customised logging
38579 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
38580 processing actions.
38581
38582 Most installations will never need to use Events.
38583 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
38584 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38585
38586 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
38587 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
38588 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
38589
38590 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
38591 An example might look like:
38592 .cindex logging custom
38593 .code
38594 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
38595 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
38596 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
38597 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
38598 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
38599 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
38600 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
38601 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
38602 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
38603 } {}}
38604 .endd
38605
38606 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
38607 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
38608 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
38609
38610 The current list of events is:
38611 .display
38612 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
38613 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
38614 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
38615 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
38616 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
38617 &`msg:fail:delivery after main `& per recipient
38618 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
38619 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
38620 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
38621 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
38622 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
38623 .endd
38624 New event types may be added in future.
38625
38626 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
38627 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
38628 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
38629
38630 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
38631 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
38632 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
38633
38634 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
38635 with the event type:
38636 .display
38637 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation mssage
38638 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
38639 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
38640 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
38641 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
38642 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
38643 .endd
38644
38645 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
38646
38647 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
38648 however due to the multiple contextx that Exim operates in during
38649 the course of its processing:
38650 .ilist
38651 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
38652 transport call
38653 .next
38654 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
38655 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
38656 .endlist
38657 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
38658 a useful way of writing to the main log.
38659
38660 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
38661 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
38662 following will be forced:
38663 .display
38664 &`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
38665 &`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
38666 &`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
38667 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
38668 &`tcp:close `& (ignored)
38669 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
38670 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
38671 .endd
38672 No other use is made of the result string.
38673
38674 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
38675 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
38676 the target system.
38677
38678 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
38679 chain element received on the connection.
38680 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
38681 loaded locally.
38682 .wen
38683
38684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38686
38687 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
38688 "Adding drivers or lookups"
38689 .cindex "adding drivers"
38690 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
38691 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
38692 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
38693 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
38694
38695 .olist
38696 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38697 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38698 .next
38699 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38700 .display
38701 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38702 .endd
38703 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38704 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38705 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38706 .next
38707 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38708 .code
38709 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38710 .endd
38711 .next
38712 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38713 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38714 .next
38715 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38716 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38717 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38718 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38719 simple form that most lookups have.
38720 .next
38721 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38722 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38723 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38724 .next
38725 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38726 &_src_&.
38727 .next
38728 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38729 as for other drivers and lookups.
38730 .endlist
38731
38732 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38733 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38734 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38735 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38736 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38737
38738 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38739 the interface that is expected.
38740
38741
38742
38743
38744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38746
38747 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38748 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38749 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38750 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38751 . processors.
38752 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38753
38754 .literal xml
38755 <?sdop
38756 format="newpage"
38757 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38758 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38759 ?>
38760 .literal off
38761
38762 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38763 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38764 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38765
38766
38767 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38768 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////